US20150039660A1 - Co-locate objects request - Google Patents
Co-locate objects request Download PDFInfo
- Publication number
- US20150039660A1 US20150039660A1 US14/292,662 US201414292662A US2015039660A1 US 20150039660 A1 US20150039660 A1 US 20150039660A1 US 201414292662 A US201414292662 A US 201414292662A US 2015039660 A1 US2015039660 A1 US 2015039660A1
- Authority
- US
- United States
- Prior art keywords
- data
- module
- sets
- dst
- slices
- Prior art date
- Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
- Abandoned
Links
Images
Classifications
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G06—COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
- G06F—ELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
- G06F3/00—Input arrangements for transferring data to be processed into a form capable of being handled by the computer; Output arrangements for transferring data from processing unit to output unit, e.g. interface arrangements
- G06F3/06—Digital input from, or digital output to, record carriers, e.g. RAID, emulated record carriers or networked record carriers
- G06F3/0601—Interfaces specially adapted for storage systems
- G06F3/0602—Interfaces specially adapted for storage systems specifically adapted to achieve a particular effect
- G06F3/0604—Improving or facilitating administration, e.g. storage management
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G06—COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
- G06F—ELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
- G06F11/00—Error detection; Error correction; Monitoring
- G06F11/07—Responding to the occurrence of a fault, e.g. fault tolerance
- G06F11/08—Error detection or correction by redundancy in data representation, e.g. by using checking codes
- G06F11/10—Adding special bits or symbols to the coded information, e.g. parity check, casting out 9's or 11's
- G06F11/1076—Parity data used in redundant arrays of independent storages, e.g. in RAID systems
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G06—COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
- G06F—ELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
- G06F11/00—Error detection; Error correction; Monitoring
- G06F11/07—Responding to the occurrence of a fault, e.g. fault tolerance
- G06F11/08—Error detection or correction by redundancy in data representation, e.g. by using checking codes
- G06F11/10—Adding special bits or symbols to the coded information, e.g. parity check, casting out 9's or 11's
- G06F11/1076—Parity data used in redundant arrays of independent storages, e.g. in RAID systems
- G06F11/1092—Rebuilding, e.g. when physically replacing a failing disk
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G06—COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
- G06F—ELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
- G06F3/00—Input arrangements for transferring data to be processed into a form capable of being handled by the computer; Output arrangements for transferring data from processing unit to output unit, e.g. interface arrangements
- G06F3/06—Digital input from, or digital output to, record carriers, e.g. RAID, emulated record carriers or networked record carriers
- G06F3/0601—Interfaces specially adapted for storage systems
- G06F3/0602—Interfaces specially adapted for storage systems specifically adapted to achieve a particular effect
- G06F3/0614—Improving the reliability of storage systems
- G06F3/0619—Improving the reliability of storage systems in relation to data integrity, e.g. data losses, bit errors
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G06—COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
- G06F—ELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
- G06F3/00—Input arrangements for transferring data to be processed into a form capable of being handled by the computer; Output arrangements for transferring data from processing unit to output unit, e.g. interface arrangements
- G06F3/06—Digital input from, or digital output to, record carriers, e.g. RAID, emulated record carriers or networked record carriers
- G06F3/0601—Interfaces specially adapted for storage systems
- G06F3/0628—Interfaces specially adapted for storage systems making use of a particular technique
- G06F3/0638—Organizing or formatting or addressing of data
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G06—COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
- G06F—ELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
- G06F3/00—Input arrangements for transferring data to be processed into a form capable of being handled by the computer; Output arrangements for transferring data from processing unit to output unit, e.g. interface arrangements
- G06F3/06—Digital input from, or digital output to, record carriers, e.g. RAID, emulated record carriers or networked record carriers
- G06F3/0601—Interfaces specially adapted for storage systems
- G06F3/0628—Interfaces specially adapted for storage systems making use of a particular technique
- G06F3/0638—Organizing or formatting or addressing of data
- G06F3/064—Management of blocks
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G06—COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
- G06F—ELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
- G06F3/00—Input arrangements for transferring data to be processed into a form capable of being handled by the computer; Output arrangements for transferring data from processing unit to output unit, e.g. interface arrangements
- G06F3/06—Digital input from, or digital output to, record carriers, e.g. RAID, emulated record carriers or networked record carriers
- G06F3/0601—Interfaces specially adapted for storage systems
- G06F3/0628—Interfaces specially adapted for storage systems making use of a particular technique
- G06F3/0638—Organizing or formatting or addressing of data
- G06F3/0644—Management of space entities, e.g. partitions, extents, pools
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G06—COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
- G06F—ELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
- G06F3/00—Input arrangements for transferring data to be processed into a form capable of being handled by the computer; Output arrangements for transferring data from processing unit to output unit, e.g. interface arrangements
- G06F3/06—Digital input from, or digital output to, record carriers, e.g. RAID, emulated record carriers or networked record carriers
- G06F3/0601—Interfaces specially adapted for storage systems
- G06F3/0668—Interfaces specially adapted for storage systems adopting a particular infrastructure
- G06F3/067—Distributed or networked storage systems, e.g. storage area networks [SAN], network attached storage [NAS]
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04L—TRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL INFORMATION, e.g. TELEGRAPHIC COMMUNICATION
- H04L67/00—Network arrangements or protocols for supporting network services or applications
- H04L67/01—Protocols
- H04L67/10—Protocols in which an application is distributed across nodes in the network
- H04L67/1097—Protocols in which an application is distributed across nodes in the network for distributed storage of data in networks, e.g. transport arrangements for network file system [NFS], storage area networks [SAN] or network attached storage [NAS]
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04L—TRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL INFORMATION, e.g. TELEGRAPHIC COMMUNICATION
- H04L67/00—Network arrangements or protocols for supporting network services or applications
- H04L67/2866—Architectures; Arrangements
- H04L67/30—Profiles
- H04L67/306—User profiles
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G06—COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
- G06F—ELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
- G06F2211/00—Indexing scheme relating to details of data-processing equipment not covered by groups G06F3/00 - G06F13/00
- G06F2211/10—Indexing scheme relating to G06F11/10
- G06F2211/1002—Indexing scheme relating to G06F11/1076
- G06F2211/1028—Distributed, i.e. distributed RAID systems with parity
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H03—ELECTRONIC CIRCUITRY
- H03M—CODING; DECODING; CODE CONVERSION IN GENERAL
- H03M13/00—Coding, decoding or code conversion, for error detection or error correction; Coding theory basic assumptions; Coding bounds; Error probability evaluation methods; Channel models; Simulation or testing of codes
- H03M13/03—Error detection or forward error correction by redundancy in data representation, i.e. code words containing more digits than the source words
- H03M13/05—Error detection or forward error correction by redundancy in data representation, i.e. code words containing more digits than the source words using block codes, i.e. a predetermined number of check bits joined to a predetermined number of information bits
- H03M13/13—Linear codes
- H03M13/15—Cyclic codes, i.e. cyclic shifts of codewords produce other codewords, e.g. codes defined by a generator polynomial, Bose-Chaudhuri-Hocquenghem [BCH] codes
- H03M13/151—Cyclic codes, i.e. cyclic shifts of codewords produce other codewords, e.g. codes defined by a generator polynomial, Bose-Chaudhuri-Hocquenghem [BCH] codes using error location or error correction polynomials
- H03M13/1515—Reed-Solomon codes
Definitions
- This present disclosure relates generally to computer networks and more particularly to dispersed storage of data and distributed task processing of data.
- Computing devices are known to communicate data, process data, and/or store data. Such computing devices range from wireless smart phones, laptops, tablets, personal computers (PC), work stations, and video game devices, to data centers that support millions of web searches, stock trades, or on-line purchases every day.
- a computing device includes a central processing unit (CPU), a memory system, user input/output interfaces, peripheral device interfaces, and an interconnecting bus structure.
- a computer may effectively extend its CPU by using “cloud computing” to perform one or more computing functions (e.g., a service, an application, an algorithm, an arithmetic logic function, etc.) on behalf of the computer.
- cloud computing may be performed by multiple cloud computing resources in a distributed manner to improve the response time for completion of the service, application, and/or function.
- Hadoop is an open source software framework that supports distributed applications enabling application execution by thousands of computers.
- a computer may use “cloud storage” as part of its memory system.
- cloud storage enables a user, via its computer, to store files, applications, etc. on an Internet storage system.
- the Internet storage system may include a RAID (redundant array of independent disks) system and/or a dispersed storage system that uses an error correction scheme to encode data for storage.
- FIG. 1 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of a distributed computing system in accordance with the present disclosure
- FIG. 2 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of a computing core in accordance with the present disclosure
- FIG. 3 is a diagram of an example of a distributed storage and task processing in accordance with the present disclosure
- FIG. 4 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of an outbound distributed storage and/or task (DST) processing in accordance with the present disclosure
- FIG. 5 is a logic diagram of an example of a method for outbound DST processing in accordance with the present disclosure
- FIG. 6 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of a dispersed error encoding in accordance with the present disclosure
- FIG. 7 is a diagram of an example of a segment processing of the dispersed error encoding in accordance with the present disclosure.
- FIG. 8 is a diagram of an example of error encoding and slicing processing of the dispersed error encoding in accordance with the present disclosure
- FIG. 9 is a diagram of an example of grouping selection processing of the outbound DST processing in accordance with the present disclosure.
- FIG. 10 is a diagram of an example of converting data into slice groups in accordance with the present disclosure.
- FIG. 11 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of a DST execution unit in accordance with the present disclosure.
- FIG. 12 is a schematic block diagram of an example of operation of a DST execution unit in accordance with the present disclosure.
- FIG. 13 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of an inbound distributed storage and/or task (DST) processing in accordance with the present disclosure
- FIG. 14 is a logic diagram of an example of a method for inbound DST processing in accordance with the present disclosure.
- FIG. 15 is a diagram of an example of de-grouping selection processing of the inbound DST processing in accordance with the present disclosure
- FIG. 16 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of a dispersed error decoding in accordance with the present disclosure.
- FIG. 17 is a diagram of an example of de-slicing and error decoding processing of the dispersed error decoding in accordance with the present disclosure.
- FIG. 18 is a diagram of an example of a de-segment processing of the dispersed error decoding in accordance with the present disclosure.
- FIG. 19 is a diagram of an example of converting slice groups into data in accordance with the present disclosure.
- FIG. 20 is a diagram of an example of a distributed storage within the distributed computing system in accordance with the present disclosure.
- FIG. 21 is a schematic block diagram of an example of operation of outbound distributed storage and/or task (DST) processing for storing data in accordance with the present disclosure
- FIG. 22 is a schematic block diagram of an example of a dispersed error encoding for the example of FIG. 21 in accordance with the present disclosure
- FIG. 23 is a diagram of an example of converting data into pillar slice groups for storage in accordance with the present disclosure.
- FIG. 24 is a schematic block diagram of an example of a storage operation of a DST execution unit in accordance with the present disclosure
- FIG. 25 is a schematic block diagram of an example of operation of inbound distributed storage and/or task (DST) processing for retrieving dispersed error encoded data in accordance with the present disclosure
- FIG. 26 is a schematic block diagram of an example of a dispersed error decoding for the example of FIG. 25 in accordance with the present disclosure
- FIG. 27 is a schematic block diagram of an example of a distributed storage and task processing network (DSTN) module storing a plurality of data and a plurality of task codes in accordance with the present disclosure
- DSTN distributed storage and task processing network
- FIG. 28 is a schematic block diagram of an example of the distributed computing system performing tasks on stored data in accordance with the present disclosure
- FIG. 29 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of a task distribution module facilitating the example of FIG. 28 in accordance with the present disclosure
- FIG. 30 is a diagram of a specific example of the distributed computing system performing tasks on stored data in accordance with the present disclosure
- FIG. 31 is a schematic block diagram of an example of a distributed storage and task processing network (DSTN) module storing data and task codes for the example of FIG. 30 in accordance with the present disclosure;
- DSTN distributed storage and task processing network
- FIG. 32 is a diagram of an example of DST allocation information for the example of FIG. 30 in accordance with the present disclosure
- FIGS. 33-38 are schematic block diagrams of the DSTN module performing the example of FIG. 30 in accordance with the present disclosure.
- FIG. 39 is a diagram of an example of combining result information into final results for the example of FIG. 30 in accordance with the present disclosure.
- FIGS. 40A-40D are schematic block diagrams of an embodiment of a dispersed storage network (DSN) illustrating an example of storing data in DSN memory in accordance with the present disclosure
- FIG. 40E is a flowchart illustrating an example of accessing data in accordance with the present disclosure.
- FIG. 41 is a flowchart illustrating an example of updating a dispersed storage network (DSN) address in accordance with the present disclosure
- FIG. 42 is a flowchart illustrating an example of accessing an encoded data slice in accordance with the present disclosure
- FIGS. 43A , 43 C-F are schematic block diagrams of an embodiment of a dispersed storage network (DSN) illustrating an example of time-based storage of data in accordance with the present disclosure
- FIG. 43B is a timing diagram illustrating an example of generating a time-availability pattern in accordance with the present disclosure
- FIG. 43G is a flowchart illustrating an example of time-based storage of data in accordance with the present disclosure.
- FIG. 44A is a schematic block diagram of another embodiment of a distributed storage and task (DST) execution unit in accordance with the present disclosure.
- DST distributed storage and task
- FIG. 44B is a flowchart illustrating an example of assigning resources in accordance with the present disclosure.
- FIG. 45A is a schematic block diagram of another embodiment of a dispersed storage network (DSN) system in accordance with the present disclosure.
- DSN dispersed storage network
- FIG. 45B is a diagram illustrating an example of load-balancing in accordance with the present disclosure.
- FIG. 46A is a schematic block diagram of another embodiment of a distributed storage and task (DST) execution unit in accordance with the present disclosure.
- DST distributed storage and task
- FIG. 46B is a diagram illustrating an example of memory utilization in accordance with the present disclosure.
- FIG. 46C is a diagram illustrating another example of memory utilization in accordance with the present disclosure.
- FIG. 46D is a flowchart illustrating an example of updating memory utilization information in accordance with the present disclosure.
- FIG. 46E is a flowchart illustrating example ways to identify slices needing a rebuild in accordance with the present disclosure
- FIG. 46F is a flowchart illustrating another example of updating memory utilization information
- FIG. 46G is schematic block diagram illustrating an example DST client module structure for memory utilization
- FIG. 47A is a schematic block diagram of another embodiment of a dispersed storage network (DSN) system in accordance with the present disclosure.
- DSN dispersed storage network
- FIG. 47B is a diagram illustrating an example of generating a slice name in accordance with the present disclosure.
- FIG. 47C is a flowchart illustrating an example of co-locating storage of data in accordance with the present disclosure.
- FIG. 47D is a flowchart illustrating one example of obtaining the plurality of sets of encoded data slices to be co-located.
- FIG. 47E is a schematic block diagram of another embodiment of a dispersed storage network (DSN) system in accordance with the present disclosure.
- DSN dispersed storage network
- FIG. 1 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of a distributed computing system 10 that includes a user device 12 and/or a user device 14 , a distributed storage and/or task (DST) processing unit 16 , a distributed storage and/or task network (DSTN) managing unit 18 , a DST integrity processing unit 20 , and a distributed storage and/or task network (DSTN) module 22 .
- the components of the distributed computing system 10 are coupled via a network 24 , which may include one or more wireless and/or wire lined communication systems; one or more private intranet systems and/or public internet systems; and/or one or more local area networks (LAN) and/or wide area networks (WAN).
- a network 24 which may include one or more wireless and/or wire lined communication systems; one or more private intranet systems and/or public internet systems; and/or one or more local area networks (LAN) and/or wide area networks (WAN).
- the DSTN module 22 includes a plurality of distributed storage and/or task (DST) execution units 36 that may be located at geographically different sites (e.g., one in Chicago, one in Milwaukee, etc.). Each of the DST execution units is operable to store dispersed error encoded data and/or to execute, in a distributed manner, one or more tasks on data.
- DST distributed storage and/or task
- the tasks may be a simple function (e.g., a mathematical function, a logic function, an identify function, a find function, a search engine function, a replace function, etc.), a complex function (e.g., compression, human and/or computer language translation, text-to-voice conversion, voice-to-text conversion, etc.), multiple simple and/or complex functions, one or more algorithms, one or more applications, etc.
- a simple function e.g., a mathematical function, a logic function, an identify function, a find function, a search engine function, a replace function, etc.
- a complex function e.g., compression, human and/or computer language translation, text-to-voice conversion, voice-to-text conversion, etc.
- multiple simple and/or complex functions e.g., compression, human and/or computer language translation, text-to-voice conversion, voice-to-text conversion, etc.
- Each of the user devices 12 - 14 , the DST processing unit 16 , the DSTN managing unit 18 , and the DST integrity processing unit 20 include a computing core 26 and may be a portable computing device and/or a fixed computing device.
- a portable computing device may be a social networking device, a gaming device, a cell phone, a smart phone, a personal digital assistant, a digital music player, a digital video player, a laptop computer, a handheld computer, a tablet, a video game controller, and/or any other portable device that includes a computing core.
- a fixed computing device may be a personal computer (PC), a computer server, a cable set-top box, a satellite receiver, a television set, a printer, a fax machine, home entertainment equipment, a video game console, and/or any type of home or office computing equipment.
- User device 12 and DST processing unit 16 are configured to include a DST client module 34 .
- each interface 30 , 32 , and 33 includes software and/or hardware to support one or more communication links via the network 24 indirectly and/or directly.
- interfaces 30 support a communication link (e.g., wired, wireless, direct, via a LAN, via the network 24 , etc.) between user device 14 and the DST processing unit 16 .
- interface 32 supports communication links (e.g., a wired connection, a wireless connection, a LAN connection, and/or any other type of connection to/from the network 24 ) between user device 12 and the DSTN module 22 and between the DST processing unit 16 and the DSTN module 22 .
- interface 33 supports a communication link for each of the DSTN managing unit 18 and DST integrity processing unit 20 to the network 24 .
- the distributed computing system 10 is operable to support dispersed storage (DS) error encoded data storage and retrieval, to support distributed task processing on received data, and/or to support distributed task processing on stored data.
- DS error encoded data storage and retrieval the distributed computing system 10 supports three primary operations: storage management, data storage and retrieval (an example of which will be discussed with reference to FIGS. 20-26 ), and data storage integrity verification.
- data can be encoded, distributedly stored in physically different locations, and subsequently retrieved in a reliable and secure manner.
- Such a system is tolerant of a significant number of failures (e.g., up to a failure level, which may be greater than or equal to a pillar width minus a decode threshold minus one) that may result from individual storage device failures and/or network equipment failures without loss of data and without the need for a redundant or backup copy. Further, the system allows the data to be stored for an indefinite period of time without data loss and does so in a secure manner (e.g., the system is very resistant to attempts at hacking the data).
- a failure level which may be greater than or equal to a pillar width minus a decode threshold minus one
- the second primary function begins and ends with a user device 12 - 14 .
- a second type of user device 14 has data 40 to store in the DSTN module 22 , it sends the data 40 to the DST processing unit 16 via its interface 30 .
- the interface 30 functions to mimic a conventional operating system (OS) file system interface (e.g., network file system (NFS), flash file system (FFS), disk file system (DFS), file transfer protocol (FTP), web-based distributed authoring and versioning (WebDAV), etc.) and/or a block memory interface (e.g., small computer system interface (SCSI), internet small computer system interface (iSCSI), etc.).
- OS operating system
- NFS network file system
- FFS disk file system
- FTP file transfer protocol
- WebDAV web-based distributed authoring and versioning
- the interface 30 may attach a user identification code (ID) to the data 40 .
- ID user identification code
- the DSTN managing unit 18 performs DS management services.
- One such DS management service includes the DSTN managing unit 18 establishing distributed data storage parameters (e.g., vault creation, distributed storage parameters, security parameters, billing information, user profile information, etc.) for a user device 12 - 14 individually or as part of a group of user devices.
- distributed data storage parameters e.g., vault creation, distributed storage parameters, security parameters, billing information, user profile information, etc.
- the DSTN managing unit 18 coordinates creation of a vault (e.g., a virtual memory block) within memory of the DSTN module 22 for a user device, a group of devices, or for public access and establishes per vault dispersed storage (DS) error encoding parameters for a vault.
- a vault e.g., a virtual memory block
- the DSTN managing unit 18 may facilitate storage of DS error encoding parameters for each vault of a plurality of vaults by updating registry information for the distributed computing system 10 .
- the facilitating includes storing updated registry information in one or more of the DSTN module 22 , the user device 12 , the DST processing unit 16 , and the DST integrity processing unit 20 .
- the DS error encoding parameters include data segmenting information (e.g., how many segments data (e.g., a file, a group of files, a data block, etc.) is divided into), segment security information (e.g., per segment encryption, compression, integrity checksum, etc.), error coding information (e.g., pillar width, decode threshold, read threshold, write threshold, etc.), slicing information (e.g., the number of encoded data slices that will be created for each data segment); and slice security information (e.g., per encoded data slice encryption, compression, integrity checksum, etc.).
- data segmenting information e.g., how many segments data (e.g., a file, a group of files, a data block, etc.) is divided into
- segment security information e.g., per segment encryption, compression, integrity checksum, etc.
- error coding information e.g., pillar width, decode threshold, read threshold, write threshold, etc.
- slicing information
- the DSTN managing module 18 creates and stores user profile information (e.g., an access control list (ACL)) in local memory and/or within memory of the DSTN module 22 .
- the user profile information includes authentication information, permissions, and/or the security parameters.
- the security parameters may include encryption/decryption scheme, one or more encryption keys, key generation scheme, and/or data encoding/decoding scheme.
- the DSTN managing unit 18 creates billing information for a particular user, a user group, a vault access, public vault access, etc. For instance, the DSTN managing unit 18 tracks the number of times a user accesses a private vault and/or public vaults, which can be used to generate per-access billing information. In another instance, the DSTN managing unit 18 tracks the amount of data stored and/or retrieved by a user device and/or a user group, which can be used to generate per-data-amount billing information.
- Another DS management service includes the DSTN managing unit 18 performing network operations, network administration, and/or network maintenance.
- Network operations includes authenticating user data allocation requests (e.g., read and/or write requests), managing creation of vaults, establishing authentication credentials for user devices, adding/deleting components (e.g., user devices, DST execution units, and/or DST processing units) from the distributed computing system 10 , and/or establishing authentication credentials for DST execution units 36 .
- Network administration includes monitoring devices and/or units for failures, maintaining vault information, determining device and/or unit activation status, determining device and/or unit loading, and/or determining any other system level operation that affects the performance level of the system 10 .
- Network maintenance includes facilitating replacing, upgrading, repairing, and/or expanding a device and/or unit of the system 10 .
- the DST integrity processing unit 20 performs rebuilding of ‘bad’ (e.g., corrupted) or missing encoded data slices.
- the DST integrity processing unit 20 performs rebuilding by periodically attempting to retrieve/list encoded data slices, and/or slice names of the encoded data slices, from the DSTN module 22 . For retrieved encoded slices, they are checked for errors due to data corruption, outdated version, etc. If a slice includes an error, it is flagged as a ‘bad’ slice. For encoded data slices that were not received and/or not listed, they are flagged as missing slices.
- the rebuilt slices are stored in memory of the DSTN module 22 .
- the DST integrity processing unit 20 may be a separate unit as shown, it may be included in the DSTN module 22 , and it may be included in the DST processing unit 16 , and/or distributed among the DST execution units 36 .
- the distributed computing system 10 has two primary operations: DST (distributed storage and/or task processing) management and DST execution on received data (an example of which will be discussed with reference to FIGS. 3-19 ).
- DST distributed storage and/or task processing
- the DSTN managing unit 18 functions as previously described.
- the DSTN managing unit 18 performs distributed task processing (DTP) management services.
- DTP distributed task processing
- One such DTP management service includes the DSTN managing unit 18 establishing DTP parameters (e.g., user-vault affiliation information, billing information, user-task information, etc.) for a user device 12 - 14 individually or as part of a group of user devices.
- Another DTP management service includes the DSTN managing unit 18 performing DTP network operations, network administration (which is essentially the same as described above), and/or network maintenance (which is essentially the same as described above).
- Network operations include, but are not limited to, authenticating user task processing requests (e.g., valid request, valid user, etc.), authenticating results and/or partial results, establishing DTP authentication credentials for user devices, adding/deleting components (e.g., user devices, DST execution units, and/or DST processing units) from the distributed computing system, and/or establishing DTP authentication credentials for DST execution units.
- the distributed computing system 10 has two primary operations: DST (distributed storage and/or task) management and DST execution on stored data.
- DST distributed storage and/or task
- the DST execution on stored data if the second type of user device 14 has a task request 38 for execution by the DSTN module 22 , it sends the task request 38 to the DST processing unit 16 via its interface 30 .
- An example of DST execution on stored data will be discussed in greater detail with reference to FIGS. 27-39 .
- the DST management it is substantially similar to the DST management to support distributed task processing on received data.
- FIG. 2 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of a computing core 26 that includes a processing module 50 , a memory controller 52 , main memory 54 , a video graphics processing unit 55 , an input/output (IO) controller 56 , a peripheral component interconnect (PCI) interface 58 , an IO interface module 60 , at least one IO device interface module 62 , a read only memory (ROM) basic input output system (BIOS) 64 , and one or more memory interface modules.
- IO input/output
- PCI peripheral component interconnect
- IO interface module 60 at least one IO device interface module 62
- ROM read only memory
- BIOS basic input output system
- the one or more memory interface module(s) includes one or more of a universal serial bus (USB) interface module 66 , a host bus adapter (HBA) interface module 68 , a network interface module 70 , a flash interface module 72 , a hard drive interface module 74 , and a DSTN interface module 76 .
- USB universal serial bus
- HBA host bus adapter
- the DSTN interface module 76 functions to mimic a conventional operating system (OS) file system interface (e.g., network file system (NFS), flash file system (FFS), disk file system (DFS), file transfer protocol (FTP), web-based distributed authoring and versioning (WebDAV), etc.) and/or a block memory interface (e.g., small computer system interface (SCSI), internet small computer system interface (iSCSI), etc.).
- OS operating system
- the DSTN interface module 76 and/or the network interface module 70 may function as the interface 30 of the user device 14 of FIG. 1 .
- the IO device interface module 62 and/or the memory interface modules may be collectively or individually referred to as IO ports.
- FIG. 3 is a diagram of an example of the distributed computing system performing a distributed storage and task processing operation.
- the distributed computing system includes a DST (distributed storage and/or task) client module 34 (which may be in user device 14 and/or in DST processing unit 16 of FIG. 1 ), a network 24 , a plurality of DST execution units 1-n that includes two or more DST execution units 36 of FIG. 1 (which form at least a portion of DSTN module 22 of FIG. 1 ), a DST managing module (not shown), and a DST integrity verification module (not shown).
- the DST client module 34 includes an outbound DST processing section 80 and an inbound DST processing section 82 .
- Each of the DST execution units 1-n includes a controller 86 , a processing module 84 , memory 88 , a DT (distributed task) execution module 90 , and a DST client module 34 .
- the DST client module 34 receives data 92 and one or more tasks 94 to be performed upon the data 92 .
- the data 92 may be of any size and of any content, where, due to the size (e.g., greater than a few Terabytes), the content (e.g., secure data, etc.), and/or task(s) (e.g., MIPS intensive), distributed processing of the task(s) on the data is desired.
- the data 92 may be one or more digital books, a copy of a company's emails, a large-scale Internet search, a video security file, one or more entertainment video files (e.g., television programs, movies, etc.), data files, and/or any other large amount of data (e.g., greater than a few Terabytes).
- the outbound DST processing section 80 receives the data 92 and the task(s) 94 .
- the outbound DST processing section 80 processes the data 92 to produce slice groupings 96 .
- the outbound DST processing section 80 partitions the data 92 into a plurality of data partitions.
- the outbound DST processing section 80 dispersed storage (DS) error encodes the data partition to produce encoded data slices and groups the encoded data slices into a slice grouping 96 .
- the outbound DST processing section 80 partitions the task 94 into partial tasks 98 , where the number of partial tasks 98 may correspond to the number of slice groupings 96 .
- the outbound DST processing section 80 then sends, via the network 24 , the slice groupings 96 and the partial tasks 98 to the DST execution units 1-n of the DSTN module 22 of FIG. 1 .
- the outbound DST processing section 80 sends slice group 1 and partial task 1 to DST execution unit 1.
- the outbound DST processing section 80 sends slice group #n and partial task #n to DST execution unit #n.
- Each DST execution unit performs its partial task 98 upon its slice group 96 to produce partial results 102 .
- DST execution unit #1 performs partial task #1 on slice group #1 to produce a partial result #1, for results.
- slice group #1 corresponds to a data partition of a series of digital books and the partial task #1 corresponds to searching for specific phrases, recording where the phrase is found, and establishing a phrase count.
- the partial result #1 includes information as to where the phrase was found and includes the phrase count.
- the DST execution units Upon completion of generating their respective partial results 102 , the DST execution units send, via the network 24 , their partial results 102 to the inbound DST processing section 82 of the DST client module 34 .
- the inbound DST processing section 82 processes the received partial results 102 to produce a result 104 .
- the inbound DST processing section 82 combines the phrase count from each of the DST execution units 36 to produce a total phrase count.
- the inbound DST processing section 82 combines the ‘where the phrase was found’ information from each of the DST execution units 36 within their respective data partitions to produce ‘where the phrase was found’ information for the series of digital books.
- the DST client module 34 requests retrieval of stored data within the memory of the DST execution units 36 (e.g., memory of the DSTN module).
- the task 94 is retrieve data stored in the memory of the DSTN module.
- the outbound DST processing section 80 converts the task 94 into a plurality of partial tasks 98 and sends the partial tasks 98 to the respective DST execution units 1-n.
- a DST execution unit 36 In response to the partial task 98 of retrieving stored data, a DST execution unit 36 identifies the corresponding encoded data slices 100 and retrieves them. For example, DST execution unit #1 receives partial task #1 and retrieves, in response thereto, retrieved slices #1. The DST execution units 36 send their respective retrieved slices 100 to the inbound DST processing section 82 via the network 24 .
- the inbound DST processing section 82 converts the retrieved slices 100 into data 92 .
- the inbound DST processing section 82 de-groups the retrieved slices 100 to produce encoded slices per data partition.
- the inbound DST processing section 82 then DS error decodes the encoded slices per data partition to produce data partitions.
- the inbound DST processing section 82 de-partitions the data partitions to recapture the data 92 .
- FIG. 4 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of an outbound distributed storage and/or task (DST) processing section 80 of a DST client module 34 FIG. 1 coupled to a DSTN module 22 of a FIG. 1 (e.g., a plurality of n DST execution units 36 ) via a network 24 .
- the outbound DST processing section 80 includes a data partitioning module 110 , a dispersed storage (DS) error encoding module 112 , a grouping selector module 114 , a control module 116 , and a distributed task control module 118 .
- DS dispersed storage
- the data partitioning module 110 partitions data 92 into a plurality of data partitions 120 .
- the number of partitions and the size of the partitions may be selected by the control module 116 via control 160 based on the data 92 (e.g., its size, its content, etc.), a corresponding task 94 to be performed (e.g., simple, complex, single step, multiple steps, etc.), DS encoding parameters (e.g., pillar width, decode threshold, write threshold, segment security parameters, slice security parameters, etc.), capabilities of the DST execution units 36 (e.g., processing resources, availability of processing recourses, etc.), and/or as may be inputted by a user, system administrator, or other operator (human or automated).
- the data 92 e.g., its size, its content, etc.
- a corresponding task 94 to be performed e.g., simple, complex, single step, multiple steps, etc.
- DS encoding parameters e.g., pillar width, de
- the data partitioning module 110 partitions the data 92 (e.g., 100 Terabytes) into 100,000 data segments, each being 1 Gigabyte in size.
- the data partitioning module 110 partitions the data 92 into a plurality of data segments, where some of data segments are of a different size, are of the same size, or a combination thereof.
- the DS error encoding module 112 receives the data partitions 120 in a serial manner, a parallel manner, and/or a combination thereof. For each data partition 120 , the DS error encoding module 112 DS error encodes the data partition 120 in accordance with control information 160 from the control module 116 to produce encoded data slices 122 .
- the DS error encoding includes segmenting the data partition into data segments, segment security processing (e.g., encryption, compression, watermarking, integrity check (e.g., CRC), etc.), error encoding, slicing, and/or per slice security processing (e.g., encryption, compression, watermarking, integrity check (e.g., CRC), etc.).
- the control information 160 indicates which steps of the DS error encoding are active for a given data partition and, for active steps, indicates the parameters for the step.
- the control information 160 indicates that the error encoding is active and includes error encoding parameters (e.g., pillar width, decode threshold, write threshold, read threshold, type of error encoding, etc.).
- the grouping selector module 114 groups the encoded slices 122 of a data partition into a set of slice groupings 96 .
- the number of slice groupings corresponds to the number of DST execution units 36 identified for a particular task 94 . For example, if five DST execution units 36 are identified for the particular task 94 , the group selecting module groups the encoded slices 122 of a data partition into five slice groupings 96 .
- the grouping selector module 114 outputs the slice groupings 96 to the corresponding DST execution units 36 via the network 24 .
- the distributed task control module 118 receives the task 94 and converts the task 94 into a set of partial tasks 98 .
- the distributed task control module 118 receives a task to find where in the data (e.g., a series of books) a phrase occurs and a total count of the phrase usage in the data.
- the distributed task control module 118 replicates the task 94 for each DST execution unit 36 to produce the partial tasks 98 .
- the distributed task control module 118 receives a task to find where in the data a first phrase occurs, where in the data a second phrase occurs, and a total count for each phrase usage in the data.
- the distributed task control module 118 generates a first set of partial tasks 98 for finding and counting the first phase and a second set of partial tasks for finding and counting the second phrase.
- the distributed task control module 118 sends respective first and/or second partial tasks 98 to each DST execution unit 36 .
- FIG. 5 is a logic diagram of an example of a method for outbound distributed storage and task (DST) processing that begins at step 126 where a DST client module receives data and one or more corresponding tasks. The method continues at step 128 where the DST client module determines a number of DST units to support the task for one or more data partitions. For example, the DST client module may determine the number of DST units to support the task based on the size of the data, the requested task, the content of the data, a predetermined number (e.g., user indicated, system administrator determined, etc.), available DST units, capability of the DST units, and/or any other factor regarding distributed task processing of the data. The DST client module may select the same DST units for each data partition, may select different DST units for the data partitions, or a combination thereof.
- DST distributed storage and task
- the method continues at step 130 where the DST client module determines processing parameters of the data based on the number of DST units selected for distributed task processing.
- the processing parameters include data partitioning information, DS encoding parameters, and/or slice grouping information.
- the data partitioning information includes a number of data partitions, size of each data partition, and/or organization of the data partitions (e.g., number of data blocks in a partition, the size of the data blocks, and arrangement of the data blocks).
- the DS encoding parameters include segmenting information, segment security information, error encoding information (e.g., dispersed storage error encoding function parameters including one or more of pillar width, decode threshold, write threshold, read threshold, generator matrix), slicing information, and/or per slice security information.
- the slice grouping information includes information regarding how to arrange the encoded data slices into groups for the selected DST units. As a specific example, if the DST client module determines that five DST units are needed to support the task, then it determines that the error encoding parameters include a pillar width of five and a decode threshold of three.
- the method continues at step 132 where the DST client module determines task partitioning information (e.g., how to partition the tasks) based on the selected DST units and data processing parameters.
- the data processing parameters include the processing parameters and DST unit capability information.
- the DST unit capability information includes the number of DT (distributed task) execution units, execution capabilities of each DT execution unit (e.g., MIPS capabilities, processing resources (e.g., quantity and capability of microprocessors, CPUs, digital signal processors, co-processor, microcontrollers, arithmetic logic circuitry, and/or and the other analog and/or digital processing circuitry), availability of the processing resources, memory information (e.g., type, size, availability, etc.)), and/or any information germane to executing one or more tasks.
- MIPS distributed task
- processing resources e.g., quantity and capability of microprocessors, CPUs, digital signal processors, co-processor, microcontrollers, arithmetic logic circuitry, and
- the method continues at step 134 where the DST client module processes the data in accordance with the processing parameters to produce slice groupings.
- the method continues at step 136 where the DST client module partitions the task based on the task partitioning information to produce a set of partial tasks.
- the method continues at step 138 where the DST client module sends the slice groupings and the corresponding partial tasks to respective DST units.
- FIG. 6 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of the dispersed storage (DS) error encoding module 112 of an outbound distributed storage and task (DST) processing section.
- the DS error encoding module 112 includes a segment processing module 142 , a segment security processing module 144 , an error encoding module 146 , a slicing module 148 , and a per slice security processing module 150 . Each of these modules is coupled to a control module 116 to receive control information 160 therefrom.
- the segment processing module 142 receives a data partition 120 from a data partitioning module and receives segmenting information as the control information 160 from the control module 116 .
- the segmenting information indicates how the segment processing module 142 is to segment the data partition 120 .
- the segmenting information indicates how many rows to segment the data based on a decode threshold of an error encoding scheme, indicates how many columns to segment the data into based on a number and size of data blocks within the data partition 120 , and indicates how many columns to include in a data segment 152 .
- the segment processing module 142 segments the data 120 into data segments 152 in accordance with the segmenting information.
- the segment security processing module 144 when enabled by the control module 116 , secures the data segments 152 based on segment security information received as control information 160 from the control module 116 .
- the segment security information includes data compression, encryption, watermarking, integrity check (e.g., cyclic redundancy check (CRC), etc.), and/or any other type of digital security.
- CRC cyclic redundancy check
- the segment security processing module 144 when enabled, it may compress a data segment 152 , encrypt the compressed data segment, and generate a CRC value for the encrypted data segment to produce a secure data segment 154 .
- the segment security processing module 144 passes the data segments 152 to the error encoding module 146 or is bypassed such that the data segments 152 are provided to the error encoding module 146 .
- the error encoding module 146 encodes the secure data segments 154 in accordance with error correction encoding parameters received as control information 160 from the control module 116 .
- the error correction encoding parameters include identifying an error correction encoding scheme (e.g., forward error correction algorithm, a Reed-Solomon based algorithm, an online coding algorithm, an information dispersal algorithm, etc.), a pillar width, a decode threshold, a read threshold, a write threshold, etc.
- the error correction encoding parameters identify a specific error correction encoding scheme, specifies a pillar width of five, and specifies a decode threshold of three. From these parameters, the error encoding module 146 encodes a data segment 154 to produce an encoded data segment 156 .
- the slicing module 148 slices the encoded data segment 156 in accordance with the pillar width of the error correction encoding parameters received as control information 160 . For example, if the pillar width is five, the slicing module 148 slices an encoded data segment 156 into a set of five encoded data slices. As such, for a plurality of encoded data segments 156 for a given data partition, the slicing module outputs a plurality of sets of encoded data slices 158 .
- the per slice security processing module 150 when enabled by the control module 116 , secures each encoded data slice 158 based on slice security information received as control information 160 from the control module 116 .
- the slice security information includes data compression, encryption, watermarking, integrity check (e.g., CRC, etc.), and/or any other type of digital security.
- the per slice security processing module 150 when enabled, it compresses an encoded data slice 158 , encrypts the compressed encoded data slice, and generates a CRC value for the encrypted encoded data slice to produce a secure encoded data slice 122 .
- the per slice security processing module 150 When the per slice security processing module 150 is not enabled, it passes the encoded data slices 158 or is bypassed such that the encoded data slices 158 are the output of the DS error encoding module 112 . Note that the control module 116 may be omitted and each module stores its own parameters.
- FIG. 7 is a diagram of an example of a segment processing of a dispersed storage (DS) error encoding module.
- a segment processing module 142 receives a data partition 120 that includes 45 data blocks (e.g., d1-d45), receives segmenting information (i.e., control information 160 ) from a control module, and segments the data partition 120 in accordance with the control information 160 to produce data segments 152 .
- Each data block may be of the same size as other data blocks or of a different size.
- the size of each data block may be a few bytes to megabytes of data.
- the segmenting information indicates how many rows to segment the data partition into, indicates how many columns to segment the data partition into, and indicates how many columns to include in a data segment.
- the decode threshold of the error encoding scheme is three; as such the number of rows to divide the data partition into is three.
- the number of columns for each row is set to 15, which is based on the number and size of data blocks.
- the data blocks of the data partition are arranged in rows and columns in a sequential order (i.e., the first row includes the first 15 data blocks; the second row includes the second 15 data blocks; and the third row includes the last 15 data blocks).
- the data blocks arranged into the desired sequential order they are divided into data segments based on the segmenting information.
- the data partition is divided into 8 data segments; the first 7 include 2 columns of three rows and the last includes 1 column of three rows.
- the first row of the 8 data segments is in sequential order of the first 15 data blocks; the second row of the 8 data segments in sequential order of the second 15 data blocks; and the third row of the 8 data segments in sequential order of the last 15 data blocks.
- the number of data blocks, the grouping of the data blocks into segments, and size of the data blocks may vary to accommodate the desired distributed task processing function.
- FIG. 8 is a diagram of an example of error encoding and slicing processing of the dispersed error encoding processing the data segments of FIG. 7 .
- data segment 1 includes 3 rows with each row being treated as one word for encoding.
- data segment 1 includes three words for encoding: word 1 including data blocks d1 and d2, word 2 including data blocks d16 and d17, and word 3 including data blocks d31 and d32.
- Each of data segments 2-7 includes three words where each word includes two data blocks.
- Data segment 8 includes three words where each word includes a single data block (e.g., d15, d30, and d45).
- an error encoding module 146 and a slicing module 148 convert each data segment into a set of encoded data slices in accordance with error correction encoding parameters as control information 160 . More specifically, when the error correction encoding parameters indicate a unity matrix Reed-Solomon based encoding algorithm, 5 pillars, and decode threshold of 3, the first three encoded data slices of the set of encoded data slices for a data segment are substantially similar to the corresponding word of the data segment.
- the content of the first encoded data slice (DS1_d1&2) of the first set of encoded data slices is substantially similar to content of the first word (e.g., d1 & d2); the content of the second encoded data slice (DS1_d16&17) of the first set of encoded data slices is substantially similar to content of the second word (e.g., d16 & d17); and the content of the third encoded data slice (DS1_d31&32) of the first set of encoded data slices is substantially similar to content of the third word (e.g., d31 & d32).
- the content of the fourth and fifth encoded data slices (e.g., ES1 — 1 and ES1 — 2) of the first set of encoded data slices include error correction data based on the first-third words of the first data segment.
- the encoding and slices of data segments 2-7 yield sets of encoded data slices similar to the set of encoded data slices of data segment 1.
- the content of the first encoded data slice (DS2_d3&4) of the second set of encoded data slices is substantially similar to content of the first word (e.g., d3 & d4)
- the content of the second encoded data slice (DS2_d18&19) of the second set of encoded data slices is substantially similar to content of the second word (e.g., d18 & d19)
- the content of the third encoded data slice (DS2_d33&34) of the second set of encoded data slices is substantially similar to content of the third word (e.g., d33 & d34).
- the content of the fourth and fifth encoded data slices (e.g., ES1 — 1 and ES1 — 2) of the second set of encoded data slices includes error correction data based on the first-third words of the second data segment
- FIG. 9 is a diagram of an example of grouping selection processing of an outbound distributed storage and task (DST) processing in accordance with group selection information as control information 160 from a control module.
- Encoded slices for data partition 122 are grouped in accordance with the control information 160 to produce slice groupings 96 .
- a grouping selection module 114 organizes the encoded data slices into five slice groupings (e.g., one for each DST execution unit of a distributed storage and task network (DSTN) module).
- DSTN distributed storage and task network
- the grouping selection module 114 creates a first slice grouping for a DST execution unit #1, which includes first encoded slices of each of the sets of encoded slices.
- the first DST execution unit receives encoded data slices corresponding to data blocks 1-15 (e.g., encoded data slices of contiguous data).
- the grouping selection module 114 also creates a second slice grouping for a DST execution unit #2, which includes second encoded slices of each of the sets of encoded slices. As such, the second DST execution unit receives encoded data slices corresponding to data blocks 16-30.
- the grouping selection module 114 further creates a third slice grouping for DST execution unit #3, which includes third encoded slices of each of the sets of encoded slices. As such, the third DST execution unit receives encoded data slices corresponding to data blocks 31-45.
- the grouping selection module 114 creates a fourth slice grouping for DST execution unit #4, which includes fourth encoded slices of each of the sets of encoded slices. As such, the fourth DST execution unit receives encoded data slices corresponding to first error encoding information (e.g., encoded data slices of error coding (EC) data).
- the grouping selection module 114 further creates a fifth slice grouping for DST execution unit #5, which includes fifth encoded slices of each of the sets of encoded slices. As such, the fifth DST execution unit receives encoded data slices corresponding to second error encoding information.
- FIG. 10 is a diagram of an example of converting data 92 into slice groups that expands on the preceding figures.
- the data 92 is partitioned in accordance with a partitioning function 164 into a plurality of data partitions (1-x, where x is an integer greater than 4).
- Each data partition (or chunkset of data) is encoded and grouped into slice groupings as previously discussed by an encoding and grouping function 166 .
- the slice groupings are sent to distributed storage and task (DST) execution units. From data partition to data partition, the ordering of the slice groupings to the DST execution units may vary.
- DST distributed storage and task
- the slice groupings of data partition #1 is sent to the DST execution units such that the first DST execution receives first encoded data slices of each of the sets of encoded data slices, which corresponds to a first continuous data chunk of the first data partition (e.g., refer to FIG. 9 ), a second DST execution receives second encoded data slices of each of the sets of encoded data slices, which corresponds to a second continuous data chunk of the first data partition, etc.
- the slice groupings may be sent to the DST execution units in a different order than it was done for the first data partition.
- the first slice grouping of the second data partition e.g., slice group 2 — 1
- the second slice grouping of the second data partition e.g., slice group 2 — 2
- the third slice grouping of the second data partition e.g., slice group 2 — 3
- the fourth slice grouping of the second data partition e.g., slice group 2 — 4, which includes first error coding information
- the fifth slice grouping of the second data partition e.g., slice group 2 — 5, which includes second error coding information
- the pattern of sending the slice groupings to the set of DST execution units may vary in a predicted pattern, a random pattern, and/or a combination thereof from data partition to data partition.
- the set of DST execution units may change. For example, for the first data partition, DST execution units 1-5 may be used; for the second data partition, DST execution units 6-10 may be used; for the third data partition, DST execution units 3-7 may be used; etc.
- the task is divided into partial tasks that are sent to the DST execution units in conjunction with the slice groupings of the data partitions.
- FIG. 11 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of a DST (distributed storage and/or task) execution unit that includes an interface 169 , a controller 86 , memory 88 , one or more DT (distributed task) execution modules 90 , and a DST client module 34 .
- the memory 88 is of sufficient size to store a significant number of encoded data slices (e.g., thousands of slices to hundreds-of-millions of slices) and may include one or more hard drives and/or one or more solid-state memory devices (e.g., flash memory, DRAM, etc.).
- the DST execution module receives a slice grouping 96 (e.g., slice group #1) via interface 169 .
- the slice grouping 96 includes, per partition, encoded data slices of contiguous data or encoded data slices of error coding (EC) data.
- EC error coding
- the DST execution module receives encoded data slices of contiguous data for partitions #1 and #x (and potentially others between 3 and x) and receives encoded data slices of EC data for partitions #2 and #3 (and potentially others between 3 and x). Examples of encoded data slices of contiguous data and encoded data slices of error coding (EC) data are discussed with reference to FIG. 9 .
- the memory 88 stores the encoded data slices of slice groupings 96 in accordance with memory control information 174 it receives from the controller 86 .
- the controller 86 (e.g., a processing module, a CPU, etc.) generates the memory control information 174 based on a partial task(s) 98 and distributed computing information (e.g., user information (e.g., user ID, distributed computing permissions, data access permission, etc.), vault information (e.g., virtual memory assigned to user, user group, temporary storage for task processing, etc.), task validation information, etc.).
- distributed computing information e.g., user information (e.g., user ID, distributed computing permissions, data access permission, etc.), vault information (e.g., virtual memory assigned to user, user group, temporary storage for task processing, etc.), task validation information, etc.).
- the controller 86 interprets the partial task(s) 98 in light of the distributed computing information to determine whether a requestor is authorized to perform the task 98 , is authorized to access the data, and/or is authorized to perform the task on this particular data.
- the controller 86 determines, based on the task 98 and/or another input, whether the encoded data slices of the slice grouping 96 are to be temporarily stored or permanently stored. Based on the foregoing, the controller 86 generates the memory control information 174 to write the encoded data slices of the slice grouping 96 into the memory 88 and to indicate whether the slice grouping 96 is permanently stored or temporarily stored.
- the controller 86 facilitates execution of the partial task(s) 98 .
- the controller 86 interprets the partial task 98 in light of the capabilities of the DT execution module(s) 90 .
- the capabilities include one or more of MIPS capabilities, processing resources (e.g., quantity and capability of microprocessors, CPUs, digital signal processors, co-processor, microcontrollers, arithmetic logic circuitry, and/or any other analog and/or digital processing circuitry), availability of the processing resources, etc. If the controller 86 determines that the DT execution module(s) 90 have sufficient capabilities, it generates task control information 176 .
- the task control information 176 may be a generic instruction (e.g., perform the task on the stored slice grouping) or a series of operational codes.
- the DT execution module 90 includes a co-processor function specifically configured (fixed or programmed) to perform the desired task 98 .
- the DT execution module 90 includes a general processor topology where the controller stores an algorithm corresponding to the particular task 98 .
- the controller 86 provides the operational codes (e.g., assembly language, source code of a programming language, object code, etc.) of the algorithm to the DT execution module 90 for execution.
- the DT execution module 90 may generate intermediate partial results 102 that are stored in the memory 88 or in a cache memory (not shown) within the DT execution module 90 . In either case, when the DT execution module 90 completes execution of the partial task 98 , it outputs one or more partial results 102 .
- the partial results 102 may also be stored in memory 88 .
- the controller 86 determines that the DT execution module(s) 90 cannot adequately support the task 98 (e.g., does not have the right resources, does not have sufficient available resources, available resources would be too slow, etc.), it then determines whether the partial task 98 should be fully offloaded or partially offloaded.
- the controller 86 determines that the partial task 98 should be fully offloaded, it generates DST control information 178 and provides it to the DST client module 34 .
- the DST control information 178 includes the partial task 98 , memory storage information regarding the slice grouping 96 , and distribution instructions.
- the distribution instructions instruct the DST client module 34 to divide the partial task 98 into sub-partial tasks 172 , to divide the slice grouping 96 into sub-slice groupings 170 , and identify other DST execution units.
- the DST client module 34 functions in a similar manner as the DST client module 34 of FIGS. 3-10 to produce the sub-partial tasks 172 and the sub-slice groupings 170 in accordance with the distribution instructions.
- the DST client module 34 receives DST feedback 168 (e.g., sub-partial results), via the interface 169 , from the DST execution units to which the task was offloaded.
- the DST client module 34 provides the sub-partial results to the DST execution unit, which processes the sub-partial results to produce the partial result(s) 102 .
- the controller 86 determines that the partial task 98 should be partially offloaded, it determines what portion of the task 98 and/or slice grouping 96 should be processed locally and what should be offloaded. For the portion that is being locally processed, the controller 86 generates task control information 176 as previously discussed. For the portion that is being offloaded, the controller 86 generates DST control information 178 as previously discussed.
- the DST client module 34 When the DST client module 34 receives DST feedback 168 (e.g., sub-partial results) from the DST executions units to which a portion of the task was offloaded, it provides the sub-partial results to the DT execution module 90 .
- the DT execution module 90 processes the sub-partial results with the sub-partial results it created to produce the partial result(s) 102 .
- the memory 88 may be further utilized to retrieve one or more of stored slices 100 , stored results 104 , and partial results 102 when the DT execution module 90 stores partial results 102 and/or results 104 and the memory 88 .
- the controller 86 outputs the memory control 174 to the memory 88 to facilitate retrieval of slices 100 and/or results 104 .
- FIG. 12 is a schematic block diagram of an example of operation of a distributed storage and task (DST) execution unit storing encoded data slices and executing a task thereon.
- DST distributed storage and task
- a controller 86 To store the encoded data slices of a partition 1 of slice grouping 1 , a controller 86 generates write commands as memory control information 174 such that the encoded slices are stored in desired locations (e.g., permanent or temporary) within memory 88 .
- the controller 86 provides task control information 176 to a distributed task (DT) execution module 90 .
- DT distributed task
- the DT execution module 90 retrieves the encoded slices from memory 88 .
- the DT execution module 90 then reconstructs contiguous data blocks of a data partition. As shown for this example, reconstructed contiguous data blocks of data partition 1 include data blocks 1-15 (e.g., d1-d15).
- the DT execution module 90 performs the task on the reconstructed contiguous data blocks.
- the task may be to search the reconstructed contiguous data blocks for a particular word or phrase, identify where in the reconstructed contiguous data blocks the particular word or phrase occurred, and/or count the occurrences of the particular word or phrase on the reconstructed contiguous data blocks.
- the DST execution unit continues in a similar manner for the encoded data slices of other partitions in slice grouping 1. Note that with using the unity matrix error encoding scheme previously discussed, if the encoded data slices of contiguous data are uncorrupted, the decoding of them is a relatively straightforward process of extracting the data.
- an encoded data slice of contiguous data is corrupted (or missing)
- it can be rebuilt by accessing other DST execution units that are storing the other encoded data slices of the set of encoded data slices of the corrupted encoded data slice.
- the DST execution unit having the corrupted encoded data slices retrieves at least three encoded data slices (of contiguous data and of error coding data) in the set from the other DST execution units (recall for this example, the pillar width is 5 and the decode threshold is 3).
- the DST execution unit decodes the retrieved data slices using the DS error encoding parameters to recapture the corresponding data segment.
- the DST execution unit then re-encodes the data segment using the DS error encoding parameters to rebuild the corrupted encoded data slice. Once the encoded data slice is rebuilt, the DST execution unit functions as previously described.
- FIG. 13 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of an inbound distributed storage and/or task (DST) processing section 82 of a DST client module coupled to DST execution units of a distributed storage and task network (DSTN) module via a network 24 .
- the inbound DST processing section 82 includes a de-grouping module 180 , a DS (dispersed storage) error decoding module 182 , a data de-partitioning module 184 , a control module 186 , and a distributed task control module 188 .
- the control module 186 and/or the distributed task control module 188 may be separate modules from corresponding ones of outbound DST processing section or may be the same modules.
- the DST execution units have completed execution of corresponding partial tasks on the corresponding slice groupings to produce partial results 102 .
- the inbound DST processing section 82 receives the partial results 102 via the distributed task control module 188 .
- the inbound DST processing section 82 then processes the partial results 102 to produce a final result, or results 104 .
- the partial results 102 indicate where in each of the prescribed portions of the data the corresponding DST execution units found the specific word or phrase.
- the distributed task control module 188 combines the individual partial results 102 for the corresponding portions of the data into a final result 104 for the data as a whole.
- the inbound DST processing section 82 is retrieving stored data from the DST execution units (i.e., the DSTN module).
- the DST execution units output encoded data slices 100 corresponding to the data retrieval requests.
- the de-grouping module 180 receives retrieved slices 100 and de-groups them to produce encoded data slices per data partition 122 .
- the DS error decoding module 182 decodes, in accordance with DS error encoding parameters, the encoded data slices per data partition 122 to produce data partitions 120 .
- the data de-partitioning module 184 combines the data partitions 120 into the data 92 .
- the control module 186 controls the conversion of retrieve slices 100 into the data 92 using control signals 190 to each of the modules. For instance, the control module 186 provides de-grouping information to the de-grouping module 180 , provides the DS error encoding parameters to the DS error decoding module 182 , and provides de-partitioning information to the data de-partitioning module 184 .
- FIG. 14 is a logic diagram of an example of a method that is executable by distributed storage and task (DST) client module regarding inbound DST processing.
- the method begins at step 194 where the DST client module receives partial results.
- the method continues at step 196 where the DST client module retrieves the task corresponding to the partial results.
- the partial results include header information that identifies the requesting entity, which correlates to the requested task.
- step 198 the DST client module determines result processing information based on the task. For example, if the task were to identify a particular word or phrase within the data, the result processing information would indicate to aggregate the partial results for the corresponding portions of the data to produce the final result. As another example, if the task were to count the occurrences of a particular word or phrase within the data, results of processing the information would indicate to add the partial results to produce the final results.
- step 200 the DST client module processes the partial results in accordance with the result processing information to produce the final result or results.
- FIG. 15 is a diagram of an example of de-grouping selection processing of an inbound distributed storage and task (DST) processing section of a DST client module.
- this is an inverse process of the grouping module of the outbound DST processing section of FIG. 9 .
- the de-grouping module retrieves the corresponding slice grouping from the DST execution units (EU) (e.g., DST 1-5).
- EU DST execution units
- DST execution unit #1 provides a first slice grouping, which includes the first encoded slices of each of the sets of encoded slices (e.g., encoded data slices of contiguous data of data blocks 1-15); DST execution unit #2 provides a second slice grouping, which includes the second encoded slices of each of the sets of encoded slices (e.g., encoded data slices of contiguous data of data blocks 16-30); DST execution unit #3 provides a third slice grouping, which includes the third encoded slices of each of the sets of encoded slices (e.g., encoded data slices of contiguous data of data blocks 31-45); DST execution unit #4 provides a fourth slice grouping, which includes the fourth encoded slices of each of the sets of encoded slices (e.g., first encoded data slices of error coding (EC) data); and DST execution unit #5 provides a fifth slice grouping, which includes the fifth encoded slices of each of the sets of encoded slices (e.g., first encoded data slices of error coding (EC) data).
- the de-grouping module de-groups the slice groupings (e.g., received slices 100 ) using a de-grouping selector 180 controlled by a control signal 190 as shown in the example to produce a plurality of sets of encoded data slices (e.g., retrieved slices for a partition into sets of slices 122 ). Each set corresponding to a data segment of the data partition.
- FIG. 16 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of a dispersed storage (DS) error decoding module 182 of an inbound distributed storage and task (DST) processing section.
- the DS error decoding module 182 includes an inverse per slice security processing module 202 , a de-slicing module 204 , an error decoding module 206 , an inverse segment security module 208 , a de-segmenting processing module 210 , and a control module 186 .
- the inverse per slice security processing module 202 when enabled by the control module 186 , unsecures each encoded data slice 122 based on slice de-security information received as control information 190 (e.g., the compliment of the slice security information discussed with reference to FIG. 6 ) received from the control module 186 .
- the slice security information includes data decompression, decryption, de-watermarking, integrity check (e.g., CRC verification, etc.), and/or any other type of digital security.
- the inverse per slice security processing module 202 when the inverse per slice security processing module 202 is enabled, it verifies integrity information (e.g., a CRC value) of each encoded data slice 122 , it decrypts each verified encoded data slice, and decompresses each decrypted encoded data slice to produce slice encoded data 158 .
- integrity information e.g., a CRC value
- the inverse per slice security processing module 202 passes the encoded data slices 122 as the sliced encoded data 158 or is bypassed such that the retrieved encoded data slices 122 are provided as the sliced encoded data 158 .
- the de-slicing module 204 de-slices the sliced encoded data 158 into encoded data segments 156 in accordance with a pillar width of the error correction encoding parameters received as control information 190 from the control module 186 . For example, if the pillar width is five, the de-slicing module 204 de-slices a set of five encoded data slices into an encoded data segment 156 .
- the error decoding module 206 decodes the encoded data segments 156 in accordance with error correction decoding parameters received as control information 190 from the control module 186 to produce secure data segments 154 .
- the error correction decoding parameters include identifying an error correction encoding scheme (e.g., forward error correction algorithm, a Reed-Solomon based algorithm, an information dispersal algorithm, etc.), a pillar width, a decode threshold, a read threshold, a write threshold, etc.
- an error correction encoding scheme e.g., forward error correction algorithm, a Reed-Solomon based algorithm, an information dispersal algorithm, etc.
- the error correction decoding parameters identify a specific error correction encoding scheme, specify a pillar width of five, and specify a decode threshold of three.
- the inverse segment security processing module 208 when enabled by the control module 186 , unsecures the secured data segments 154 based on segment security information received as control information 190 from the control module 186 .
- the segment security information includes data decompression, decryption, de-watermarking, integrity check (e.g., CRC, etc.) verification, and/or any other type of digital security.
- integrity information e.g., a CRC value
- the inverse segment security processing module 208 passes the decoded data segment 154 as the data segment 152 or is bypassed.
- the de-segment processing module 210 receives the data segments 152 and receives de-segmenting information as control information 190 from the control module 186 .
- the de-segmenting information indicates how the de-segment processing module 210 is to de-segment the data segments 152 into a data partition 120 .
- the de-segmenting information indicates how the rows and columns of data segments are to be rearranged to yield the data partition 120 .
- FIG. 17 is a diagram of an example of de-slicing and error decoding processing of a dispersed error decoding module.
- a de-slicing module 204 receives at least a decode threshold number of encoded data slices 158 for each data segment in accordance with control information 190 and provides encoded data 156 .
- a decode threshold is three.
- each set of encoded data slices 158 is shown to have three encoded data slices per data segment.
- the de-slicing module 204 may receive three encoded data slices per data segment because an associated distributed storage and task (DST) client module requested retrieving only three encoded data slices per segment or selected three of the retrieved encoded data slices per data segment.
- DST distributed storage and task
- an encoded data slice may be a data-based encoded data slice (e.g., DS1_d1&d2) or an error code based encoded data slice (e.g., ES3 — 1).
- An error decoding module 206 decodes the encoded data 156 of each data segment in accordance with the error correction decoding parameters of control information 190 to produce secured segments 154 .
- data segment 1 includes 3 rows with each row being treated as one word for encoding.
- data segment 1 includes three words: word 1 including data blocks d1 and d2, word 2 including data blocks d16 and d17, and word 3 including data blocks d31 and d32.
- Each of data segments 2-7 includes three words where each word includes two data blocks.
- Data segment 8 includes three words where each word includes a single data block (e.g., d15, d30, and d45).
- FIG. 18 is a diagram of an example of a de-segment processing of an inbound distributed storage and task (DST) processing.
- a de-segment processing module 210 receives data segments 152 (e.g., 1-8) and rearranges the data blocks of the data segments into rows and columns in accordance with de-segmenting information of control information 190 to produce a data partition 120 .
- data segments 152 e.g., 1-8
- de-segmenting information of control information 190 e.g., control information 190
- the number of rows is based on the decode threshold (e.g., 3 in this specific example) and the number of columns is based on the number and size of the data blocks.
- the de-segmenting module 210 converts the rows and columns of data blocks into the data partition 120 .
- each data block may be of the same size as other data blocks or of a different size.
- the size of each data block may be a few bytes to megabytes of data.
- FIG. 19 is a diagram of an example of converting slice groups into data 92 within an inbound distributed storage and task (DST) processing section.
- the data 92 is reconstructed from a plurality of data partitions (1-x, where x is an integer greater than 4).
- Each data partition (or chunk set of data) is decoded and re-grouped using a de-grouping and decoding function 212 and a de-partition function 214 from slice groupings as previously discussed.
- the slice groupings e.g., at least a decode threshold per data segment of encoded data slices
- the ordering of the slice groupings received from the DST execution units may vary as discussed with reference to FIG. 10 .
- FIG. 20 is a diagram of an example of a distributed storage and/or retrieval within the distributed computing system.
- the distributed computing system includes a plurality of distributed storage and/or task (DST) processing client modules 34 (one shown) coupled to a distributed storage and/or task processing network (DSTN) module, or multiple DSTN modules, via a network 24 .
- the DST client module 34 includes an outbound DST processing section 80 and an inbound DST processing section 82 .
- the DSTN module includes a plurality of DST execution units. Each DST execution unit includes a controller 86 , memory 88 , one or more distributed task (DT) execution modules 90 , and a DST client module 34 .
- DT distributed task
- the DST client module 34 has data 92 that it desires to store in the DSTN module.
- the data 92 may be a file (e.g., video, audio, text, graphics, etc.), a data object, a data block, an update to a file, an update to a data block, etc.
- the outbound DST processing module 80 converts the data 92 into encoded data slices 216 as will be further described with reference to FIGS. 21-23 .
- the outbound DST processing module 80 sends, via the network 24 , to the DST execution units for storage as further described with reference to FIG. 24 .
- the DST client module 34 issues a retrieve request to the DST execution units for the desired data 92 .
- the retrieve request may address each DST executions units storing encoded data slices of the desired data, address a decode threshold number of DST execution units, address a read threshold number of DST execution units, or address some other number of DST execution units.
- each addressed DST execution unit retrieves its encoded data slices 100 of the desired data and sends them to the inbound DST processing section 82 , via the network 24 .
- the inbound DST processing section 82 When, for each data segment, the inbound DST processing section 82 receives at least a decode threshold number of encoded data slices 100 , it converts the encoded data slices 100 into a data segment. The inbound DST processing section 82 aggregates the data segments to produce the retrieved data 92 .
- FIG. 21 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of an outbound distributed storage and/or task (DST) processing section 80 of a DST client module coupled to a distributed storage and task network (DSTN) module (e.g., a plurality of DST execution units) via a network 24 .
- the outbound DST processing section 80 includes a data partitioning module 110 , a dispersed storage (DS) error encoding module 112 , a grouping selector module 114 , a control module 116 , and a distributed task control module 118 .
- DS dispersed storage
- the data partitioning module 110 is by-passed such that data 92 is provided directly to the DS error encoding module 112 .
- the control module 116 coordinates the by-passing of the data partitioning module 110 by outputting a bypass 220 message to the data partitioning module 110 .
- the DS error encoding module 112 receives the data 92 in a serial manner, a parallel manner, and/or a combination thereof.
- the DS error encoding module 112 DS error encodes the data in accordance with control information 160 from the control module 116 to produce encoded data slices 218 .
- the DS error encoding includes segmenting the data 92 into data segments, segment security processing (e.g., encryption, compression, watermarking, integrity check (e.g., CRC, etc.)), error encoding, slicing, and/or per slice security processing (e.g., encryption, compression, watermarking, integrity check (e.g., CRC, etc.)).
- the control information 160 indicates which steps of the DS error encoding are active for the data 92 and, for active steps, indicates the parameters for the step.
- the control information 160 indicates that the error encoding is active and includes error encoding parameters (e.g., pillar width, decode threshold, write threshold, read threshold, type of error encoding, etc.).
- the grouping selector module 114 groups the encoded slices 218 of the data segments into pillars of slices 216 .
- the number of pillars corresponds to the pillar width of the DS error encoding parameters.
- the distributed task control module 118 facilitates the storage request.
- FIG. 22 is a schematic block diagram of an example of a dispersed storage (DS) error encoding module 112 for the example of FIG. 21 .
- the DS error encoding module 112 includes a segment processing module 142 , a segment security processing module 144 , an error encoding module 146 , a slicing module 148 , and a per slice security processing module 150 . Each of these modules is coupled to a control module 116 to receive control information 160 therefrom.
- the segment processing module 142 receives data 92 and receives segmenting information as control information 160 from the control module 116 .
- the segmenting information indicates how the segment processing module is to segment the data. For example, the segmenting information indicates the size of each data segment.
- the segment processing module 142 segments the data 92 into data segments 152 in accordance with the segmenting information.
- the segment security processing module 144 when enabled by the control module 116 , secures the data segments 152 based on segment security information received as control information 160 from the control module 116 .
- the segment security information includes data compression, encryption, watermarking, integrity check (e.g., CRC, etc.), and/or any other type of digital security.
- CRC integrity check
- the segment security processing module 144 when enabled, it compresses a data segment 152 , encrypts the compressed data segment, and generates a CRC value for the encrypted data segment to produce a secure data segment.
- the segment security processing module 144 passes the data segments 152 to the error encoding module 146 or is bypassed such that the data segments 152 are provided to the error encoding module 146 .
- the error encoding module 146 encodes the secure data segments in accordance with error correction encoding parameters received as control information 160 from the control module 116 .
- the error correction encoding parameters include identifying an error correction encoding scheme (e.g., forward error correction algorithm, a Reed-Solomon based algorithm, an information dispersal algorithm, etc.), a pillar width, a decode threshold, a read threshold, a write threshold, etc.
- the error correction encoding parameters identify a specific error correction encoding scheme, specifies a pillar width of five, and specifies a decode threshold of three. From these parameters, the error encoding module 146 encodes a data segment to produce an encoded data segment.
- the slicing module 148 slices the encoded data segment in accordance with a pillar width of the error correction encoding parameters. For example, if the pillar width is five, the slicing module slices an encoded data segment into a set of five encoded data slices. As such, for a plurality of data segments, the slicing module 148 outputs a plurality of sets of encoded data slices as shown within encoding and slicing function 222 as described.
- the per slice security processing module 150 when enabled by the control module 116 , secures each encoded data slice based on slice security information received as control information 160 from the control module 116 .
- the slice security information includes data compression, encryption, watermarking, integrity check (e.g., CRC, etc.), and/or any other type of digital security.
- the per slice security processing module 150 when enabled, it may compress an encoded data slice, encrypt the compressed encoded data slice, and generate a CRC value for the encrypted encoded data slice to produce a secure encoded data slice tweaking.
- the per slice security processing module 150 passes the encoded data slices or is bypassed such that the encoded data slices 218 are the output of the DS error encoding module 112 .
- FIG. 23 is a diagram of an example of converting data 92 into pillar slice groups utilizing encoding, slicing and pillar grouping function 224 for storage in memory of a distributed storage and task network (DSTN) module.
- DSTN distributed storage and task network
- the data 92 is encoded and sliced into a plurality of sets of encoded data slices; one set per data segment.
- the grouping selection module organizes the sets of encoded data slices into pillars of data slices.
- the DS error encoding parameters include a pillar width of 5 and a decode threshold of 3. As such, for each data segment, 5 encoded data slices are created.
- the grouping selection module takes the first encoded data slice of each of the sets and forms a first pillar, which may be sent to the first DST execution unit. Similarly, the grouping selection module creates the second pillar from the second slices of the sets; the third pillar from the third slices of the sets; the fourth pillar from the fourth slices of the sets; and the fifth pillar from the fifth slices of the set.
- FIG. 24 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of a distributed storage and/or task (DST) execution unit that includes an interface 169 , a controller 86 , memory 88 , one or more distributed task (DT) execution modules 90 , and a DST client module 34 .
- a computing core 26 may be utilized to implement the one or more DT execution modules 90 and the DST client module 34 .
- the memory 88 is of sufficient size to store a significant number of encoded data slices (e.g., thousands of slices to hundreds-of-millions of slices) and may include one or more hard drives and/or one or more solid-state memory devices (e.g., flash memory, DRAM, etc.).
- the DST execution unit receives, via interface 169 , a pillar of slices 216 (e.g., pillar #1 slices).
- the memory 88 stores the encoded data slices 216 of the pillar of slices in accordance with memory control information 174 it receives from the controller 86 .
- the controller 86 e.g., a processing module, a CPU, etc.
- the controller 86 generates the memory control information 174 based on distributed storage information (e.g., user information (e.g., user ID, distributed storage permissions, data access permission, etc.), vault information (e.g., virtual memory assigned to user, user group, etc.), etc.).
- the DST execution unit receives, via interface 169 , a slice retrieval request.
- the memory 88 retrieves the slice in accordance with memory control information 174 it receives from the controller 86 .
- the memory 88 outputs the slice 100 , via the interface 169 , to a requesting entity.
- FIG. 25 is a schematic block diagram of an example of operation of an inbound distributed storage and/or task (DST) processing section 82 for retrieving dispersed error encoded data 92 .
- the inbound DST processing section 82 includes a de-grouping module 180 , a dispersed storage (DS) error decoding module 182 , a data de-partitioning module 184 , a control module 186 , and a distributed task control module 188 .
- the control module 186 and/or the distributed task control module 188 may be separate modules from corresponding ones of an outbound DST processing section or may be the same modules.
- the inbound DST processing section 82 is retrieving stored data 92 from the DST execution units (i.e., the DSTN module).
- the DST execution units output encoded data slices corresponding to data retrieval requests from the distributed task control module 188 .
- the de-grouping module 180 receives pillars of slices 100 and de-groups them in accordance with control information 190 from the control module 186 to produce sets of encoded data slices 218 .
- the DS error decoding module 182 decodes, in accordance with the DS error encoding parameters received as control information 190 from the control module 186 , each set of encoded data slices 218 to produce data segments, which are aggregated into retrieved data 92 .
- the data de-partitioning module 184 is by-passed in this operational mode via a bypass signal 226 of control information 190 from the control module 186 .
- FIG. 26 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of a dispersed storage (DS) error decoding module 182 of an inbound distributed storage and task (DST) processing section.
- the DS error decoding module 182 includes an inverse per slice security processing module 202 , a de-slicing module 204 , an error decoding module 206 , an inverse segment security module 208 , and a de-segmenting processing module 210 .
- the dispersed error decoding module 182 is operable to de-slice and decode encoded slices per data segment 218 utilizing a de-slicing and decoding function 228 to produce a plurality of data segments that are de-segmented utilizing a de-segment function 230 to recover data 92 .
- the inverse per slice security processing module 202 when enabled by the control module 186 via control information 190 , unsecures each encoded data slice 218 based on slice de-security information (e.g., the compliment of the slice security information discussed with reference to FIG. 6 ) received as control information 190 from the control module 186 .
- slice de-security information includes data decompression, decryption, de-watermarking, integrity check (e.g., CRC verification, etc.), and/or any other type of digital security.
- the inverse per slice security processing module 202 when the inverse per slice security processing module 202 is enabled, it verifies integrity information (e.g., a CRC value) of each encoded data slice 218 , it decrypts each verified encoded data slice, and decompresses each decrypted encoded data slice to produce slice encoded data.
- integrity information e.g., a CRC value
- the inverse per slice security processing module 202 passes the encoded data slices 218 as the sliced encoded data or is bypassed such that the retrieved encoded data slices 218 are provided as the sliced encoded data.
- the de-slicing module 204 de-slices the sliced encoded data into encoded data segments in accordance with a pillar width of the error correction encoding parameters received as control information 190 from a control module 186 . For example, if the pillar width is five, the de-slicing module de-slices a set of five encoded data slices into an encoded data segment. Alternatively, the encoded data segment may include just three encoded data slices (e.g., when the decode threshold is 3).
- the error decoding module 206 decodes the encoded data segments in accordance with error correction decoding parameters received as control information 190 from the control module 186 to produce secure data segments.
- the error correction decoding parameters include identifying an error correction encoding scheme (e.g., forward error correction algorithm, a Reed-Solomon based algorithm, an information dispersal algorithm, etc.), a pillar width, a decode threshold, a read threshold, a write threshold, etc.
- the error correction decoding parameters identify a specific error correction encoding scheme, specify a pillar width of five, and specify a decode threshold of three.
- the inverse segment security processing module 208 when enabled by the control module 186 , unsecures the secured data segments based on segment security information received as control information 190 from the control module 186 .
- the segment security information includes data decompression, decryption, de-watermarking, integrity check (e.g., CRC, etc.) verification, and/or any other type of digital security.
- integrity information e.g., a CRC value
- it verifies integrity information (e.g., a CRC value) of each secure data segment, it decrypts each verified secured data segment, and decompresses each decrypted secure data segment to produce a data segment 152 .
- the inverse segment security processing module 208 When the inverse segment security processing module 208 is not enabled, it passes the decoded data segment 152 as the data segment or is bypassed.
- the de-segmenting processing module 210 aggregates the data segments 152 into the data 92 in accordance with control information 190 from the control module 186 .
- FIG. 27 is a schematic block diagram of an example of a distributed storage and task processing network (DSTN) module that includes a plurality of distributed storage and task (DST) execution units (#1 through #n, where, for example, n is an integer greater than or equal to three).
- DST distributed storage and task
- Each of the DST execution units includes a DST client module 34 , a controller 86 , one or more DT (distributed task) execution modules 90 , and memory 88 .
- the DSTN module stores, in the memory of the DST execution units, a plurality of DS (dispersed storage) encoded data (e.g., 1 through n, where n is an integer greater than or equal to two) and stores a plurality of DS encoded task codes (e.g., 1 through k, where k is an integer greater than or equal to two).
- the DS encoded data may be encoded in accordance with one or more examples described with reference to FIGS. 3-19 (e.g., organized in slice groupings) or encoded in accordance with one or more examples described with reference to FIGS. 20-26 (e.g., organized in pillar groups).
- the data that is encoded into the DS encoded data may be of any size and/or of any content.
- the data may be one or more digital books, a copy of a company's emails, a large-scale Internet search, a video security file, one or more entertainment video files (e.g., television programs, movies, etc.), data files, and/or any other large amount of data (e.g., greater than a few Terabytes).
- the tasks that are encoded into the DS encoded task code may be a simple function (e.g., a mathematical function, a logic function, an identify function, a find function, a search engine function, a replace function, etc.), a complex function (e.g., compression, human and/or computer language translation, text-to-voice conversion, voice-to-text conversion, etc.), multiple simple and/or complex functions, one or more algorithms, one or more applications, etc.
- the tasks may be encoded into the DS encoded task code in accordance with one or more examples described with reference to FIGS. 3-19 (e.g., organized in slice groupings) or encoded in accordance with one or more examples described with reference to FIGS. 20-26 (e.g., organized in pillar groups).
- a DST client module of a user device or of a DST processing unit issues a DST request to the DSTN module.
- the DST request may include a request to retrieve stored data, or a portion thereof, may include a request to store data that is included with the DST request, may include a request to perform one or more tasks on stored data, may include a request to perform one or more tasks on data included with the DST request, etc.
- the client module and/or the DSTN module processes the request as previously discussed with reference to one or more of FIGS. 3-19 (e.g., slice groupings) and/or 20 - 26 (e.g., pillar groupings).
- the DST client module and/or the DSTN module process the DST request as previously discussed with reference to one or more of FIGS. 3-19 .
- the DST client module and/or the DSTN module processes the DST request as will be described with reference to one or more of FIGS. 28-39 .
- the DST client module identifies data and one or more tasks for the DSTN module to execute upon the identified data.
- the DST request may be for a one-time execution of the task or for an on-going execution of the task.
- the DST request may be to daily search new emails for inappropriate content and, if found, record the content, the email sender(s), the email recipient(s), email routing information, notify human resources of the identified email, etc.
- FIG. 28 is a schematic block diagram of an example of a distributed computing system performing tasks on stored data.
- two distributed storage and task (DST) client modules 1-2 are shown: the first may be associated with a user device and the second may be associated with a DST processing unit or a high priority user device (e.g., high priority clearance user, system administrator, etc.).
- Each DST client module includes a list of stored data 234 and a list of tasks codes 236 .
- the list of stored data 234 includes one or more entries of data identifying information, where each entry identifies data stored in the DSTN module 22 .
- the data identifying information includes one or more of a data file name, a data file directory listing, DSTN addressing information of the data, a data object identifier, etc.
- the list of tasks 236 includes one or more entries of task code identifying information, when each entry identifies task codes stored in the DSTN module 22 .
- the task code identifying information includes one or more of a task file name, a task file directory listing, DSTN addressing information of the task, another type of identifier to identify the task, etc.
- the list of data 234 and the list of tasks 236 are each smaller in number of entries for the first DST client module than the corresponding lists of the second DST client module. This may occur because the user device associated with the first DST client module has fewer privileges in the distributed computing system than the device associated with the second DST client module. Alternatively, this may occur because the user device associated with the first DST client module serves fewer users than the device associated with the second DST client module and is restricted by the distributed computing system accordingly. As yet another alternative, this may occur through no restraints by the distributed computing system, it just occurred because the operator of the user device associated with the first DST client module has selected fewer data and/or fewer tasks than the operator of the device associated with the second DST client module.
- the first DST client module selects one or more data entries 238 and one or more tasks 240 from its respective lists (e.g., selected data ID and selected task ID).
- the first DST client module sends its selections to a task distribution module 232 .
- the task distribution module 232 may be within a stand-alone device of the distributed computing system, may be within the user device that contains the first DST client module, or may be within the DSTN module 22 .
- the task distribution module 232 sends the DST allocation information 242 to the DSTN module 22 . Note that one or more examples of the DST allocation information will be discussed with reference to one or more of FIGS. 29-39 .
- the DSTN module 22 interprets the DST allocation information 242 to identify the stored DS encoded data (e.g., DS error encoded data 2) and to identify the stored DS error encoded task code (e.g., DS error encoded task code 1). In addition, the DSTN module 22 interprets the DST allocation information 242 to determine how the data is to be partitioned and how the task is to be partitioned. The DSTN module 22 also determines whether the selected DS error encoded data 238 needs to be converted from pillar grouping to slice grouping.
- the DSTN module 22 converts the selected DS error encoded data into slice groupings and stores the slice grouping DS error encoded data by overwriting the pillar grouping DS error encoded data or by storing it in a different location in the memory of the DSTN module 22 (i.e., does not overwrite the pillar grouping DS encoded data).
- the DSTN module 22 partitions the data and the task as indicated in the DST allocation information 242 and sends the portions to selected DST execution units of the DSTN module 22 . Each of the selected DST execution units performs its partial task(s) on its slice groupings to produce partial results.
- the DSTN module 22 collects the partial results from the selected DST execution units and provides them, as result information 244 , to the task distribution module.
- the result information 244 may be the collected partial results, one or more final results as produced by the DSTN module 22 from processing the partial results in accordance with the DST allocation information 242 , or one or more intermediate results as produced by the DSTN module 22 from processing the partial results in accordance with the DST allocation information 242 .
- the task distribution module 232 receives the result information 244 and provides one or more final results 104 therefrom to the first DST client module.
- the final result(s) 104 may be result information 244 or a result(s) of the task distribution module's processing of the result information 244 .
- the distributed computing system may process the selected task(s) of the second DST client module on the selected data(s) of the second DST client module.
- the distributed computing system may process the second DST client module's request subsequent to, or preceding, that of the first DST client module.
- the second DST client module provides its selected data 238 and selected task 240 to a task distribution module 232 .
- the task distribution module 232 is a separate device of the distributed computing system or within the DSTN module, the task distribution modules 232 coupled to the first and second DST client modules may be the same module.
- the task distribution module 232 processes the request of the second DST client module in a similar manner as it processed the request of the first DST client module.
- FIG. 29 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of a task distribution module 232 facilitating the example of FIG. 28 .
- the task distribution module 232 includes a plurality of tables it uses to generate distributed storage and task (DST) allocation information 242 for selected data and selected tasks received from a DST client module.
- the data storage information table 248 includes a data identification (ID) field 260 , a data size field 262 , an addressing information field 264 , distributed storage (DS) information 266 , and may further include other information regarding the data, how it is stored, and/or how it can be processed.
- ID data identification
- DS distributed storage
- DS encoded data #1 has a data ID of 1, a data size of AA (e.g., a byte size of a few Terabytes or more), addressing information of Addr — 1_AA, and DS parameters of 3/5; SEG — 1; and SLC — 1.
- the addressing information may be a virtual address corresponding to the virtual address of the first storage word (e.g., one or more bytes) of the data and information on how to calculate the other addresses, may be a range of virtual addresses for the storage words of the data, physical addresses of the first storage word or the storage words of the data, may be a list of slice names of the encoded data slices of the data, etc.
- the DS parameters may include identity of an error encoding scheme, decode threshold/pillar width (e.g., 3/5 for the first data entry), segment security information (e.g., SEG — 1), per slice security information (e.g., SLC — 1), and/or any other information regarding how the data was encoded into data slices.
- the task storage information table 250 includes a task identification (ID) field 268 , a task size field 270 , an addressing information field 272 , distributed storage (DS) information 274 , and may further include other information regarding the task, how it is stored, and/or how it can be used to process data.
- DS encoded task #2 has a task ID of 2, a task size of XY, addressing information of Addr — 2_XY, and DS parameters of 3/5; SEG — 2; and SLC — 2.
- the addressing information may be a virtual address corresponding to the virtual address of the first storage word (e.g., one or more bytes) of the task and information on how to calculate the other addresses, may be a range of virtual addresses for the storage words of the task, physical addresses of the first storage word or the storage words of the task, may be a list of slices names of the encoded slices of the task code, etc.
- the DS parameters may include identity of an error encoding scheme, decode threshold/pillar width (e.g., 3/5 for the first data entry), segment security information (e.g., SEG — 2), per slice security information (e.g., SLC — 2), and/or any other information regarding how the task was encoded into encoded task slices.
- segment and/or the per-slice security information include a type of encryption (if enabled), a type of compression (if enabled), watermarking information (if enabled), and/or an integrity check scheme (if enabled).
- the task field 256 identifies a task stored in the memory of a distributed storage and task network (DSTN) module and the corresponding sub-task fields 258 indicates whether the task includes sub-tasks and, if so, how many and if any of the sub-tasks are ordered.
- the DT execution module table 252 includes a DST execution unit ID field 276 , a DT execution module ID field 278 , and a DT execution module capabilities field 280 .
- the DST execution unit ID field 276 includes the identity of DST units in the DSTN module.
- the DT execution module ID field 278 includes the identity of each DT execution unit in each DST unit.
- DST unit 1 includes three DT executions modules (e.g., 1 — 1, 1 — 2, and 1 — 3).
- the DT execution capabilities field 280 includes identity of the capabilities of the corresponding DT execution unit.
- DT execution module 1 — 1 includes capabilities X, where X includes one or more of MIPS capabilities, processing resources (e.g., quantity and capability of microprocessors, CPUs, digital signal processors, co-processor, microcontrollers, arithmetic logic circuitry, and/or any other analog and/or digital processing circuitry), availability of the processing resources, memory information (e.g., type, size, availability, etc.), and/or any information germane to executing one or more tasks.
- processing resources e.g., quantity and capability of microprocessors, CPUs, digital signal processors, co-processor, microcontrollers, arithmetic logic circuitry, and/or any other analog and/or digital processing circuitry
- availability of the processing resources e.g., type, size, availability, etc.
- memory information e.g., type, size, availability, etc.
- the task distribution module 232 From these tables, the task distribution module 232 generates the DST allocation information 242 to indicate where the data is stored, how to partition the data, where the task is stored, how to partition the task, which DT execution units should perform which partial task on which data partitions, where and how intermediate results are to be stored, etc. If multiple tasks are being performed on the same data or different data, the task distribution module factors such information into its generation of the DST allocation information.
- FIG. 30 is a diagram of a specific example of a distributed computing system performing tasks on stored data as a task flow 318 .
- selected data 92 is data 2 and selected tasks are tasks 1, 2, and 3.
- Task 1 corresponds to analyzing translation of data from one language to another (e.g., human language or computer language);
- task 2 corresponds to finding specific words and/or phrases in the data;
- task 3 corresponds to finding specific translated words and/or phrases in translated data.
- task 1 includes 7 sub-tasks: task 1 — 1—identify non-words (non-ordered); task 1 — 2—identify unique words (non-ordered); task 1 — 3—translate (non-ordered); task 1 — 4—translate back (ordered after task 1 — 3); task 1 — 5—compare to ID errors (ordered after task 1-4); task 1 — 6—determine non-word translation errors (ordered after task 1 — 5 and 1 — 1); and task 1 — 7—determine correct translations (ordered after 1 — 5 and 1 — 2).
- the sub-task further indicates whether they are an ordered task (i.e., are dependent on the outcome of another task) or non-order (i.e., are independent of the outcome of another task).
- Task 2 does not include sub-tasks and task 3 includes two sub-tasks: task 3 — 1 translate; and task 3 — 2 find specific word or phrase in translated data.
- the three tasks collectively are selected to analyze data for translation accuracies, translation errors, translation anomalies, occurrence of specific words or phrases in the data, and occurrence of specific words or phrases on the translated data.
- the data 92 is translated 306 into translated data 282 ; is analyzed for specific words and/or phrases 300 to produce a list of specific words and/or phrases 286 ; is analyzed for non-words 302 (e.g., not in a reference dictionary) to produce a list of non-words 290 ; and is analyzed for unique words 316 included in the data 92 (i.e., how many different words are included in the data) to produce a list of unique words 298 .
- Each of these tasks is independent of each other and can therefore be processed in parallel if desired.
- the translated data 282 is analyzed (e.g., sub-task 3 — 2) for specific translated words and/or phrases 304 to produce a list of specific translated words and/or phrases.
- the translated data 282 is translated back 308 (e.g., sub-task 1 — 4) into the language of the original data to produce re-translated data 284 .
- These two tasks are dependent on the translate task (e.g., task 1 — 3) and thus must be ordered after the translation task, which may be in a pipelined ordering or a serial ordering.
- the re-translated data 284 is then compared 310 with the original data 92 to find words and/or phrases that did not translate (one way and/or the other) properly to produce a list of incorrectly translated words 294 .
- the comparing task e.g., sub-task 1 — 5
- 310 is ordered after the translation 306 and re-translation tasks 308 (e.g., sub-tasks 1 — 3 and 1 — 4
- the list of words incorrectly translated 294 is compared 312 to the list of non-words 290 to identify words that were not properly translated because the words are non-words to produce a list of errors due to non-words 292 .
- the list of words incorrectly translated 294 is compared 314 to the list of unique words 298 to identify unique words that were properly translated to produce a list of correctly translated words 296 .
- the comparison may also identify unique words that were not properly translated to produce a list of unique words that were not properly translated.
- each list of words may include the word and/or phrase, how many times it is used, where in the data it is used, and/or any other information requested regarding a word and/or phrase.
- FIG. 31 is a schematic block diagram of an example of a distributed storage and task processing network (DSTN) module storing data and task codes for the example of FIG. 30 .
- DS encoded data 2 is stored as encoded data slices across the memory (e.g., stored in memories 88 ) of DST execution units 1-5; the DS encoded task code 1 (of task 1) and DS encoded task 3 are stored as encoded task slices across the memory of DST execution units 1-5; and DS encoded task code 2 (of task 2) is stored as encoded task slices across the memory of DST execution units 3-7.
- the respective data/task has DS parameters of 3/5 for their decode threshold/pillar width; hence spanning the memory of five DST execution units.
- FIG. 32 is a diagram of an example of distributed storage and task (DST) allocation information 242 for the example of FIG. 30 .
- the DST allocation information 242 includes data partitioning information 320 , task execution information 322 , and intermediate result information 324 .
- the data partitioning information 320 includes the data identifier (ID), the number of partitions to split the data into, address information for each data partition, and whether the DS encoded data has to be transformed from pillar grouping to slice grouping.
- the task execution information 322 includes tabular information having a task identification field 326 , a task ordering field 328 , a data partition field ID 330 , and a set of DT execution modules 332 to use for the distributed task processing per data partition.
- the intermediate result information 324 includes tabular information having a name ID field 334 , an ID of the DST execution unit assigned to process the corresponding intermediate result 336 , a scratch pad storage field 338 , and an intermediate result storage field 340 .
- the data partitioning information includes the ID of data 2.
- the task distribution module determines whether the DS encoded data 2 is in the proper format for distributed computing (e.g., was stored as slice groupings). If not, the task distribution module indicates that the DS encoded data 2 format needs to be changed from the pillar grouping format to the slice grouping format, which will be done the by DSTN module.
- the task distribution module determines the number of partitions to divide the data into (e.g., 2 — 1 through 2_z) and addressing information for each partition.
- the task distribution module generates an entry in the task execution information section for each sub-task to be performed.
- task 1 — 1 e.g., identify non-words on the data
- has no task ordering i.e., is independent of the results of other sub-tasks
- DT execution modules 1 — 1, 2 — 1, 3 — 1, 4 — 1, and 5 — 1 search for non-words in data partitions 2 — 1 through 2_z to produce task 1 — 1 intermediate results (R1-1, which is a list of non-words).
- Task 1 — 2 e.g., identify unique words
- Task 1 — 3 (e.g., translate) includes task execution information as being non-ordered (i.e., is independent), having DT execution modules 1 — 1, 2 — 1, 3 — 1, 4 — 1, and 5 — 1 translate data partitions 2 — 1 through 2 — 4 and having DT execution modules 1 — 2, 2 — 2, 3 — 2, 4 — 2, and 5 — 2 translate data partitions 2 — 5 through 2_z to produce task 1 — 3 intermediate results (R1-3, which is the translated data).
- the data partitions are grouped, where different sets of DT execution modules perform a distributed sub-task (or task) on each data partition group, which allows for further parallel processing.
- Task 1 — 4 (e.g., translate back) is ordered after task 1 — 3 and is to be executed on task 1 — 3's intermediate result (e.g., R1-3 — 1) (e.g., the translated data).
- DT execution modules 1 — 1, 2 — 1, 3 — 1, 4 — 1, and 5 — 1 are allocated to translate back task 1 — 3 intermediate result partitions R1-3 — 1 through R1-3 — 4 and DT execution modules 1 — 2, 2 — 2, 6 — 1, 7 — 1, and 7 — 2 are allocated to translate back task 1 — 3 intermediate result partitions R1-3 — 5 through R1-3_z to produce task 1-4 intermediate results (R1-4, which is the translated back data).
- Task 1 — 5 (e.g., compare data and translated data to identify translation errors) is ordered after task 1 — 4 and is to be executed on task 1 — 4's intermediate results (R4-1) and on the data.
- DT execution modules 1 — 1, 2 — 1, 3 — 1, 4 — 1, and 5 — 1 are allocated to compare the data partitions (2 — 1 through 2_z) with partitions of task 1-4 intermediate results partitions R1-4 — 1 through R1-4_z to produce task 1 — 5 intermediate results (R1-5, which is the list words translated incorrectly).
- Task 1 — 6 (e.g., determine non-word translation errors) is ordered after tasks 1 — 1 and 1 — 5 and is to be executed on tasks 1 — 1's and 1 — 5's intermediate results (R1-1 and R1-5).
- DT execution modules 1 — 1, 2 — 1, 3 — 1, 4 — 1, and 5 — 1 are allocated to compare the partitions of task 1 — 1 intermediate results (R1-1 — 1 through R1-1_z) with partitions of task 1-5 intermediate results partitions (R1-5 — 1 through R1-5_z) to produce task 1 — 6 intermediate results (R1-6, which is the list translation errors due to non-words).
- Task 1 — 7 (e.g., determine words correctly translated) is ordered after tasks 1 — 2 and 1 — 5 and is to be executed on tasks 1 — 2's and 1 — 5's intermediate results (R1-1 and R1-5).
- DT execution modules 1 — 2, 2 — 2, 3 — 2, 4 — 2, and 5 — 2 are allocated to compare the partitions of task 1 — 2 intermediate results (R1-2 — 1 through R1-2_z) with partitions of task 1-5 intermediate results partitions (R1-5 — 1 through R1-5_z) to produce task 1 — 7 intermediate results (R1-7, which is the list of correctly translated words).
- Task 2 (e.g., find specific words and/or phrases) has no task ordering (i.e., is independent of the results of other sub-tasks), is to be performed on data partitions 2 — 1 through 2_z by DT execution modules 3 — 1, 4 — 1, 5 — 1, 6 — 1, and 7 — 1.
- DT execution modules 3 — 1, 4 — 1, 5 — 1, 6 — 1, and 7 — 1 search for specific words and/or phrases in data partitions 2 — 1 through 2_z to produce task 2 intermediate results (R2, which is a list of specific words and/or phrases).
- Task 3 — 2 (e.g., find specific translated words and/or phrases) is ordered after task 1 — 3 (e.g., translate) is to be performed on partitions R1-3 — 1 through R1-3_z by DT execution modules 1 — 2, 2 — 2, 3 — 2, 4 — 2, and 5 — 2.
- DT execution modules 1 — 2, 2 — 2, 3 — 2, 4 — 2, and 5 — 2 search for specific translated words and/or phrases in the partitions of the translated data (R1-3 — 1 through R1-3_z) to produce task 3 — 2 intermediate results (R3-2, which is a list of specific translated words and/or phrases).
- the intermediate result information indicates which DST unit is responsible for overseeing execution of the task and, if needed, processing the partial results generated by the set of allocated DT execution units.
- the intermediate result information indicates a scratch pad memory for the task and where the corresponding intermediate results are to be stored.
- DST unit 1 is responsible for overseeing execution of the task 1 — 1 and coordinates storage of the intermediate result as encoded intermediate result slices stored in memory of DST execution units 1-5.
- the scratch pad is for storing non-DS encoded intermediate results and the intermediate result storage is for storing DS encoded intermediate results.
- FIGS. 33-38 are schematic block diagrams of the distributed storage and task network (DSTN) module performing the example of FIG. 30 .
- the DSTN module accesses the data 92 and partitions it into a plurality of partitions 1-z in accordance with distributed storage and task network (DST) allocation information.
- DST distributed storage and task network
- the DSTN identifies a set of its DT (distributed task) execution modules 90 to perform the task (e.g., identify non-words (i.e., not in a reference dictionary) within the data partition) in accordance with the DST allocation information.
- the set of DT execution modules 90 may be the same, different, or a combination thereof (e.g., some data partitions use the same set while other data partitions use different sets).
- the first set of DT execution modules executes task 1 — 1 to produce a first partial result 102 of non-words found in the first data partition.
- the second set of DT execution modules executes task 1 — 1 to produce a second partial result 102 of non-words found in the second data partition.
- the sets of DT execution modules (as per the DST allocation information) perform task 1 — 1 on the data partitions until the “z” set of DT execution modules performs task 1 — 1 on the “zth” data partition to produce a “zth” partial result 102 of non-words found in the “zth” data partition.
- DST execution unit 1 is assigned to process the first through “zth” partial results to produce the first intermediate result (R1-1), which is a list of non-words found in the data.
- each set of DT execution modules 90 stores its respective partial result in the scratchpad memory of DST execution unit 1 (which is identified in the DST allocation or may be determined by DST execution unit 1).
- a processing module of DST execution 1 is engaged to aggregate the first through “zth” partial results to produce the first intermediate result (e.g., R1 — 1).
- the processing module stores the first intermediate result as non-DS error encoded data in the scratchpad memory or in another section of memory of DST execution unit 1.
- the DST execution unit 1 engages its DST client module to slice grouping based DS error encode the first intermediate result (e.g., the list of non-words).
- the DST client module determines whether the list of non-words is of a sufficient size to partition (e.g., greater than a Terabytes). If yes, it partitions the first intermediate result (R1-1) into a plurality of partitions (e.g., R1-1 — 1 through R1-1_m). If the first intermediate result is not of sufficient size to partition, it is not partitioned.
- the DST client module For each partition of the first intermediate result, or for the first intermediate result, the DST client module uses the DS error encoding parameters of the data (e.g., DS parameters of data 2, which includes 3/5 decode threshold/pillar width ratio) to produce slice groupings.
- the slice groupings are stored in the intermediate result memory (e.g., allocated memory in the memories of DST execution units 1-5).
- the DSTN module is performing task 1 — 2 (e.g., find unique words) on the data 92 .
- the DSTN module accesses the data 92 and partitions it into a plurality of partitions 1-z in accordance with the DST allocation information or it may use the data partitions of task 1 — 1 if the partitioning is the same.
- the DSTN identifies a set of its DT execution modules to perform task 1 — 2 in accordance with the DST allocation information. From data partition to data partition, the set of DT execution modules may be the same, different, or a combination thereof.
- the allocated set of DT execution modules executes task 1 — 2 to produce a partial results (e.g., 1 st through “zth”) of unique words found in the data partitions.
- DST execution unit 1 is assigned to process the first through “zth” partial results 102 of task 1 — 2 to produce the second intermediate result (R1-2), which is a list of unique words found in the data 92 .
- the processing module of DST execution 1 is engaged to aggregate the first through “zth” partial results of unique words to produce the second intermediate result.
- the processing module stores the second intermediate result as non-DS error encoded data in the scratchpad memory or in another section of memory of DST execution unit 1.
- the DST execution unit 1 engages its DST client module to slice grouping based DS error encode the second intermediate result (e.g., the list of non-words).
- the DST client module determines whether the list of unique words is of a sufficient size to partition (e.g., greater than a Terabytes). If yes, it partitions the second intermediate result (R1-2) into a plurality of partitions (e.g., R1-2 — 1 through R1-2_m). If the second intermediate result is not of sufficient size to partition, it is not partitioned.
- the DST client module For each partition of the second intermediate result, or for the second intermediate results, the DST client module uses the DS error encoding parameters of the data (e.g., DS parameters of data 2, which includes 3/5 decode threshold/pillar width ratio) to produce slice groupings.
- the slice groupings are stored in the intermediate result memory (e.g., allocated memory in the memories of DST execution units 1-5).
- the DSTN module is performing task 1 — 3 (e.g., translate) on the data 92 .
- the DSTN module accesses the data 92 and partitions it into a plurality of partitions 1-z in accordance with the DST allocation information or it may use the data partitions of task 1 — 1 if the partitioning is the same.
- the DSTN For each data partition, the DSTN identifies a set of its DT execution modules to perform task 1 — 3 in accordance with the DST allocation information (e.g., DT execution modules 1 — 1, 2 — 1, 3 — 1, 4 — 1, and 5 — 1 translate data partitions 2 — 1 through 2 — 4 and DT execution modules 1 — 2, 2 — 2, 3 — 2, 4 — 2, and 5 — 2 translate data partitions 2 — 5 through 2_z).
- the allocated set of DT execution modules 90 executes task 1 — 3 to produce partial results 102 (e.g., 1 st through “zth”) of translated data.
- DST execution unit 2 is assigned to process the first through “zth” partial results of task 1 — 3 to produce the third intermediate result (R1-3), which is translated data.
- the processing module of DST execution 2 is engaged to aggregate the first through “zth” partial results of translated data to produce the third intermediate result.
- the processing module stores the third intermediate result as non-DS error encoded data in the scratchpad memory or in another section of memory of DST execution unit 2.
- the DST execution unit 2 engages its DST client module to slice grouping based DS error encode the third intermediate result (e.g., translated data).
- the DST client module partitions the third intermediate result (R1-3) into a plurality of partitions (e.g., R1-3 — 1 through R1-3_y).
- the DST client module uses the DS error encoding parameters of the data (e.g., DS parameters of data 2, which includes 3/5 decode threshold/pillar width ratio) to produce slice groupings.
- the slice groupings are stored in the intermediate result memory (e.g., allocated memory in the memories of DST execution units 2-6 per the DST allocation information).
- the DSTN module is performing task 1 — 4 (e.g., retranslate) on the translated data of the third intermediate result.
- the DSTN module accesses the translated data (from the scratchpad memory or from the intermediate result memory and decodes it) and partitions it into a plurality of partitions in accordance with the DST allocation information.
- the DSTN identifies a set of its DT execution modules 90 to perform task 1 — 4 in accordance with the DST allocation information (e.g., DT execution modules 1 — 1, 2 — 1, 3 — 1, 4 — 1, and 5 — 1 are allocated to translate back partitions R1-3 — 1 through R1-3 — 4 and DT execution modules 1 — 2, 2 — 2, 6 — 1, 7 — 1, and 7 — 2 are allocated to translate back partitions R1-3 — 5 through R1-3_z).
- the allocated set of DT execution modules executes task 1 — 4 to produce partial results 102 (e.g., 1st through “zth”) of re-translated data.
- DST execution unit 3 is assigned to process the first through “zth” partial results of task 1 — 4 to produce the fourth intermediate result (R1-4), which is retranslated data.
- the processing module of DST execution 3 is engaged to aggregate the first through “zth” partial results of retranslated data to produce the fourth intermediate result.
- the processing module stores the fourth intermediate result as non-DS error encoded data in the scratchpad memory or in another section of memory of DST execution unit 3.
- DST execution unit 3 engages its DST client module to slice grouping based DS error encode the fourth intermediate result (e.g., retranslated data).
- the DST client module partitions the fourth intermediate result (R1-4) into a plurality of partitions (e.g., R1-4 — 1 through R1-4_z).
- the DST client module uses the DS error encoding parameters of the data (e.g., DS parameters of data 2 , which includes 3/5 decode threshold/pillar width ratio) to produce slice groupings.
- the slice groupings are stored in the intermediate result memory (e.g., allocated memory in the memories of DST execution units 3-7 per the DST allocation information).
- a distributed storage and task network (DSTN) module is performing task 1 — 5 (e.g., compare) on data 92 and retranslated data of FIG. 35 .
- the DSTN module accesses the data 92 and partitions it into a plurality of partitions in accordance with the DST allocation information or it may use the data partitions of task 1 — 1 if the partitioning is the same.
- the DSTN module also accesses the retranslated data from the scratchpad memory, or from the intermediate result memory and decodes it, and partitions it into a plurality of partitions in accordance with the DST allocation information.
- the number of partitions of the retranslated data corresponds to the number of partitions of the data.
- the DSTN For each pair of partitions (e.g., data partition 1 and retranslated data partition 1), the DSTN identifies a set of its DT execution modules 90 to perform task 1 — 5 in accordance with the DST allocation information (e.g., DT execution modules 1 — 1, 2 — 1, 3 — 1, 4 — 1, and 5 — 1). For each pair of partitions, the allocated set of DT execution modules executes task 1 — 5 to produce partial results 102 (e.g., 1 st through “zth”) of a list of incorrectly translated words and/or phrases.
- partial results 102 e.g., 1 st through “zth”
- DST execution unit 1 is assigned to process the first through “zth” partial results of task 1 — 5 to produce the fifth intermediate result (R1-5), which is the list of incorrectly translated words and/or phrases.
- the processing module of DST execution 1 is engaged to aggregate the first through “zth” partial results of the list of incorrectly translated words and/or phrases to produce the fifth intermediate result.
- the processing module stores the fifth intermediate result as non-DS error encoded data in the scratchpad memory or in another section of memory of DST execution unit 1.
- DST execution unit 1 engages its DST client module to slice grouping based DS error encode the fifth intermediate result.
- the DST client module partitions the fifth intermediate result (R1-5) into a plurality of partitions (e.g., R1-5 — 1 through R1-5_z).
- the DST client module uses the DS error encoding parameters of the data (e.g., DS parameters of data 2, which includes 3/5 decode threshold/pillar width ratio) to produce slice groupings.
- the slice groupings are stored in the intermediate result memory (e.g., allocated memory in the memories of DST execution units 1-5 per the DST allocation information).
- the DSTN module is performing task 1 — 6 (e.g., translation errors due to non-words) on the list of incorrectly translated words and/or phrases (e.g., the fifth intermediate result R1-5) and the list of non-words (e.g., the first intermediate result R1-1).
- task 1 — 6 e.g., translation errors due to non-words
- the DSTN module accesses the lists and partitions them into a corresponding number of partitions.
- the DSTN For each pair of partitions (e.g., partition R1-1 — 1 and partition R1-5 — 1), the DSTN identifies a set of its DT execution modules 90 to perform task 1 — 6 in accordance with the DST allocation information (e.g., DT execution modules 1 — 1, 2 — 1, 3 — 1, 4 — 1, and 5 — 1). For each pair of partitions, the allocated set of DT execution modules executes task 1 — 6 to produce partial results 102 (e.g., 1 st through “zth”) of a list of incorrectly translated words and/or phrases due to non-words.
- partial results 102 e.g., 1 st through “zth”
- DST execution unit 2 is assigned to process the first through “zth” partial results of task 1 — 6 to produce the sixth intermediate result (R1-6), which is the list of incorrectly translated words and/or phrases due to non-words.
- the processing module of DST execution 2 is engaged to aggregate the first through “zth” partial results of the list of incorrectly translated words and/or phrases due to non-words to produce the sixth intermediate result.
- the processing module stores the sixth intermediate result as non-DS error encoded data in the scratchpad memory or in another section of memory of DST execution unit 2.
- the DST execution unit 2 engages its DST client module to slice grouping based DS error encode the sixth intermediate result.
- the DST client module partitions the sixth intermediate result (R1-6) into a plurality of partitions (e.g., R1-6 — 1 through R1-6_z).
- the DST client module uses the DS error encoding parameters of the data (e.g., DS parameters of data 2, which includes 3/5 decode threshold/pillar width ratio) to produce slice groupings.
- the slice groupings are stored in the intermediate result memory (e.g., allocated memory in the memories of DST execution units 2-6 per the DST allocation information).
- the DSTN module is performing task 1 — 7 (e.g., correctly translated words and/or phrases) on the list of incorrectly translated words and/or phrases (e.g., the fifth intermediate result R1-5) and the list of unique words (e.g., the second intermediate result R1-2).
- task 1 — 7 e.g., correctly translated words and/or phrases
- the list of incorrectly translated words and/or phrases e.g., the fifth intermediate result R1-5) and the list of unique words
- the DSTN module accesses the lists and partitions them into a corresponding number of partitions.
- the DSTN For each pair of partitions (e.g., partition R1-2 — 1 and partition R1-5 — 1), the DSTN identifies a set of its DT execution modules 90 to perform task 1 — 7 in accordance with the DST allocation information (e.g., DT execution modules 1 — 2, 2 — 2, 3 — 2, 4 — 2, and 5 — 2). For each pair of partitions, the allocated set of DT execution modules executes task 1 — 7 to produce partial results 102 (e.g., 1 st through “zth”) of a list of correctly translated words and/or phrases.
- partial results 102 e.g., 1 st through “zth”
- DST execution unit 3 is assigned to process the first through “zth” partial results of task 1 — 7 to produce the seventh intermediate result (R1-7), which is the list of correctly translated words and/or phrases.
- the processing module of DST execution 3 is engaged to aggregate the first through “zth” partial results of the list of correctly translated words and/or phrases to produce the seventh intermediate result.
- the processing module stores the seventh intermediate result as non-DS error encoded data in the scratchpad memory or in another section of memory of DST execution unit 3.
- DST execution unit 3 engages its DST client module to slice grouping based DS error encode the seventh intermediate result.
- the DST client module partitions the seventh intermediate result (R1-7) into a plurality of partitions (e.g., R1-7 — 1 through R1-7_z).
- the DST client module uses the DS error encoding parameters of the data (e.g., DS parameters of data 2 , which includes 3/5 decode threshold/pillar width ratio) to produce slice groupings.
- the slice groupings are stored in the intermediate result memory (e.g., allocated memory in the memories of DST execution units 3-7 per the DST allocation information).
- the distributed storage and task network (DSTN) module is performing task 2 (e.g., find specific words and/or phrases) on the data 92 .
- the DSTN module accesses the data and partitions it into a plurality of partitions 1-z in accordance with the DST allocation information or it may use the data partitions of task 1 — 1 if the partitioning is the same.
- the DSTN identifies a set of its DT execution modules 90 to perform task 2 in accordance with the DST allocation information. From data partition to data partition, the set of DT execution modules may be the same, different, or a combination thereof.
- the allocated set of DT execution modules executes task 2 to produce partial results 102 (e.g., 1 st through “zth”) of specific words and/or phrases found in the data partitions.
- DST execution unit 7 is assigned to process the first through “zth” partial results of task 2 to produce task 2 intermediate result (R2), which is a list of specific words and/or phrases found in the data.
- the processing module of DST execution 7 is engaged to aggregate the first through “zth” partial results of specific words and/or phrases to produce the task 2 intermediate result.
- the processing module stores the task 2 intermediate result as non-DS error encoded data in the scratchpad memory or in another section of memory of DST execution unit 7.
- DST execution unit 7 engages its DST client module to slice grouping based DS error encode the task 2 intermediate result.
- the DST client module determines whether the list of specific words and/or phrases is of a sufficient size to partition (e.g., greater than a Terabytes). If yes, it partitions the task 2 intermediate result (R2) into a plurality of partitions (e.g., R2 — 1 through R2_m). If the task 2 intermediate result is not of sufficient size to partition, it is not partitioned.
- the DST client module For each partition of the task 2 intermediate result, or for the task 2 intermediate results, the DST client module uses the DS error encoding parameters of the data (e.g., DS parameters of data 2, which includes 3/5 decode threshold/pillar width ratio) to produce slice groupings.
- the slice groupings are stored in the intermediate result memory (e.g., allocated memory in the memories of DST execution units 1-4, and 7).
- the distributed storage and task network (DSTN) module is performing task 3 (e.g., find specific translated words and/or phrases) on the translated data (R1-3).
- the DSTN module accesses the translated data (from the scratchpad memory or from the intermediate result memory and decodes it) and partitions it into a plurality of partitions in accordance with the DST allocation information.
- the DSTN identifies a set of its DT execution modules to perform task 3 in accordance with the DST allocation information.
- the set of DT execution modules may be the same, different, or a combination thereof.
- the allocated set of DT execution modules 90 executes task 3 to produce partial results 102 (e.g., 1 st through “zth”) of specific translated words and/or phrases found in the data partitions.
- DST execution unit 5 is assigned to process the first through “zth” partial results of task 3 to produce task 3 intermediate result (R3), which is a list of specific translated words and/or phrases found in the translated data.
- R3 is a list of specific translated words and/or phrases found in the translated data.
- the processing module of DST execution 5 is engaged to aggregate the first through “zth” partial results of specific translated words and/or phrases to produce the task 3 intermediate result.
- the processing module stores the task 3 intermediate result as non-DS error encoded data in the scratchpad memory or in another section of memory of DST execution unit 7.
- DST execution unit 5 engages its DST client module to slice grouping based DS error encode the task 3 intermediate result.
- the DST client module determines whether the list of specific translated words and/or phrases is of a sufficient size to partition (e.g., greater than a Terabytes). If yes, it partitions the task 3 intermediate result (R3) into a plurality of partitions (e.g., R3 — 1 through R3_m). If the task 3 intermediate result is not of sufficient size to partition, it is not partitioned.
- the DST client module For each partition of the task 3 intermediate result, or for the task 3 intermediate results, the DST client module uses the DS error encoding parameters of the data (e.g., DS parameters of data 2, which includes 3/5 decode threshold/pillar width ratio) to produce slice groupings.
- the slice groupings are stored in the intermediate result memory (e.g., allocated memory in the memories of DST execution units 1-4, 5, and 7).
- FIG. 39 is a diagram of an example of combining result information into final results 104 for the example of FIG. 30 .
- the result information includes the list of specific words and/or phrases found in the data (task 2 intermediate result), the list of specific translated words and/or phrases found in the data (task 3 intermediate result), the list of non-words found in the data (task 1 first intermediate result R1-1), the list of unique words found in the data (task 1 second intermediate result R1-2), the list of translation errors due to non-words (task 1 sixth intermediate result R1-6), and the list of correctly translated words and/or phrases (task 1 seventh intermediate result R1-7).
- the task distribution module provides the result information to the requesting DST client module as the results 104 .
- FIGS. 40A-40D are schematic block diagrams of an embodiment of a dispersed storage network (DSN) illustrating an example of storing data in DSN memory.
- the DSN includes the distributed storage and task (DST) client module 34 of FIG. 1 , the network 24 of FIG. 1 , and the distributed storage and task network (DSTN) module 22 of FIG. 1 .
- the DSTN module 22 may be referred to interchangeably as the DSN memory.
- the DSTN module 22 includes one or more storage generations, where each storage generation is associated with a vault of the DSN.
- a vault includes virtual storage of the DSN and may be associated with one or more users of the DSN. Incremental storage generations may be added over time to provide incremental storage capacity as a total amount of data stored associated with the vault grows.
- the DSTN module 22 includes storage generations 1-3 during a first timeframe (e.g., as illustrated in FIGS. 40A-B ) and includes storage generations 1-5 during a second timeframe (e.g., as illustrated in FIGS. 40C-D ).
- Each storage generation includes a set of DST execution (EX) units 1-n.
- Each DST execution unit may be implemented utilizing the DST execution unit 36 of FIG. 1 .
- the DST execution unit may be referred to interchangeably as a storage unit of a set of storage units associated with each storage generation.
- the DST client module 34 includes the outbound DST processing 80 of FIG. 3 , the inbound DST processing 82 of FIG. 3 , and a slice name module 350 .
- the slice name module 350 may be implemented utilizing the processing module 84 of FIG. 3 .
- the DST client module 34 further includes a dispersed storage (DS) module 351 .
- the DS module 351 may be implemented utilizing a plurality of processing modules.
- the plurality of processing modules may include the processing module 84 of FIG. 3 .
- the plurality of processing module includes a first module, a second module, a third module, a fourth module, a fifth module, and a sixth module.
- the first through sixth modules may be utilized to implement the outbound DST processing 80 , the inbound DST processing 82 , and the slice name module 350 .
- the DSN functions to access data 352 in the DSTN module 22 without utilizing a directory.
- the accessing of the data 352 includes storing of the data 352 and retrieving stored data to reproduce the data 352 .
- FIG. 40A illustrates initial steps of an example of the storing of the data 352 , where the outbound DST processing 80 receives the data 352 for storage, where the data has a data name.
- the data name includes file system information.
- the file system information includes one or more of a user identifier (ID), a vault identifier, and a file system path name for the data.
- the outbound DST processing 80 dispersed storage error encodes the data 352 to produce a plurality of sets of encoded data slices.
- the outbound DST processing 80 Having produced the plurality of sets of encoded data slices, the outbound DST processing 80 generates a plurality of sets of DSN data addresses based on a data object number associated with the data and data storage information.
- Each set of the plurality of sets of DSN data addresses includes a set of DSN addresses, where the set of DSN addresses includes a set of slice names.
- Each slice name includes one or more of a slice index corresponding to a particular slice of the set of encoded data slices, a vault ID corresponding to an associated vault, a generation number corresponding to one of the storage generations, the data object number, and a segment number corresponding to the set of encoded data slices.
- the outbound DST processing 80 utilizes a pseudo random number generator to produce the data object number, performs a system registry lookup to retrieve the vault ID corresponding to a requesting entity, and selects a storage generation of the storage generations to produce the generation number.
- the selecting of the storage generation for storing of the data 352 includes at least one of a random selection, selecting a most recently activated storage generation, selecting a storage generation associated with a highest storage availability level, selecting a storage generation based on interpreting a data storage request, selecting a storage generation based on interpreting a system registry entry, and selecting a storage generation associated with a storage availability level that is greater than a storage availability threshold level. For instance, the outbound DST processing 80 selects a most recently activated storage generation 3 as the selected storage generation to produce generation number 3.
- the data storage information includes dispersed storage error encoding parameters.
- the dispersed storage error encoding parameters includes one or more of data segmenting information regarding segmenting the data 352 into a plurality of data segments, a total number of encoded data slices per set of encoded data slices, a decode threshold number of encoded data slices per set of encoded data slices, a read threshold number of encoded data slices per set of encoded data slices, and a write threshold number of encoded data slices per the set of encoded data slices.
- the outbound DST processing 80 determines the data storage information. The determining includes at least one of performing a system registry lookup, receiving the dispersed storage error encoding parameters, and determining the dispersed storage error encoding parameters based on one or more of received storage requirements and an estimated DSN performance level.
- the outbound DST processing 80 sends, via the network 24 , the plurality of sets of encoded data slices to the DSTN module 22 (e.g., DSN memory) for storage in accordance with the plurality of sets of DSN data addresses.
- the outbound DST processing 80 generates a set of write slice requests that includes the plurality of sets of encoded data slices and the plurality of sets of DSN data addresses, and outputs the set of write slice requests that includes the plurality of sets of encoded data slices (EDS) 1-n of generation 3 to the set of DST execution units 1-n of the storage generation 3.
- FIG. 40B illustrates final steps of the example of the storing of the data 352 , where the outbound DST processing 80 generates retrieval data that is based on the data object number and the data storage information.
- the outbound DST processing 80 aggregates the data object number, the vault ID and the generation number to produce the retrieval data. Having generated the retrieval data, the outbound DST processing 80 dispersed storage error encodes the retrieval data to produce a set of encoded retrieval data slices.
- the slice name module 350 With the set of encoded retrieval data slices produced, the slice name module 350 generates a set of DSN retrieval data addresses 356 based on the data name 354 and on retrieval data storage information.
- the set of DSN retrieval data addresses 356 includes a set of slice names for the set of encoded retrieval data slices.
- Each slice name for a corresponding encoded retrieval data slice includes one or more of a slice index corresponding to a particular slice of the set of encoded retrieval data slices, the vault ID, a generation number for the retrieval data corresponding to at least one of the storage generations, a retrieval data object number, and a segment number corresponding to the set of encoded retrieval data slices.
- slice name module 350 performs a deterministic function on the data name 354 to produce the retrieval data object number, and selects at least one storage generation of the storage generations to produce the generation number.
- the deterministic function includes one or more of a hashing function, a hash-based message authentication code function, a mask generating function, and a sponge function.
- the slice name module 350 performs the mask generating function on the data name 354 to directly produce the retrieval data object number.
- the selecting of the at least one storage generation for storing of the retrieval data includes at least one of a random selection, applying a deterministic function to the data name 354 , selecting the most recently activated storage generation, selecting the storage generation associated with the highest storage availability level, selecting the storage generation based on interpreting the data storage request, selecting the storage generation based on interpreting the system registry entry, and selecting the storage generation associated with the storage availability level that is greater than the storage availability threshold level.
- the slice name module 350 performs the hashing function on the data name 354 to produce an intermediate result, and takes the intermediate result modulo a number of current storage generations to produce generation number 2.
- the retrieval data storage information includes dispersed storage error encoding parameters for the retrieval data.
- the dispersed storage error encoding parameters for the retrieval data includes one or more of a total number of encoded retrieval data slices for the set of encoded retrieval data slices, a decode threshold number of encoded retrieval data slices for the set of encoded retrieval data slices, a read threshold number of encoded retrieval data slices for the set of encoded retrieval data slices, and a write threshold number of encoded retrieval data slices for the set of encoded retrieval data slices.
- the outbound DST processing 80 determines the retrieval data storage information.
- the slice name module 350 determines the retrieval data storage information.
- the determining includes at least one of performing a system registry lookup, receiving the dispersed storage error encoding parameters for the retrieval data, utilizing the dispersed storage error encoding parameters of the data 352 , and determining the dispersed storage error encoding parameters for the retrieval data based on one or more of further received storage requirements and the estimated DSN performance level.
- the outbound DST processing 80 sends, via the network 24 , the set of encoded retrieval data slices to the DSTN module 22 (e.g., DSN memory) for storage in accordance with the set of DSN retrieval data addresses 356 .
- the outbound DST processing 80 generates another set of write slice requests that includes the set of encoded retrieval data slices and the set of DSN retrieval data addresses 356 ; and outputs the other set of write slice requests that includes the set of encoded retrieval data slices (ERDS) 1-n of generation 2 to the set of DST execution units 1-n of the storage generation 2.
- one or more of the slice name module 350 and the outbound DST processing 80 may determine to store the retrieval data in at least one other storage generation.
- the slice name module 350 determines to store multiple copies of the set of encoded retrieval data slices and identifies multiple sets of storage units of the DSN memory for storing the multiple copies.
- the multiple sets of storage units being part of a logical storage vault within the DSN memory, where a first set of storage units of the set of storage units corresponds to a first generation of the DSN memory and a second set of storage units of the set of storage units corresponds to a second generation of the DSN memory.
- the determining includes one or more of detecting that a size of the retrieval data is less than a size threshold level, detecting that an available storage capacity level is greater than an available storage capacity threshold level, interpreting a system registry entry, and interpreting a request.
- the slice name module 350 When determining to store multiple copies of the set of encoded retrieval data slices, the slice name module 350 generates a unique set of DSN retrieval data addresses based on the data name, on the retrieval data storage information, and on a corresponding one of the multiple sets of storage units. As a specific example, the slice name module 350 generates another set of DSN retrieval data addresses that includes generation 3 when identifying storage generation 3. With the other set of DSN retrieval data addresses, the outbound DST processing 80 sends, via the network 24 , the set of encoded retrieval data slices to the corresponding one of the multiple sets of storage units for storage in accordance with the other set of DSN retrieval data addresses.
- the outbound DST processing 80 generates yet another set of write slice requests that includes the set of encoded retrieval data slices and the other set of DSN retrieval data addresses 356 ; and outputs the yet another set of write slice requests that includes the set of encoded retrieval data slices (ERDS) 1-n of generation 3 to the set of DST execution units 1-n of the storage generation 3.
- ERDS encoded retrieval data slices
- FIG. 40C illustrates initial steps of the example of the retrieving of the stored data to reproduce the data 352 , where the inbound DST processing 82 receives a read request regarding the data, where the read request includes the data name 354 . Having received the data name 354 , the inbound DST processing 82 estimates likely retrieval data storage information. Alternatively, the slice name module 350 estimates the likely retrieval data storage information. As a specific example, the slice name module 350 determines a logical DSN address to physical storage device mapping (e.g., identifies DSN address ranges corresponding to each current storage generation). As another specific example, the slice name module 350 determines historical use patterns of the DSN memory (e.g., which storage generations hold the most retrieval data). As yet another specific example, the slice name module 350 determines historical storage patterns of a requesting entity that is requesting the read request (e.g., identify likely storage generations associated with storage of retrieval data associated with the requesting entity).
- a logical DSN address to physical storage device mapping e.
- the slice name module 350 Having estimated the likely retrieval data storage information, the slice name module 350 generates likely DSN retrieval data addresses 358 based on the data name 354 and the likely retrieval data storage information. As a specific example, the slice name module 350 generates the likely DSN retrieval data addresses 358 to include generation 3 when the likely retrieval data storage information includes identification of storage generation 3.
- the inbound DST processing 82 sends read requests to the likely DSN retrieval data addresses 358 .
- the inbound DST processing 82 sends, via the network 24 , retrieval data read requests for generation 3, that includes a set of read slice requests 1-n, to the set of DST execution units associated with storage generation 3.
- the set of DST execution units 1-n issues read slice responses to the inbound DST processing 82 , where the read slice responses includes encoded retrieval data slices of generation 3.
- the inbound DST processing 82 reconstructs the retrieval data. Having reconstructive the retrieval data, the inbound DST processing 82 utilizes the retrieval data to reconstruct the data. The reconstruction of the data is discussed in greater detail with reference to FIG. 40D .
- At least one of the inbound DST processing 82 and the slice name module 350 estimates a second likely retrieval data storage information and generates second likely DSN retrieval data addresses based on the data name and the second likely retrieval data storage information. For example, the slice name module 350 generates second likely DSN retrieval data addresses for generation 3. Having generated the second likely DSN retrieval data addresses, the inbound DST processing 82 sends second read requests to the second likely DSN retrieval data addresses. For example, the inbound DST processing 82 sends, via the network 24 , retrieval data read requests for generation 3 to the set of DST execution units associated with storage generation 3. When favorable responses to the second read requests have been received, the inbound DST processing 82 reconstructs the retrieval data and utilizes the retrieval data to reconstruct the data.
- At least one of the inbound DST processing 82 and the slice name module 350 determines to recover the retrieval data from at least two storage generations.
- the determining includes at least one of interpreting a request, interpreting another system registry entry, and detecting that a system loading level is less than a system loading threshold level.
- at least one of the inbound DST processing 82 and the slice name module 350 estimates the second likely retrieval data storage information. With the second likely retrieval data storage information, the slice name module 350 generates the second likely DSN retrieval data addresses based on the data name 354 and the second likely retrieval data storage information.
- the inbound DST processing 82 sends, via the network 24 , the second read requests to the second likely DSN retrieval data addresses.
- the inbound DST processing 82 reconstructs the retrieval data and utilizes the retrieval data to reconstruct the data.
- FIG. 40D illustrates final steps of the example of the retrieving of the stored data to reproduce the data 352 , where the inbound DST processing 82 extracts the DSN data addresses from the reconstructed retrieval data and issues a data retrieval requests to the DSTN module 22 in accordance with the extracted DSN data addresses.
- the inbound DST processing 82 generates a set of read slice requests that includes the plurality of sets of DSN data addresses based on the extracted DSN data addresses. Having generated the set of read slice request, the inbound DST processing 82 sends the set of read slice requests to the set of DST execution units 1-n of storage generation 3, where the read slice requests includes read slice requests for the plurality of encoded data slices stored in storage generation 3.
- the set of DST execution units 1-n of storage generation 3 sends encoded data slices of generation 3 to the inbound DST processing 82 .
- the inbound DST processing 82 decodes received encoded data slices to reproduce the data 352 .
- FIG. 40E is a flowchart illustrating an example of accessing data.
- the method includes storage where at step 360 a processing module (e.g., of a distributed storage and task (DST) client module of a dispersed storage network (DSN)) sends a plurality of sets of encoded data slices to DSN memory for storage in accordance with a plurality of sets of DSN data addresses.
- the data was dispersed storage error encoded to produce the plurality of sets of encoded data slices.
- the data has a data name and the plurality of sets of DSN data addresses is generated based on a data object number associated with the data and data storage information.
- the data name includes file system information.
- the processing module may utilize a pseudo random number generator to produce the data object number.
- the processing module may determine, as the data storage information, dispersed storage error encoding parameters.
- the method continues at step 362 where the processing module generates retrieval data that is based on the data object number and the data storage information. For example, the processing module generates the retrieval data to include a source name associated with the sets of DSN data addresses.
- the method continues at step 364 where the processing module dispersed storage error encodes the retrieval data to produce a set of encoded retrieval data slices.
- the method continues at step 366 where the processing module generates a set of DSN retrieval data addresses based on the data name and on retrieval data storage information. For example, the processing module performs a deterministic function on the data name to produce a retrieval data object number. The processing module may determine, as the retrieval data storage information, dispersed storage error encoding parameters.
- step 368 the processing module sends the set of encoded retrieval data slices to the DSN memory for storage therein in accordance with the set of DSN retrieval data addresses.
- the processing module may facilitate storage of multiple copies of the set of encoded retrieval data slices.
- the method continues at step 370 where the processing module determines to store multiple copies of the set of encoded retrieval data slices.
- the method continues at step 372 where the processing module identifies multiple sets of storage units of the DSN memory for storing the multiple copies.
- the multiple sets of storage units being part of a logical storage vault within the DSN memory, where a first set of storage units of the set of storage units corresponds to a first generation of the DSN memory and a second set of storage units of the set of storage units corresponds to a second generation of the DSN memory.
- the method continues at step 374 where the processing module stores the multiple copies in the identified multiple sets of storage units. For example, the processing module generates a unique set of DSN retrieval data addresses based on the data name, on the retrieval data storage information, and on a corresponding one of the multiple sets of storage units. Next, the processing module sends the set of encoded retrieval data slices to the corresponding one of the multiple sets of storage units for storage therein in accordance with the unique set of DSN retrieval data addresses.
- the method includes step 376 where the processing module receives a read request regarding the data, where the read request includes the data name.
- the method continues at step 378 where the processing module estimates likely retrieval data storage information (e.g., estimates most probable generations).
- the estimating the likely retrieval data storage information includes one or more of determining a logical DSN address to physical storage device mapping, determining historical use patterns of the DSN memory, and determining historical storage patterns of a requesting entity that is requesting the read request.
- the method continues at step 380 where the processing module generates likely DSN retrieval data addresses based on the data name and the likely retrieval data storage information.
- the method continues at step 382 where the processing module sends read requests to the likely DSN retrieval data addresses.
- the processing module may receive responses to the read requests. When favorable write responses to the read requests have been received, the method branches to step 390 . When the favorable responses to the read requests have not been received, the method continues to step 384 .
- the method continues at step 384 where the processing module estimates a second likely retrieval data storage information when the favorable responses to the read requests have not been received.
- the method continues at step 386 where the processing module generates second likely DSN retrieval data addresses based on the data name and the second likely retrieval data storage information.
- the method continues at step 388 where the processing module sends second read requests to the second likely DSN retrieval data addresses.
- the processing module reconstructs the retrieval data and utilizes the retrieval data to reconstruct the data.
- the processing module may attempt to recover the retrieval data from multiple potential storage locations.
- the processing module estimates the second likely retrieval data storage information and generates the second likely DSN retrieval data addresses based on the data name and the second likely retrieval data storage information.
- the processing module sends the second read requests to the second likely DSN retrieval data addresses.
- the processing module reconstructs the retrieval data and utilizes the retrieval data to reconstruct the data.
- FIG. 41 is a flowchart illustrating an example of updating a dispersed storage network (DSN) address.
- the method includes step 400 where a processing module (e.g., of a distributed storage and task (DST) processing unit) determines to adjust a number of generations associated with a data object stored in a dispersed storage network (DSN).
- the determining may include at least one of determining to add a generation when an amount of data associated with the data is growing and determining to delete a generation when the amount of data associated with the data a shrinking.
- DST distributed storage and task
- the method continues at step 402 where the processing module identifies a number of generations associated with the data.
- the identifying includes looking up a current number of generations associated with the data for a write request and estimating a number of generations that existed when the data was written when the access is the read request.
- the method continues at step 404 where the processing module generates a generation number based on the number of generations.
- the generating includes performing a deterministic function on the data identifier and the number of generations to produce the generation number.
- the processing module obtains at least a portion (e.g., a vault identifier (ID) field entry, an object number field entry) of a dispersed storage network (DSN) address associated with the data, performs a deterministic function on the portion of the DSN address to produce a source name reference, and taking the source name reference modulo the number of generations to produce the generation number.
- a portion e.g., a vault identifier (ID) field entry, an object number field entry
- DSN dispersed storage network
- the method continues at step 406 where the processing module generates a DSN address using the generation number and based on the data. For example, the processing module utilizes the generation number in a generation field of the DSN address, obtains a data ID, performs a registry lookup to identify the vault ID for a vault ID field of the DSN address based on a accessing entity ID, and obtains an object number for an object number field of the DSN address associated with the data ID (e.g., look up in a directory or a dispersed hierarchical index; generate as a random number when writing the data).
- the method continues at step 408 where the processing module identifies a set of storage units based on the DSN address. The identifying includes at least one of performing a DSN address-to-physical address table lookup using the DSN address, initiating a query, and performing a generation-to-storage set table lookup using the generation number.
- the method continues at step 410 where the processing module accesses the set of storage units using the DSN address to retrieve a plurality of sets of encoded data slices associated the data. For example, the processing module generates and sends a plurality of sets of read slice requests to the set of storage units and receive a plurality of at least a decode threshold number of read slice responses for each of the sets of read slice requests.
- the method continues at step 412 where the processing module identifies an updated number of generations associated with the data. The identifying includes adding or subtracting a generation based on one or more of a volume of stored data trend, a request, receiving an error message, and detecting a new set of storage units. For example, the processing module determines to add a new generation when detecting the new set of storage units. As another example, the processing module determines to delete a generation when detecting that a current volume of stored data is less than a low store data threshold level.
- the method continues at step 414 where the processing module generates an updated generation number based on the updated number of generations. For example, the processing module performs a deterministic function on a data identifier and the updated number of generations to produce the updated generation number.
- the method continues at step 416 where the processing module generates an updated DSN address using the updated generation number and based on the data.
- the generating includes at least one of obtaining a data identifier, performing a lookup based on a vault identifier, obtaining an object number, and performing a lookup.
- the lookup may include one or more of accessing a registry, accessing a directory, and accessing a dispersed hierarchical index.
- the method continues at step 418 where the processing module identifies another set of storage units based on the updated DSN address.
- the identifying includes at least one of performing a lookup, initiating a query, and identifying the other set of storage units based on the updated generation number of the updated DSN address.
- the method continues at step 420 where the processing module accesses the other set of storage units using the updated DSN address to store the plurality of sets of encoded data slices associated with the data.
- the accessing includes issuing one or more sets of write slice requests to the other set of storage units where the requests includes slice names based on the updated DSN address.
- the method continues at step 422 where the processing module deletes the plurality of sets of encoded data slices from the set of storage units using the DSN address.
- the deleting includes issuing one or more sets of delete slice requests to the set of storage units that includes slice names based on the DSN address.
- FIG. 42 is a flowchart illustrating an example of accessing an encoded data slice, which includes similar steps to FIG. 41 .
- the method includes step 424 where a processing module (e.g., of a distributed storage and task (DST) execution unit) receives a read slice request that includes a slice name, where the slice name includes a generation number.
- a processing module e.g., of a distributed storage and task (DST) execution unit
- receives a read slice request that includes a slice name, where the slice name includes a generation number.
- DST distributed storage and task
- the processing module determines whether the generation number is associated with a locally stored encoded data slice. The determining may be based on accessing a local slice list.
- the method continues with step 402 of FIG. 41 where the processing module identifies a number of generations associated with the data.
- the method continues at step 428 where the processing module generates an alternate generation number based on the generation number and the number of generations.
- the processing module may increment or decrement the generation number based on a comparison of another generation number that is associated with locally stored encoded data slices and perform a deterministic function on the data identifier and the number of generations.
- the method continues at step 430 where the processing module generates an alternate slice name using the alternate generation number and the slice name. The generating includes replacing the generation number with the alternate generation number in the slice name to produce the alternate slice name.
- the method continues at step 432 where the processing module identifies another storage unit based on the alternate slice name.
- the identifying includes accessing a list of storage units associated with a set of generation number is associated with the slice name.
- the method continues at step 434 where the processing module retrieves an encoded data slice from the other storage units using the alternate slice name.
- the retrieving includes issuing a read slice requests to the other storage unit, where the request includes the alternate slice name.
- the processing module receives the encoded data slice from the other storage unit.
- the method continues at step 436 where the processing module outputs the encoded data slice to a requesting entity. Alternatively, or in addition to, the processing module stores the encoded data slice in a local memory and updates slice location information.
- FIGS. 43A , 43 C-F are schematic block diagrams of an embodiment of a dispersed storage network (DSN) illustrating an example of time-based storage of data.
- the DSN includes the distributed storage and task (DST) client module 34 of FIG. 1 , the network 24 of FIG. 1 , and the distributed storage and a DST execution (EX) unit set 438 .
- the DST execution unit set 438 includes a set of DST execution units 1-5. Each DST execution unit may be implemented utilizing the DST execution unit 36 of FIG. 1 .
- the DST execution unit set 438 may be referred to interchangeably as one or more of DSN memory, a set of storage units, and a storage unit set; and the DST execution unit may be referred to interchangeably as a storage unit.
- the DST client module 34 includes the outbound DST processing 80 of FIG. 3 .
- the DST client module 34 may further include a dispersed storage (DS) module 441 .
- the DS module 441 may be implemented utilizing a plurality of processing modules.
- the plurality of processing modules may include the processing module 84 of FIG. 3 .
- the plurality of processing module includes a first module, a second module, a third module, and a fourth module.
- the first through fourth modules may be utilized to implement the outbound DST processing 80 .
- the DSN functions to time-based store a large data object 442 in the DST execution unit set 438 .
- the large data object 442 may include at least one of a video file, a records file, a collection of images file a documentation file, or any other data object that has a data object size greater than a size threshold level, where the size threshold level is associated with a storage process that has a time to completion of storage that compares unfavorably to a potential change in availability of the DST execution unit set 438 .
- the availability of the DST execution unit set 438 may change during a time frame that the large data object is being stored to the DST execution unit set 438 .
- FIG. 43A illustrates initial steps of an example of the storing of the large data object 442 , where the outbound DST processing 80 receives the large data object 442 . Having received the large data object 442 , the outbound DST processing 80 encodes the large data object 442 in accordance with a dispersed storage error coding function to produce a plurality of sets of encoded data slices. As a specific example, the outbound DST processing 80 generates encoded data slice sets 1-M as the plurality of sets of encoded data slices and temporarily stores the encoded data slice sets 1-M in a send queue 440 .
- the outbound DST processing 80 obtains estimated future availability information for storage units of the DSN.
- the outbound DST processing 80 obtains availability information 444 from the DST execution unit set 438 .
- the availability information 444 includes one or more of an expected pattern of availability, expected start time of and availability level transition, expected duration of a next availability period, a maintenance schedule, a historical availability record, and an indication of a pending software update.
- the set of DST execution units 1-5 send, via the network 24 , availability information 1-5 as the availability information 444 to the outbound DST processing 80 .
- the outbound DST processing 80 interprets the availability information 444 to produce the estimated future availability information for the storage units. The generation and utilization of the estimated future availability information is discussed in greater detail with reference to FIG. 43B .
- FIG. 43B is a timing diagram illustrating an example of generating a time-availability pattern.
- the timing diagram includes a mapping of the estimated future availability information 446 versus time 448 and to a time-availability pattern 450 .
- the mapping of the estimated future availability information 446 versus time 444 indicates that DST execution unit 1 is expected to be available from a current time of t0 until a time of t2, unavailable from t2 to t8 due to a scheduled software update, and available again from t8 to t10.
- the example mapping also indicates that DST execution unit 2 is expected to be available from t0 to t5, unavailable from t5 to t8 due to scheduled maintenance, and available from t8 to t10.
- the example mapping also indicates that DST execution unit 3 is expected to be available from t0 to t6 and unavailable from t6 to t10 due to a scheduled power shutdown.
- the example mapping also indicates that DST execution units 4 and 5 are expected to be available from t0 to t10.
- the outbound DST processing 80 of FIG. 43A organizes the plurality of sets of encoded data slices into a plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices, where a group-set of encoded data slices includes multiple sets of encoded data slices.
- the outbound DST processing 80 organizes encoded slice sets 1 through M1 (e.g., of encoded slice sets 1-M) into a first group-set of encoded data slices to be associated with a first write transaction, encoded slice sets M1+1 through M2 into a second group-set of encoded data slices to be associated with a second write transaction, encoded slice sets M2+1 through M3 into a third group-set of encoded data slices to be associated with a third write transaction, and encoded slice sets M3+1 through M into a fourth group-set of encoded data slices to be associated with a fourth write transaction.
- M1 e.g., of encoded slice sets 1-M
- the outbound DST processing 80 estimates an approximate storage completion time to produce a plurality of approximate storage completion times.
- the estimating of the approximate storage completion time may be based on one or more of a network performance level of the network 24 , a loading level for the DST execution unit set 438 , a previous write transaction, a number of encoded data slices of the group-set of encoded data slices, and a size of each of the encoded data slices.
- the outbound DST processing 80 estimates that the first group-set of encoded data slices has an approximate storage completion time of a time duration associated with a time from t0 to t2.
- the outbound DST processing 80 obtains a write threshold number.
- the write threshold number includes a minimum number of available storage units of the set of storage units to facilitate favorable write transactions of each of the group-sets of encoded data slices.
- the write threshold number is greater than or equal to a decode threshold number and is less than or equal to an information dispersal algorithm (IDA) width, where the decode threshold number and IDA width are associated with the dispersed storage error coding function.
- the IDA width includes a number of encoded data slices of each set of encoded data slices and the decode threshold number includes a minimum number of encoded data slices required to recover data associated with a set of encoded data slices.
- the outbound DST processing 80 establishes the time-availability pattern 450 for writing the plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices to the storage units based on the estimated future availability information, the plurality of approximate storage completion times, and the write threshold number.
- the time-availability pattern 450 includes a plurality of time intervals and an availability indication for each of the storage units in each time interval of the plurality of time intervals.
- the storing of a group-set of the plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices spans at least one time interval of the plurality of time intervals.
- the outbound DST processing 80 establishes the time-availability pattern 450 to include writing the first group-set of encoded data slices during time interval t0-t2 when all five storage units are expected to be available, writing the second group-set of encoded data slices during time interval t2-t5 when four of the five storage units are available and the write threshold number is three, writing the third group-set of encoded data slices during time interval t5-t6 when three of the five storage units are available and the write threshold number is three, performing no writing during time interval t6-t8 when less than the write threshold number of storage units are expected to be available, and writing the fourth-set of encoded data slices during time interval t8-t10 when four of the five storage units are expected to be available and the write threshold number is three.
- the time-availability pattern 450 may further include an indication to send or withhold particular encoded data slices of a given set of encoded data slices based on the estimated future availability information 446 .
- the outbound DST processing 80 determines to withhold sending encoded data slices to DST execution unit 1 during the timeframe t2-t5 associated with the second write transaction when DST execution unit 1 is expected to be unavailable.
- the outbound DST processing 80 holds encoded data slices associated with DST execution unit 1 in the send queue 440 during time interval t2-t8 and sends the held encoded data slices (e.g., unwritten encoded data slices from the second and third write transactions) to the DST execution unit 1 over the time interval t8-t10.
- FIG. 43C illustrates further steps of an example of the storing of the large data object 442 , where the outbound DST processing 80 sends the plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices to at least some of the storage units for storage in accordance with the time-availability pattern 450 .
- the sending includes, for each of the plurality of group-set of encoded data slices, the outbound DST processing 80 assigning a transaction number (e.g., transaction numbers 1-4 for the four group-sets of encoded data slices) and generating a write request for each available storage unit per the time-availability pattern 450 to produce a set of write requests, where each write request of the set of write requests includes the transaction number.
- a transaction number e.g., transaction numbers 1-4 for the four group-sets of encoded data slices
- the outbound DST processing 80 initiates a write transaction 1 at time t0.
- the outbound DST processing 80 sends, via the network 24 , a set of write slice requests 1-1 through 1-5 to DST execution units 1-5, where the set of write slice request includes the first group-set of encoded data slices and the transaction number 1.
- the outbound DST processing 80 queues sending an encoded data slice of each set of the given group-set of encoded data slices and when the one of the storage units is available and when another given group-set of the plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices is being sent to the storage units, the outbound DST processing 80 sends the encoded data slice of each set of the given group-set of encoded data slices to the one of the storage units.
- FIG. 43D illustrates further steps of an example of the storing of the large data object 442 , where the outbound DST processing 80 compares, as time passes, actual availability information of the storage units with corresponding time portions of the estimated future availability information 450 .
- the outbound DST processing 80 re-obtains the availability information 444 from the DST execution unit set 438 prior to time t2.
- the outbound DST processing 80 adjusts the time-availability pattern 450 based on a difference between the actual availability information and estimated future availability information for the corresponding time portions. For instance, the outbound DST processing 80 suspends sending of a next group-set of encoded data slices when the actual availability information for a next time frame indicates that less than the write threshold number of storage units are estimated to be available.
- the outbound DST processing 80 ceases the sending of the given group-set of the plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices and queues the given group-set of the plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices for sending to the at least some of the storage units when at least the write threshold number of storage units are available.
- FIG. 43E illustrates further steps of an example of the storing of the large data object 442 , where the outbound DST processing 80 initiates a write transaction 2 at time t2.
- the outbound DST processing 80 sends, via the network 24 , a set of write slice requests 2-1 through 2-5 to DST execution units 1-5, where the set of write slice request includes the second group-set of encoded data slices and the transaction number 2.
- FIG. 43F illustrates further steps of an example of the storing of the large data object 442 , where the outbound DST processing 80 compares further actual availability information of the storage units with corresponding time portions of the estimated future availability information 450 .
- the outbound DST processing 80 re-obtains the availability information 444 from the DST execution unit set 438 prior to time t5 and interprets the re-obtained availability information 444 to produce the further actual availability information.
- the outbound DST processing 80 adjusts the time-availability pattern 450 based on a difference between the further actual availability information and estimated future availability information for the corresponding time portions.
- FIG. 43G is a flowchart illustrating an example of time-based storage of data.
- a method is presented for use in conjunction with one or more functions and features described in conjunction with FIGS. 1-39 and also FIGS. 43A-F .
- the method includes step 460 where a processing module (e.g., of a distributed storage and task (DST) client module of a dispersed storage network (DSN)) obtains estimated future availability information for storage units of the DSN.
- DST distributed storage and task
- DSN dispersed storage network
- step 462 the processing module organizes a plurality of sets of encoded data slices into a plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices.
- a group-set of encoded data slices includes multiple sets of encoded data slices.
- the data is encoded in accordance with a dispersed storage error coding function to produce the plurality of sets of encoded data slices.
- Dispersal parameters are associated with the dispersed storage error coding function.
- the dispersal parameters includes one or more of an information dispersal algorithm width (e.g., a number of encoded data slices of each set of encoded data slices), a write threshold number (e.g., a subset number of the IDA width required to successfully write a representation of the set of encoded data slices to the storage units), and a decode threshold number (e.g., a minimum number of encoded data slices of the set of encoded data slices required to recover data represented by the set of encoded data slices).
- an information dispersal algorithm width e.g., a number of encoded data slices of each set of encoded data slices
- a write threshold number e.g., a subset number of the IDA width required to successfully write a representation of the set of encoded data slices to the storage units
- a decode threshold number e.g., a minimum number of encoded data slices of the set of encoded data slices required to recover data represented by the set of encoded data slices.
- the method continues at step 464 where the processing module estimates an approximate storage completion time to produce a plurality of approximate storage completion times.
- the method continues at step 466 of the processing module obtains the write threshold number (e.g., retrieves from system registry information, receives, determines based on storage requirements and a system performance level).
- step 468 the processing module establishes a time-availability pattern for writing the plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices to the storage units based on the estimated future availability information, the plurality of approximate storage completion times, and the write threshold number.
- the establishing may include comparing, as time passes, actual availability information of the storage units with corresponding time portions of the estimated future availability information and when the actual availability information does not substantially match the estimated future availability information for the corresponding time portions, adjusting the time-availability pattern based on a difference between the actual availability information and estimated future availability information for the corresponding time portions.
- step 470 the processing module sends the plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices to at least some of the storage units for storage in accordance with the time-availability pattern.
- the sending includes, for each of the plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices, assigning a transaction number and generating a write request for each available storage unit per the time-availability pattern to produce a set of write requests, where each write request of the set of write requests includes the transaction number.
- the processing module queues sending an encoded data slice of each set of the given group-set of encoded data slices.
- the processing module sends the encoded data slice of each set of the given group-set of encoded data slices to the one of the storage units.
- the processing module ceases the sending of the given group-set of the plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices and queues the given group-set of the plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices for sending to the at least some of the storage units when at least the write threshold number of storage units are available.
- FIG. 44A is a schematic block diagram of another embodiment of a distributed storage and task (DST) execution unit 36 of FIG. 11 .
- the DST execution unit 36 includes an interface 169 , the memory 88 , the controller 86 , a plurality of distributed task (DT) execution modules 90 , and a plurality of DST client modules 34 .
- the controller 86 obtains status of the plurality of DT execution modules 90 and the plurality of DST client modules 34 .
- the obtaining includes one or more of issuing a task control message 480 to the plurality of DT execution modules 90 , issuing a DST control message 482 to the plurality of DST client modules 34 , receiving a task control message 480 from one or more of the DT execution modules 90 that includes the status, and receiving a DST control message 482 from one or more of the DST client modules 34 that includes the status.
- the status includes one or more of processing utilization level information, memory utilization level information, garbage collection logs, error information, and pending activity information.
- the controller 86 receives a request via the interface 169 , where the request includes at least one of a slice processing request and a partial task 98 .
- the controller 86 identifies a resource type based on the request (e.g., a DT execution module type for the partial task 98 and a DST client module type for the slice processing request).
- the controller 86 determines whether the resource type is available based on the status. When the resource type is available, the controller 86 selects a particular resource for assignment of the request. For example, the controller 86 identifies a third DST client module 34 that is most available for the request when the request is the slice processing request.
- the controller 86 selects a fourth DT execution module 90 when the fourth DT execution module 90 is associated with processing resources capable of executing the partial task 98 when the request is the partial task 98 .
- the controller 86 assigns the request to the selected resource.
- the assigning includes at least one of outputting an assignment task control message to an assigned DT execution module 90 and outputting an assignment DST control message to the assigned DST client module.
- the controller 86 may issue an error response via the interface 169 to a requesting entity and/or to a managing unit.
- the assigned DT execution module 90 executes the assigned partial task 98 to produce partial results 102 .
- the assigned DT execution module 90 facilitates the memory 88 to retrieve slices 96 and to output results 104 .
- the assigned a DST client module 34 executes the slice processing request to facilitate producing at least one of sub-slice groupings 170 and sub-partial partial tasks 172 .
- the DST client module 34 may facilitate the memory 88 to provide slices 100 and/or two receives slices 96 for further slice processing.
- FIG. 44B is a flowchart illustrating an example of assigning resources.
- the method includes step 484 where a processing module (e.g., of a controller module) obtains resource status information for a plurality of task execution modules and a plurality of dispersed storage modules.
- the obtaining includes at least one of receiving, issuing a query, performing a lookup, accessing a historical record, and interpreting an activity log.
- the method continues at step 486 where the processing module receives a request.
- the method continues at step 488 where the processing module identifies a resource type based on the request. For example, the processing module identifies the resource type based on a type of the request. For instance, the processing module identifies a distributed task execution module receiving a partial task requests. In another instance, the processing module identifies a distributed storage and task client module type when receiving a slice processing request.
- the processing module may identify another resource type for another request type.
- step 490 the processing module determines whether the resource type is available. For example, for each resource, the processing module interprets pending request to produce a predicted loading level and compares the predicted loading level to an upper loading level threshold. The processing module indicates available when the comparison is favorable (e.g., more capacities available than required). The method branches to step 494 when the resource type is available. The method continues to step 492 when the resource type is not available. The method continues at step 492 where the processing module issues and error response when the resource type is not available. The issuing of the error response includes generating an error message and sending the error message to at least one of a requesting entity and a managing unit.
- the method continues at step 494 where the processing module selects at least one resource of the plurality of task execution modules and the plurality of dispersed storage modules when the resource type is available. For example, the processing module identifies a resource associated with a most favorable comparison of predicted loading to available loading (e.g., most available capacity).
- the method continues at step 496 where the processing module assigns the request to the selected at least one resource. For example, the processing module sends the request to the selected resource.
- FIG. 45A is a schematic block diagram of another embodiment of a dispersed storage network (DSN) system that includes the distributed storage and task network (DSTN) module 22 of FIG. 1 , a set of distributed storage and task (DST) processing units 1-N, where each DST processing unit includes the DST processing unit 16 of FIG. 1 , and a load-balancing module 498 .
- the DSTN module 22 includes the DST execution unit set 438 of FIG. 43A .
- the DST execution unit set 438 includes a set of DST execution units 36 of FIG. 1 .
- the system functions to store data 500 as a plurality of sets of encoded data slices 504 in the DST execution unit set 438 .
- the load-balancing module 498 selects one of the DST processing units, based on resource status information 502 from the DST processing units, to encode the data 500 using a dispersed storage error coding function to produce the plurality of sets of encoded data slices 504 for storage in the DST execution unit set 438 .
- the resource status information 502 includes one or more of an indicator of a time frame of availability, an indicator of a time frame of unavailability, a time frame for a scheduled software update, a time frame for a scheduled new hardware addition, an error message, a maintenance schedule, a communications error rate, and a storage error rate.
- a DST processing unit determines to at least temporarily suspend operations. The determining may be based on one or more of adding new software, activating new hardware, recovering from a storage error, recovering from a communications error, receiving a suspend request, and interpreting the maintenance schedule.
- the DST processing unit continues to perform a slice access activity with regards to pending data access requests associated with the DST processing unit.
- the load-balancing module 498 receives a new data access request.
- the load-balancing module 498 determines availability of each of the DST processing units based on one or more of receiving resource status information 502 , initiating a query, receiving an error message, and detecting an unfavorable performance (e.g., detecting slow response latency).
- the load-balancing module 498 selects the DST processing unit when the availability (e.g., previously known availability) of the DST processing unit compares favorably to availability of other DST processing units.
- the load-balancing module 498 forwards the data access requests to the DST processing unit.
- the DST processing units While suspending operations, the DST processing units indicates the unfavorable performance to the load-balancing module.
- the indicating unfavorable performance includes at least one of ignoring the request, sending a late unfavorable response, issuing unfavorable resource status information, and ignoring resource status requests from the load-balancing module.
- the load-balancing module 498 interprets the indication to determine that the data access request is to be reassigned.
- the load-balancing module 498 un-selects the DST processing unit from the data access assignment. For example, the load-balancing module sends a cancellation message to the DST processing unit and selects another DST processing unit and sends the data access request to the other DST processing unit.
- FIG. 45B is a diagram illustrating an example of load-balancing.
- the method includes step 506 where a distributed storage and task (DST) processing unit determines to temporarily suspend operations.
- the method continues at step 508 where the DST processing unit continues to execute pending operations. For example, the DST processing unit continues to process previously accepted data access requests.
- the method continues at step 510 where a load-balancing module receives a data access request.
- the method continues at step 512 where the load-balancing module assesses availability of a set of DST processing units that includes the DST processing unit.
- the assessing includes producing availability information based on one or more of interpreting performance indicators, receiving resource status information, initiating a query, receiving an error message, and detecting favorable performance.
- step 514 the load-balancing module selects the DST processing unit for execution of the data access request. For example, the load-balancing module selects the DST processing unit when availability of the DST processing unit compares more favorably to availability of other DST processing units.
- step 516 the load-balancing module forwards the data access request to the DST processing unit.
- the method continues at step 518 where the DST processing unit indicates unfavorable performance. For example, the DST processing unit ignores the data access requests. As another example, the DST processing unit waits a delay time period before sending a data access response causing the load-balancing module to interpret the data access response as a late data access response associated with unfavorable performance. As yet another example, the DST processing unit delays responses associated with previous accepted data access requests.
- the method continues at step 520 where the load-balancing module detects the indicated unfavorable performance. For example, the load-balancing module detects the indicated unfavorable performance when the data access response was not received within a desired response timeframe.
- the method continues at step 522 where the load-balancing module un-selects the DST processing unit for execution of the data access request.
- the un-selecting includes one or more of sending a cancellation message to the DST processing unit, selecting another DST processing unit for the data access request, and assigning the other DST processing unit the data access request.
- the method continues at step 524 where the DST processing unit determines to resume operations. The determining may be based on one or more of detecting that new software is operational, detecting that new hardware is operational, detecting that an error condition has cleared, and detecting that a level of pending data access requests has fallen below a low data access request threshold level.
- the method continues at step 526 where the DST processing unit indicates favorable performance. For example, the DST processing unit generates data access responses in accordance with desired data access response timing. As another example, the DST processing unit responds to all data access requests. As yet another example, the DST processing unit sends favorable resource status information to the load-balancing module.
- FIG. 46A is a schematic block diagram of another embodiment of a distributed storage and task (DST) execution unit 36 that includes the distributed storage and task (DST) client module 34 and one or more memory devices 88 of FIG. 3 .
- the memory 88 includes a plurality of portions of memory associated with different utilizations. The portions may be physical memory or virtual memory space.
- the plurality of portions includes one or more portions utilized for slices memory 606 , utilized for rebuilt slices memory 608 , reserved for rebuilt slices memory 610 , and un-utilized memory 612 .
- the un-utilized memory 612 is associated with available storage capacity, where the available storage capacity may be calculated as a memory size minus memory used for each of the utilized for slices memory 606 , memory used for the utilized for rebuilt slices memory 608 , and memory used for the reserved for rebuilt slices memory 610 .
- the DST execution unit 36 functions to store encoded data slices 600 in the utilized for slices memory 606 and store rebuilt encoded data slices 602 in the utilized for rebuilt slices memory.
- the DST client module 34 may obtain the rebuilt encoded data slices by at least one of: receiving the rebuilt encoded data slices and generating the rebuilt encoded data slices by retrieving representations of encoded data slices from a decode threshold number of other DST execution units 36 .
- the DST client module 34 determines whether sufficient available storage capacity of the un-utilized memory is available for utilization for slices memory. For instance, the DST client module compares a size of an encoded data slice for storage to the size of the un-utilized memory.
- the DST client module indicates that storage space is available when the size of the encoded data slice is less than the size of the un-utilized memory.
- the DST client module 34 may determine the size of the reserved for rebuilt slices memory based on identifying encoded data slices to be rebuilt. The identifying includes at least one of detecting a slice error and receiving an indication of the slice error.
- the DST client module 34 identifies a plurality of encoded data slices requiring rebuilding.
- the DST client module 34 determines an amount of reserve memory 610 required for storage of rebuilt slices for the identified plurality of encoded data slices requiring rebuilding.
- the determining may include exchanging memory utilization information 604 with at least one other DST execution unit, where the exchanging includes receiving an amount of memory required for an encoded data slice associated with, for example, a slice error.
- the DST client module 34 updates the memory utilization information to include the amount of reserve memory required.
- the memory utilization information includes one or more of size of the utilized for slices memory, size of the utilized for rebuilt slices memory, size of the reserved for rebuilt slices memory, and size of the un-utilized memory.
- the DST client module 34 outputs the memory utilization information 604 to one or more of a DST processing unit, a managing unit, and a user device.
- the DST client module 34 obtains rebuilt encoded data slices (e.g., receives, generates) and stores the rebuilt encoded data slices in the utilized for rebuilt encoded data slices memory. Accordingly, the DST client module updates the reserved for rebuilt slices memory by a similar memory size amount as storage of the rebuild encoded data slices (e.g., lowers size of reserved for rebuilt slices memory and raises size for utilized for rebuilt slices memory). The DST client module updates the memory utilization information and may output the updated memory utilization information.
- FIG. 46B-C are diagrams illustrating examples of memory utilization for a series of times frames, where each timeframe indicates an amount of memory utilized for slices, rebuilt slices, reserved for rebuilt slices, unutilized, and a total amount of memory capacity. The total amount of memory capacity remains constant over the time intervals.
- FIG. 46 B illustrates examples of the memory utilization 614 for a first set of time intervals T1-5.
- stored slices use 300 TB of memory space of a total capacity of 500 TB of memory space leaving 200 TB of unutilized memory space.
- 50 TB of slices for rebuilding are detected such that reserved for rebuilding is incremented by 50 TB and unutilized memory space is lowered by 50 TB from 200 TB to 150 TB.
- a first 20 TB of rebuilt slices are obtained and stored such that the reserved memory space for rebuilt slices is lowered by 20 TB from 50 TB to 30 TB.
- a remaining 30 TB of rebuilt slices are obtained and stored such that the reserve memory space rebuilt slices is lowered by another 30 TB from 30 TB two 0 TB and the rebuilt slices is raised to buy 30 TB from 20 TB to 50 TB.
- the rebuilt slices are moved to the memory space for slices thus raising the rebuilt slices by 50 TB from 300 TB to 350 TB.
- Utilized memory includes the combination 615 of utilized for slices memory 606 , memory used for the utilized for rebuilt slices memory 608 , and memory used for the reserved for rebuilt slices memory 610 .
- FIG. 46C continues the examples of memory utilization 616 for second set of time intervals T6-T10.
- the example begins at time interval T6 which is equivalent to memory utilization of T5.
- T7 100 TB of new slices are stored thus raising the memory utilization of slices from 350 TB to 450 TB and lowering the unutilized memory space from 150 TB to 50 TB.
- T8 50 TB of slices for rebuilding is detected such that memory space of reserved for rebuilding is incremented by 50 TB from zero to 50 TB and memory space of unutilized is lowered by 50 TB from 50 TB two 0 TB. Requests for storage of new slices are rejected since the memory space of the unutilized memory is zero.
- 50 TB of rebuilt slices are received and stored in the memory space of the rebuilt slices thus raising the rebuilt slices from 0 TB to 50 TB and lowering the memory space for rebuilt slices from 50 TB to 0 TB.
- the slices of the memory space rebuilt slices is considered part of the memory space of slices thus raising the memory space of the slices from 450 TB to 500 TB and lowering the memory space of the rebuilt slices from 50 TB to 0 TB. As such, the memory storage space is full and subsequent request for storage of slices or rebuilt slices shall be rejected.
- FIG. 46D is a flowchart illustrating an example of updating memory utilization information.
- the method begins at step 618 where a processing module (e.g., of a distributed storage and task (DST) client module) identifies a plurality of encoded data slices requiring rebuilding.
- a processing module e.g., of a distributed storage and task (DST) client module
- DST distributed storage and task
- the identifying includes at least one of: receiving an error message 632 (e.g., no slices detected for rebuild, no access to rebuild information, not enough space to rebuild, etc.); receiving a rebuilding request 634 (e.g., to rebuild specific data slices or range of data slices); detecting missing or corrupted encoded data slices by comparing a list of locally stored encoded data slices (or range of slices) to a list of remotely stored encoded data slices (or range of slices) associated with the locally stored encoded data slices to identify missing slices or detecting unfavorable slice integrity (e.g., corrupted slices); monitoring downloads 638 to the DS memory meeting minimum read/write (R/W) width thresholds but less than a full pillar width (successful download, but not all slices above threshold successfully downloaded); determining 640 when DSN read/write (R/W) requests occur for the plurality of encoded data slices and comparing to known times of inaccessibility for the
- the rebuilding of the plurality of encoded data slices is, in one embodiment, queued for at least one of individual, group, or batch processing and the processing will be performed at a significant time delay from the queuing.
- the embodiments of FIGS. 46A-G ensure that memory space is set aside for rebuilds such that interceding requests for memory slice storage will not over utilize memory needed for the rebuild before it has a chance to occur.
- the method continues at the step 620 where the processing module determines an amount of memory space to reserve for the plurality of encoded data slices requiring rebuilding.
- the determining includes identifying slice sizes based on at least one of initiating a slice size query with regards to the remotely stored encoded data slices, receiving a query response, and performing a local lookup based on a slice name.
- the method continues at step 622 where the processing module updates memory utilization information to include the amount of memory space to reserve. For example, the processing module increments an amount of memory reserved for rebuilt slices by the amount of memory space to reserve and decrements unutilized memory space by the amount of memory space to reserve.
- the method continues at step 624 where the processing module sends the memory utilization information to at least one of a storing entity and a managing unit. The sending may further include determining whether a sum of an amount of memory utilized for slices, an amount of memory utilize for rebuilt slices, and an amount of memory reserved for rebuilt slices is greater than a capacity of memory. When the sum is greater, the processing module may further send an indication that the memory is full.
- the method continues at step 626 where the processing module obtains rebuilt encoded data slices (e.g., received, generate).
- the method continues at step 628 where the processing module stores the rebuilt encoded data slices in a local DS memory.
- the method continues at step 630 where the processing module updates the amount of memory space to reserve for remaining encoded data slices requiring rebuilding.
- the updating includes determining an amount of memory space utilized to store the obtained rebuilt encoded data slices, incrementing the amount of memory space utilized for rebuilt slices by the amount of memory space utilized to store the obtained rebuilt encoded data slices, and decrementing the amount of memory space reserved for rebuilt slices by the amount of memory space utilized to store the obtained rebuilt encoded data slices.
- the updating may further include updating the memory space utilized for slices to include the amount of memory space utilized to store the obtained rebuilt encoded data slices and decrementing the amount of memory space utilized to store the rebuild encoded data slices.
- the method loops back to the step where the processing module updates the memory utilization information.
- FIG. 46F is a flowchart illustrating another example of updating memory utilization information.
- the method begins at step 642 where a processing module (e.g., DST integrity processing unit 20 ) attempts to retrieve a plurality of encoded data slices from a DS memory to perform an integrity check. Slices are retrieved based on any of: list(s) of slice addresses, list(s) of names, range(s) of slice addresses and range(s) of slice names.
- step 646 for encoded data slices that were not received and/or not listed, they are flagged as missing slices. For retrieved encoded data slices, they are checked for errors due to data corruption, outdated version, etc.
- step 648 if a slice includes an error, it is flagged as a ‘bad’ slice. Bad and/or missing slices are subsequently rebuilt using other retrieved encoded data slices that are deemed to be good slices to produce rebuilt slices.
- the rebuilding of the plurality of encoded data slices is, in one embodiment, queued for at least one of individual, group, or batch processing and the processing will be performed at a significant time delay from the queuing.
- the embodiments of FIGS. 47A-G ensure that memory space is set aside for rebuilds such that interceding requests for memory slice storage will not over utilize memory needed for the rebuild before it has a chance to occur.
- the method continues at the step 650 where the processing module determines an amount of memory space to reserve for the plurality of encoded data slices requiring rebuilding.
- the determining includes identifying slice sizes based on at least one of initiating a slice size query with regards to the remotely stored encoded data slices, receiving a query response, and performing a local lookup based on a slice name.
- the method continues at step 652 where the processing module updates memory utilization information to include the amount of memory space to reserve. For example, the processing module increments an amount of memory reserved for rebuilt slices by the amount of memory space to reserve and decrements unutilized memory space by the amount of memory space to reserve.
- the method continues at step 653 where the processing module sends the memory utilization information to at least one of a storing entity (e.g., storage/vault peers), user units and a managing unit.
- the sending may further include determining whether a sum of an amount of memory utilized for slices, an amount of memory utilize for rebuilt slices, and an amount of memory reserved for rebuilt slices is greater than a capacity of memory. When the sum is greater, the processing module may further send an indication that the memory is full.
- the method continues at step 654 where the processing module obtains rebuilt encoded data slices (e.g., received, generated) and stores, in step 656 , the rebuilt encoded data slices in a local DS memory.
- the method continues at step 657 where the processing module updates the amount of memory space to reserve for remaining encoded data slices requiring rebuilding.
- the updating includes determining an amount of memory space utilized to store the obtained rebuilt encoded data slices, incrementing the amount of memory space utilized for rebuilt slices by the amount of memory space utilized to store the obtained rebuilt encoded data slices, and decrementing the amount of memory space reserved for rebuilt slices by the amount of memory space utilized to store the obtained rebuilt encoded data slices.
- the updating may further include updating the memory space utilized for slices to include the amount of memory space utilized to store the obtained rebuilt encoded data slices and decrementing the amount of memory space utilized to store the rebuild encoded data slices.
- FIG. 46G is a schematic block diagram illustrating an example DST client module 34 structure for memory utilization.
- DST client module 34 may include a plurality of processing modules (or sub-modules) to perform one or more steps of the embodiments of FIGS. 46A-F . While this example is shown as seven separate modules, the modules may be combined/separated into any number of modules (local or remote) to complete the various steps and functions of the various embodiments of FIGS. 46A-F .
- identify module 34 - 1 identifies a plurality of encoded data slices that require rebuilding, wherein rebuilding of the plurality of encoded data slices is queued for at least one of individual, group, or batch processing and the processing will be performed at a significant time delay from the queuing.
- Determine module 34 - 2 determines an amount of memory required for storage of the rebuild encoded data slices for the plurality of encoded data slices.
- Update module 34 - 3 updates utilization information of the memory by allocating a portion of available memory to the amount of memory required.
- Indicate module 34 - 4 indicates the memory utilization (e.g., by sending the updated utilization information 604 of the memory to at least one of a storing entity (e.g., other storage/vault peers) and a managing unit).
- Obtain module 34 - 5 obtains rebuilt data slices (e.g., from other good copies or related vaults or generates them from other encoded data slices).
- Store module 34 - 6 stores the rebuilt encoded data slices in the reserve memory; and modify module 34 - 7 modifies the utilization information to reflect the stored rebuilt encoded data slices.
- Additional modules may be included within DST client module 34 to perform additional tasks (for example, but not limited to, passing encoded data slices to/from slice memory during non-rebuild write/read (W/R) operations).
- W/R non-rebuild write/read
- obtain module 34 - 5 and store module 34 - 6 may perform the receive and store slices 600 tasks, respectively.
- FIG. 47A is a schematic block diagram of another embodiment of a dispersed storage network (DSN) system that includes the disbursing storage and task (DST) processing unit 16 and the distributed storage and task network (DSTN) module 22 of FIG. 1 .
- the DSTN module 22 includes at least two DST execution unit sets 1-2. Each DST execution unit set includes a set of DST execution units 36 of FIG. 1 .
- the system functions to store at least two data objects in a common DST execution unit set.
- the DST processing unit 16 receives a data object 1 write request 700 .
- the DST processing unit 16 encodes data object 1 using a dispersed storage error coding function to produce first sets (data object 1) of encoded data slices 700 - 1 , 2 , . . . n (where n equals the width (number of pillars) of the encoded data slice set).
- the DST processing unit 16 generates first sets of slice names for the first sets of encoded data slices.
- the DST processing unit 16 issues one or more sets of data object 1 write slice requests to a DST execution unit set 1 that includes the first sets of encoded data slices and the corresponding first sets of slice names, where the first sets of slice names fall within a range of slice names associated with the DST execution unit set 1 .
- the DST processing unit 16 receives a data object 2 co-locate write request 702 with regards to storing a second data object in the same set of DST execution units 36 as the first data object (e.g., in the DST execution unit set 1).
- the data object 2 co-locate write request includes a data identifier (ID) of the data object to be co-located with (e.g., a data ID of the data object 1), a data ID of the second data object (e.g., the data object 2 to be co-located), and may include the data (e.g., data object 2) to be co-located when it is not already stored within the DSTN module 22 .
- ID data identifier
- the DST processing unit 16 identifies the set of DST execution units 36 associated with the data ID of data object 1 to be co-located with (e.g., the DST execution unit set 1).
- the determining includes accessing one or more of a directory and a dispersed hierarchical index to identify a DSN address associated with the data ID of data object 1 to be co-located with and performing a DSN address-to-physical location table lookup to identify the set of DST execution units 36 associated with the data ID of data object 1 to be co-located with.
- the DST processing unit encodes the second data object (data object 2) to produce second sets of encoded data slices for storage in the DST execution unit set 1.
- the DST processing unit 16 generates second sets of slice names for the second sets of encoded data slices, where the second sets of slice names are based on the first sets of slice names such that the second sets of slice names fall within a range of slice names associated with a range of slice names associated with the set of DST execution units 36 associated with the data ID of data object 1 to be co-located with.
- DST processing unit 16 issues data object 2 write slice requests to the set of DST execution units 36 associated with the data ID of the data object to be co-located with (e.g., to DST execution unit set 1), where the data object 2 write slice requests includes the second sets of encoded data slices.
- the DST processing unit 16 determines whether the data object to be co-located is already co-located. The determining includes the DST processing unit 16 identifying the DST execution unit set associated with storage of the second data object and comparing the identity to the identity of the DST execution unit set associated with storage of the first data object.
- the DST processing unit 16 recovers data object 2 from the DST execution unit set associated with storage of the second data object (e.g., from DST execution unit set 2).
- the recovering includes issuing data object 2 read slice requests 704 to the DST execution unit set associated with storage of the second data object and receiving the second sets of encoded data slices (e.g., received from DST execution unit set 2).
- the DST processing unit 16 issues the data object 2 write slice requests to the set of DST execution units 36 associated with the data ID of the data object 1 to be co-located with (e.g., to DST execution unit set 1), where the data object 2 write slice requests includes the received second sets of encoded data slices and the corresponding second sets of slice names.
- FIG. 47B is a diagram illustrating an example of generating an updated slice name for a previously stored encoded data slice of a second data object to be co-located with one or more encoded data slices of a first data object.
- the slice name 706 has a structure that includes a slice index field 708 , a vault identifier (ID) field 710 , a generation field 712 , an object number field 714 , and a segment number field 716 .
- a substantial number of the fields of the slice name structure of a slice name of the previously stored encoded data slice of the second data object are updated to be substantially aligned with corresponding fields of the slice name structure of a slice name of the one or more encoded data slices of the first data object.
- a vault ID field entry of the previous data object 2 slice 1 is updated to be substantially the same as a vault ID field entry of data object 1 slice 1.
- an object number field entry of the previous data object 2 slice 1 is updated based on an object number field entry of the previous data object 2 slice 1 such that the slice name of the updated data object 2 slice 1 falls within a range of slice names associated with storage of the first data object.
- FIG. 47C is a flowchart illustrating an example of co-locating storage of data objects.
- the method begins at step 718 where a processing module (e.g., a distributed storage and task (DST) processing unit) receives a data object 2 co-locate write request to co-locate a data object 2 with a data object 1 to be co-located with.
- the write request includes one or more of data identifiers (IDs) for the data object 2 to be co-located and the data object 1 to be co-located with.
- IDs data identifiers
- the method continues at step 720 where the processing module obtains a plurality of sets of encoded data slices for the data object 2 to co-locate.
- the obtaining includes one of receiving, generating, and retrieving.
- the processing module When receiving, the processing module extracts the plurality of sets of encoded data slices from the write request 700 .
- the processing module encodes the data object 2 be co-located using a dispersed storage error coding function to produce the plurality of sets of encoded data slices.
- the processing module identifies previous sets of slice names utilized to store the plurality of sets of encoded data slices based on a data ID of the data object 2 to become co-located, issues one or more sets of read slice requests to a previously utilized set of storage units where the one or more sets of read slice requests includes the previous sets of slice names, and receiving the plurality of sets of encoded data slices 704 .
- the processing module generates a plurality of sets of slice names for the plurality of sets of encoded data slices based on addressing information of the data object 1 to be co-located with. For example, the processing module generates the plurality of sets of slice names to include a vault ID associated with the data object to be co-located with and an object number field entry that causes the generated plurality of sets of slice names to fall within a slice name range that is associated with a set of storage units where the data object to be co-located with is stored.
- the method continues at the step 724 where the processing module stores the plurality of sets of encoded data slices in the set of storage units using the generated plurality of sets of slice names.
- the storing includes generating one or more sets of write slice requests that includes the plurality of sets of encoded data slices and the generated plurality of sets of slice names and outputting the one or more sets of read slice requests to the set of storage units.
- the processing module deletes the plurality of sets of encoded data slices utilizing the previous sets of slice names. For example, the processing module issues a set of delete slice requests that includes the previous sets of slice names to the previous utilized set of storage units.
- FIG. 47D is a flowchart illustrating one example of obtaining the plurality of sets of encoded data slices to be co-located.
- the obtaining, step 720 includes multiple processing paths for receiving, generating, and retrieving the plurality of sets of encoded data slices to be co-located (data object 2) based on the location of data object 2 at the time of the request.
- the processing module extracts in step 727 the ID of data object 1, ID of data object 2 and, if included with the request, the plurality of data object 2 sets of encoded slices from the write request 700 .
- the DST processing unit 16 identifies, beginning with step 730 , the set of DST execution units 36 associated with data ID 1 of the data object to be co-located with (e.g., the DST execution unit set 1).
- the determining includes accessing one or more of a directory in step 731 and a dispersed hierarchical index in step 732 to identify a DSN address associated with data object 1 ID to be co-located with and performing a DSN address-to-physical location table lookup in step 734 to identify the physical location (PL) address set of DST execution units 36 associated with the data ID of the data object to be co-located with. If data object 2 is not already encoded, it is encoded in step 729 using a dispersed storage error coding function.
- the DST processing unit 16 determines whether the data object to be co-located is already co-located. The determining includes comparing data object 2 PL to data object 1 PL. If they are co-located (data object 2 PL is stored within a range of addresses for data object 1 PL) no further action is required. When data object 2 to be co-located is not already co-located, the DST processing unit 16 recovers (reads), in step 736 , the second data object from the DST execution unit set associated with storage of the second data object (e.g., from DST execution unit set 2).
- FIG. 47E is a schematic block diagram of another embodiment of a dispersed storage network (DSN) system in accordance with the present disclosure.
- DST processing unit 16 may include a plurality of processing modules (or sub-modules) to perform one or more steps of the embodiments of FIGS. 47A-D . While this example is shown as four separate modules, the modules may be combined or separated into any number of modules (local or remote) to complete the various steps and functions of the various embodiments of FIGS. 47A-D .
- receive module 16 - 1 operates to receive a data object co-locate write request.
- Obtain module 16 - 2 operates to obtain a plurality of sets of encoded data slices for a data object to co-locate.
- Generate module 16 - 3 operates to generate a plurality of sets of slice names for the data object to co-locate based on another plurality of sets of slice names associated with a data object to be co-located with.
- Store module 16 - 4 operates to store the plurality of sets of encoded data slices in DS memory using the generated plurality of sets of slice names for the data object co-locate.
- the terms “substantially” and “approximately” provides an industry-accepted tolerance for its corresponding term and/or relativity between items. Such an industry-accepted tolerance ranges from less than one percent to fifty percent and corresponds to, but is not limited to, component values, integrated circuit process variations, temperature variations, rise and fall times, and/or thermal noise. Such relativity between items ranges from a difference of a few percent to magnitude differences.
- the term(s) “operably coupled to”, “coupled to”, and/or “coupling” includes direct coupling between items and/or indirect coupling between items via an intervening item (e.g., an item includes, but is not limited to, a component, an element, a circuit, and/or a module) where, for indirect coupling, the intervening item does not modify the information of a signal but may adjust its current level, voltage level, and/or power level.
- inferred coupling i.e., where one element is coupled to another element by inference
- the term “operable to” or “operably coupled to” indicates that an item includes one or more of power connections, input(s), output(s), etc., to perform, when activated, one or more its corresponding functions and may further include inferred coupling to one or more other items.
- the term “associated with”, includes direct and/or indirect coupling of separate items and/or one item being embedded within another item.
- the term “compares favorably”, indicates that a comparison between two or more items, signals, etc., provides a desired relationship. For example, when the desired relationship is that signal 1 has a greater magnitude than signal 2, a favorable comparison may be achieved when the magnitude of signal 1 is greater than that of signal 2 or when the magnitude of signal 2 is less than that of signal 1.
- processing module may be a single processing device or a plurality of processing devices.
- a processing device may be a microprocessor, micro-controller, digital signal processor, microcomputer, central processing unit, field programmable gate array, programmable logic device, state machine, logic circuitry, analog circuitry, digital circuitry, and/or any device that manipulates signals (analog and/or digital) based on hard coding of the circuitry and/or operational instructions.
- the processing module, module, processing circuit, and/or processing unit may be, or further include, memory and/or an integrated memory element, which may be a single memory device, a plurality of memory devices, and/or embedded circuitry of another processing module, module, processing circuit, and/or processing unit.
- a memory device may be a read-only memory, random access memory, volatile memory, non-volatile memory, static memory, dynamic memory, flash memory, cache memory, and/or any device that stores digital information.
- processing module, module, processing circuit, and/or processing unit includes more than one processing device, the processing devices may be centrally located (e.g., directly coupled together via a wired and/or wireless bus structure) or may be distributedly located (e.g., cloud computing via indirect coupling via a local area network and/or a wide area network). Further note that if the processing module, module, processing circuit, and/or processing unit implements one or more of its functions via a state machine, analog circuitry, digital circuitry, and/or logic circuitry, the memory and/or memory element storing the corresponding operational instructions may be embedded within, or external to, the circuitry comprising the state machine, analog circuitry, digital circuitry, and/or logic circuitry.
- the memory element may store, and the processing module, module, processing circuit, and/or processing unit executes, hard coded and/or operational instructions corresponding to at least some of the steps and/or functions illustrated in one or more of the Figures.
- Such a memory device or memory element can be included in an article of manufacture.
- the present disclosure may have also been described, at least in part, in terms of one or more embodiments.
- An embodiment of the present disclosure is used herein to illustrate the present disclosure, an aspect thereof, a feature thereof, a concept thereof, and/or an example thereof.
- a physical embodiment of an apparatus, an article of manufacture, a machine, and/or of a process that embodies the present disclosure may include one or more of the aspects, features, concepts, examples, etc. described with reference to one or more of the embodiments discussed herein.
- the embodiments may incorporate the same or similarly named functions, steps, modules, etc. that may use the same or different reference numbers and, as such, the functions, steps, modules, etc. may be the same or similar functions, steps, modules, etc. or different ones.
- transistors in the above described figure(s) is/are shown as field effect transistors (FETs), as one of ordinary skill in the art will appreciate, the transistors may be implemented using any type of transistor structure including, but not limited to, bipolar, metal oxide semiconductor field effect transistors (MOSFET), N-well transistors, P-well transistors, enhancement mode, depletion mode, and zero voltage threshold (VT) transistors.
- FETs field effect transistors
- MOSFET metal oxide semiconductor field effect transistors
- N-well transistors N-well transistors
- P-well transistors P-well transistors
- enhancement mode enhancement mode
- depletion mode depletion mode
- VT zero voltage threshold
- signals to, from, and/or between elements in a figure of any of the figures presented herein may be analog or digital, continuous time or discrete time, and single-ended or differential.
- signals to, from, and/or between elements in a figure of any of the figures presented herein may be analog or digital, continuous time or discrete time, and single-ended or differential.
- a signal path is shown as a single-ended path, it also represents a differential signal path.
- a signal path is shown as a differential path, it also represents a single-ended signal path.
- module is used in the description of the various embodiments of the present disclosure.
- a module includes a processing module, a functional block, hardware, and/or software stored on memory for performing one or more functions as may be described herein. Note that, if the module is implemented via hardware, the hardware may operate independently and/or in conjunction software and/or firmware.
- a module may contain one or more sub-modules, each of which may be one or more modules.
Landscapes
- Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
- Theoretical Computer Science (AREA)
- Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
- General Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
- General Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
- Human Computer Interaction (AREA)
- Computer Networks & Wireless Communication (AREA)
- Signal Processing (AREA)
- Quality & Reliability (AREA)
- Computer Security & Cryptography (AREA)
- Information Retrieval, Db Structures And Fs Structures Therefor (AREA)
- Mathematical Physics (AREA)
- Computer And Data Communications (AREA)
- Information Transfer Between Computers (AREA)
- Algebra (AREA)
- Pure & Applied Mathematics (AREA)
- Probability & Statistics with Applications (AREA)
- Retry When Errors Occur (AREA)
Abstract
Description
- This patent application is claiming priority under 35 USC §119(e) to a provisionally filed patent application entitled DISPERSED STORAGE AND COMPUTING NETWORK COMPONENTS AND OPTIMIZATIONS having a provisional filing date of Jul. 31, 2013, and a provisional serial number of 61/860,498, which is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety and made part of the present U.S. Utility patent application for all purposes.
- Not Applicable
- Not Applicable
- 1. Technical Field
- This present disclosure relates generally to computer networks and more particularly to dispersed storage of data and distributed task processing of data.
- 2. Description of Related Art
- Computing devices are known to communicate data, process data, and/or store data. Such computing devices range from wireless smart phones, laptops, tablets, personal computers (PC), work stations, and video game devices, to data centers that support millions of web searches, stock trades, or on-line purchases every day. In general, a computing device includes a central processing unit (CPU), a memory system, user input/output interfaces, peripheral device interfaces, and an interconnecting bus structure.
- As is further known, a computer may effectively extend its CPU by using “cloud computing” to perform one or more computing functions (e.g., a service, an application, an algorithm, an arithmetic logic function, etc.) on behalf of the computer. Further, for large services, applications, and/or functions, cloud computing may be performed by multiple cloud computing resources in a distributed manner to improve the response time for completion of the service, application, and/or function. For example, Hadoop is an open source software framework that supports distributed applications enabling application execution by thousands of computers.
- In addition to cloud computing, a computer may use “cloud storage” as part of its memory system. As is known, cloud storage enables a user, via its computer, to store files, applications, etc. on an Internet storage system. The Internet storage system may include a RAID (redundant array of independent disks) system and/or a dispersed storage system that uses an error correction scheme to encode data for storage.
-
FIG. 1 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of a distributed computing system in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 2 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of a computing core in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 3 is a diagram of an example of a distributed storage and task processing in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 4 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of an outbound distributed storage and/or task (DST) processing in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 5 is a logic diagram of an example of a method for outbound DST processing in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 6 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of a dispersed error encoding in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 7 is a diagram of an example of a segment processing of the dispersed error encoding in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 8 is a diagram of an example of error encoding and slicing processing of the dispersed error encoding in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 9 is a diagram of an example of grouping selection processing of the outbound DST processing in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 10 is a diagram of an example of converting data into slice groups in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 11 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of a DST execution unit in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 12 is a schematic block diagram of an example of operation of a DST execution unit in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 13 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of an inbound distributed storage and/or task (DST) processing in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 14 is a logic diagram of an example of a method for inbound DST processing in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 15 is a diagram of an example of de-grouping selection processing of the inbound DST processing in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 16 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of a dispersed error decoding in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 17 is a diagram of an example of de-slicing and error decoding processing of the dispersed error decoding in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 18 is a diagram of an example of a de-segment processing of the dispersed error decoding in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 19 is a diagram of an example of converting slice groups into data in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 20 is a diagram of an example of a distributed storage within the distributed computing system in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 21 is a schematic block diagram of an example of operation of outbound distributed storage and/or task (DST) processing for storing data in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 22 is a schematic block diagram of an example of a dispersed error encoding for the example ofFIG. 21 in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 23 is a diagram of an example of converting data into pillar slice groups for storage in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 24 is a schematic block diagram of an example of a storage operation of a DST execution unit in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 25 is a schematic block diagram of an example of operation of inbound distributed storage and/or task (DST) processing for retrieving dispersed error encoded data in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 26 is a schematic block diagram of an example of a dispersed error decoding for the example ofFIG. 25 in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 27 is a schematic block diagram of an example of a distributed storage and task processing network (DSTN) module storing a plurality of data and a plurality of task codes in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 28 is a schematic block diagram of an example of the distributed computing system performing tasks on stored data in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 29 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of a task distribution module facilitating the example ofFIG. 28 in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 30 is a diagram of a specific example of the distributed computing system performing tasks on stored data in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 31 is a schematic block diagram of an example of a distributed storage and task processing network (DSTN) module storing data and task codes for the example ofFIG. 30 in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 32 is a diagram of an example of DST allocation information for the example ofFIG. 30 in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIGS. 33-38 are schematic block diagrams of the DSTN module performing the example ofFIG. 30 in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 39 is a diagram of an example of combining result information into final results for the example ofFIG. 30 in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIGS. 40A-40D are schematic block diagrams of an embodiment of a dispersed storage network (DSN) illustrating an example of storing data in DSN memory in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 40E is a flowchart illustrating an example of accessing data in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 41 is a flowchart illustrating an example of updating a dispersed storage network (DSN) address in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 42 is a flowchart illustrating an example of accessing an encoded data slice in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIGS. 43A , 43C-F are schematic block diagrams of an embodiment of a dispersed storage network (DSN) illustrating an example of time-based storage of data in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 43B is a timing diagram illustrating an example of generating a time-availability pattern in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 43G is a flowchart illustrating an example of time-based storage of data in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 44A is a schematic block diagram of another embodiment of a distributed storage and task (DST) execution unit in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 44B is a flowchart illustrating an example of assigning resources in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 45A is a schematic block diagram of another embodiment of a dispersed storage network (DSN) system in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 45B is a diagram illustrating an example of load-balancing in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 46A is a schematic block diagram of another embodiment of a distributed storage and task (DST) execution unit in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 46B is a diagram illustrating an example of memory utilization in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 46C is a diagram illustrating another example of memory utilization in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 46D is a flowchart illustrating an example of updating memory utilization information in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 46E is a flowchart illustrating example ways to identify slices needing a rebuild in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 46F is a flowchart illustrating another example of updating memory utilization information; -
FIG. 46G is schematic block diagram illustrating an example DST client module structure for memory utilization; -
FIG. 47A is a schematic block diagram of another embodiment of a dispersed storage network (DSN) system in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 47B is a diagram illustrating an example of generating a slice name in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 47C is a flowchart illustrating an example of co-locating storage of data in accordance with the present disclosure; -
FIG. 47D is a flowchart illustrating one example of obtaining the plurality of sets of encoded data slices to be co-located; and -
FIG. 47E is a schematic block diagram of another embodiment of a dispersed storage network (DSN) system in accordance with the present disclosure. -
FIG. 1 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of a distributedcomputing system 10 that includes auser device 12 and/or auser device 14, a distributed storage and/or task (DST)processing unit 16, a distributed storage and/or task network (DSTN) managingunit 18, a DSTintegrity processing unit 20, and a distributed storage and/or task network (DSTN)module 22. The components of the distributedcomputing system 10 are coupled via anetwork 24, which may include one or more wireless and/or wire lined communication systems; one or more private intranet systems and/or public internet systems; and/or one or more local area networks (LAN) and/or wide area networks (WAN). - The
DSTN module 22 includes a plurality of distributed storage and/or task (DST)execution units 36 that may be located at geographically different sites (e.g., one in Chicago, one in Milwaukee, etc.). Each of the DST execution units is operable to store dispersed error encoded data and/or to execute, in a distributed manner, one or more tasks on data. The tasks may be a simple function (e.g., a mathematical function, a logic function, an identify function, a find function, a search engine function, a replace function, etc.), a complex function (e.g., compression, human and/or computer language translation, text-to-voice conversion, voice-to-text conversion, etc.), multiple simple and/or complex functions, one or more algorithms, one or more applications, etc. - Each of the user devices 12-14, the
DST processing unit 16, theDSTN managing unit 18, and the DSTintegrity processing unit 20 include acomputing core 26 and may be a portable computing device and/or a fixed computing device. A portable computing device may be a social networking device, a gaming device, a cell phone, a smart phone, a personal digital assistant, a digital music player, a digital video player, a laptop computer, a handheld computer, a tablet, a video game controller, and/or any other portable device that includes a computing core. A fixed computing device may be a personal computer (PC), a computer server, a cable set-top box, a satellite receiver, a television set, a printer, a fax machine, home entertainment equipment, a video game console, and/or any type of home or office computing equipment.User device 12 andDST processing unit 16 are configured to include aDST client module 34. - With respect to interfaces, each
interface network 24 indirectly and/or directly. For example, interfaces 30 support a communication link (e.g., wired, wireless, direct, via a LAN, via thenetwork 24, etc.) betweenuser device 14 and theDST processing unit 16. As another example,interface 32 supports communication links (e.g., a wired connection, a wireless connection, a LAN connection, and/or any other type of connection to/from the network 24) betweenuser device 12 and theDSTN module 22 and between theDST processing unit 16 and theDSTN module 22. As yet another example,interface 33 supports a communication link for each of theDSTN managing unit 18 and DSTintegrity processing unit 20 to thenetwork 24. - The distributed
computing system 10 is operable to support dispersed storage (DS) error encoded data storage and retrieval, to support distributed task processing on received data, and/or to support distributed task processing on stored data. In general and with respect to DS error encoded data storage and retrieval, the distributedcomputing system 10 supports three primary operations: storage management, data storage and retrieval (an example of which will be discussed with reference toFIGS. 20-26 ), and data storage integrity verification. In accordance with these three primary functions, data can be encoded, distributedly stored in physically different locations, and subsequently retrieved in a reliable and secure manner. Such a system is tolerant of a significant number of failures (e.g., up to a failure level, which may be greater than or equal to a pillar width minus a decode threshold minus one) that may result from individual storage device failures and/or network equipment failures without loss of data and without the need for a redundant or backup copy. Further, the system allows the data to be stored for an indefinite period of time without data loss and does so in a secure manner (e.g., the system is very resistant to attempts at hacking the data). - The second primary function (i.e., distributed data storage and retrieval) begins and ends with a user device 12-14. For instance, if a second type of
user device 14 hasdata 40 to store in theDSTN module 22, it sends thedata 40 to theDST processing unit 16 via itsinterface 30. Theinterface 30 functions to mimic a conventional operating system (OS) file system interface (e.g., network file system (NFS), flash file system (FFS), disk file system (DFS), file transfer protocol (FTP), web-based distributed authoring and versioning (WebDAV), etc.) and/or a block memory interface (e.g., small computer system interface (SCSI), internet small computer system interface (iSCSI), etc.). In addition, theinterface 30 may attach a user identification code (ID) to thedata 40. - To support storage management, the
DSTN managing unit 18 performs DS management services. One such DS management service includes theDSTN managing unit 18 establishing distributed data storage parameters (e.g., vault creation, distributed storage parameters, security parameters, billing information, user profile information, etc.) for a user device 12-14 individually or as part of a group of user devices. For example, theDSTN managing unit 18 coordinates creation of a vault (e.g., a virtual memory block) within memory of theDSTN module 22 for a user device, a group of devices, or for public access and establishes per vault dispersed storage (DS) error encoding parameters for a vault. TheDSTN managing unit 18 may facilitate storage of DS error encoding parameters for each vault of a plurality of vaults by updating registry information for the distributedcomputing system 10. The facilitating includes storing updated registry information in one or more of theDSTN module 22, theuser device 12, theDST processing unit 16, and the DSTintegrity processing unit 20. - The DS error encoding parameters (e.g., or dispersed storage error coding parameters) include data segmenting information (e.g., how many segments data (e.g., a file, a group of files, a data block, etc.) is divided into), segment security information (e.g., per segment encryption, compression, integrity checksum, etc.), error coding information (e.g., pillar width, decode threshold, read threshold, write threshold, etc.), slicing information (e.g., the number of encoded data slices that will be created for each data segment); and slice security information (e.g., per encoded data slice encryption, compression, integrity checksum, etc.).
- The
DSTN managing module 18 creates and stores user profile information (e.g., an access control list (ACL)) in local memory and/or within memory of theDSTN module 22. The user profile information includes authentication information, permissions, and/or the security parameters. The security parameters may include encryption/decryption scheme, one or more encryption keys, key generation scheme, and/or data encoding/decoding scheme. - The
DSTN managing unit 18 creates billing information for a particular user, a user group, a vault access, public vault access, etc. For instance, theDSTN managing unit 18 tracks the number of times a user accesses a private vault and/or public vaults, which can be used to generate per-access billing information. In another instance, theDSTN managing unit 18 tracks the amount of data stored and/or retrieved by a user device and/or a user group, which can be used to generate per-data-amount billing information. - Another DS management service includes the
DSTN managing unit 18 performing network operations, network administration, and/or network maintenance. Network operations includes authenticating user data allocation requests (e.g., read and/or write requests), managing creation of vaults, establishing authentication credentials for user devices, adding/deleting components (e.g., user devices, DST execution units, and/or DST processing units) from the distributedcomputing system 10, and/or establishing authentication credentials forDST execution units 36. Network administration includes monitoring devices and/or units for failures, maintaining vault information, determining device and/or unit activation status, determining device and/or unit loading, and/or determining any other system level operation that affects the performance level of thesystem 10. Network maintenance includes facilitating replacing, upgrading, repairing, and/or expanding a device and/or unit of thesystem 10. - To support data storage integrity verification within the distributed
computing system 10, the DSTintegrity processing unit 20 performs rebuilding of ‘bad’ (e.g., corrupted) or missing encoded data slices. At a high level, the DSTintegrity processing unit 20 performs rebuilding by periodically attempting to retrieve/list encoded data slices, and/or slice names of the encoded data slices, from theDSTN module 22. For retrieved encoded slices, they are checked for errors due to data corruption, outdated version, etc. If a slice includes an error, it is flagged as a ‘bad’ slice. For encoded data slices that were not received and/or not listed, they are flagged as missing slices. Bad and/or missing slices are subsequently rebuilt using other retrieved encoded data slices that are deemed to be good slices to produce rebuilt slices. The rebuilt slices are stored in memory of theDSTN module 22. Note that the DSTintegrity processing unit 20 may be a separate unit as shown, it may be included in theDSTN module 22, and it may be included in theDST processing unit 16, and/or distributed among theDST execution units 36. - To support distributed task processing on received data, the distributed
computing system 10 has two primary operations: DST (distributed storage and/or task processing) management and DST execution on received data (an example of which will be discussed with reference toFIGS. 3-19 ). With respect to the storage portion of the DST management, theDSTN managing unit 18 functions as previously described. With respect to the tasking processing of the DST management, theDSTN managing unit 18 performs distributed task processing (DTP) management services. One such DTP management service includes theDSTN managing unit 18 establishing DTP parameters (e.g., user-vault affiliation information, billing information, user-task information, etc.) for a user device 12-14 individually or as part of a group of user devices. - Another DTP management service includes the
DSTN managing unit 18 performing DTP network operations, network administration (which is essentially the same as described above), and/or network maintenance (which is essentially the same as described above). Network operations include, but are not limited to, authenticating user task processing requests (e.g., valid request, valid user, etc.), authenticating results and/or partial results, establishing DTP authentication credentials for user devices, adding/deleting components (e.g., user devices, DST execution units, and/or DST processing units) from the distributed computing system, and/or establishing DTP authentication credentials for DST execution units. - To support distributed task processing on stored data, the distributed
computing system 10 has two primary operations: DST (distributed storage and/or task) management and DST execution on stored data. With respect to the DST execution on stored data, if the second type ofuser device 14 has atask request 38 for execution by theDSTN module 22, it sends thetask request 38 to theDST processing unit 16 via itsinterface 30. An example of DST execution on stored data will be discussed in greater detail with reference toFIGS. 27-39 . With respect to the DST management, it is substantially similar to the DST management to support distributed task processing on received data. -
FIG. 2 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of acomputing core 26 that includes aprocessing module 50, amemory controller 52,main memory 54, a videographics processing unit 55, an input/output (IO)controller 56, a peripheral component interconnect (PCI)interface 58, anIO interface module 60, at least one IOdevice interface module 62, a read only memory (ROM) basic input output system (BIOS) 64, and one or more memory interface modules. The one or more memory interface module(s) includes one or more of a universal serial bus (USB)interface module 66, a host bus adapter (HBA)interface module 68, anetwork interface module 70, aflash interface module 72, a harddrive interface module 74, and aDSTN interface module 76. - The
DSTN interface module 76 functions to mimic a conventional operating system (OS) file system interface (e.g., network file system (NFS), flash file system (FFS), disk file system (DFS), file transfer protocol (FTP), web-based distributed authoring and versioning (WebDAV), etc.) and/or a block memory interface (e.g., small computer system interface (SCSI), internet small computer system interface (iSCSI), etc.). TheDSTN interface module 76 and/or thenetwork interface module 70 may function as theinterface 30 of theuser device 14 ofFIG. 1 . Further note that the IOdevice interface module 62 and/or the memory interface modules may be collectively or individually referred to as IO ports. -
FIG. 3 is a diagram of an example of the distributed computing system performing a distributed storage and task processing operation. The distributed computing system includes a DST (distributed storage and/or task) client module 34 (which may be inuser device 14 and/or inDST processing unit 16 ofFIG. 1 ), anetwork 24, a plurality of DST execution units 1-n that includes two or moreDST execution units 36 ofFIG. 1 (which form at least a portion ofDSTN module 22 ofFIG. 1 ), a DST managing module (not shown), and a DST integrity verification module (not shown). TheDST client module 34 includes an outboundDST processing section 80 and an inboundDST processing section 82. Each of the DST execution units 1-n includes acontroller 86, aprocessing module 84,memory 88, a DT (distributed task)execution module 90, and aDST client module 34. - In an example of operation, the
DST client module 34 receivesdata 92 and one ormore tasks 94 to be performed upon thedata 92. Thedata 92 may be of any size and of any content, where, due to the size (e.g., greater than a few Terabytes), the content (e.g., secure data, etc.), and/or task(s) (e.g., MIPS intensive), distributed processing of the task(s) on the data is desired. For example, thedata 92 may be one or more digital books, a copy of a company's emails, a large-scale Internet search, a video security file, one or more entertainment video files (e.g., television programs, movies, etc.), data files, and/or any other large amount of data (e.g., greater than a few Terabytes). - Within the
DST client module 34, the outboundDST processing section 80 receives thedata 92 and the task(s) 94. The outboundDST processing section 80 processes thedata 92 to produceslice groupings 96. As an example of such processing, the outboundDST processing section 80 partitions thedata 92 into a plurality of data partitions. For each data partition, the outboundDST processing section 80 dispersed storage (DS) error encodes the data partition to produce encoded data slices and groups the encoded data slices into aslice grouping 96. In addition, the outboundDST processing section 80 partitions thetask 94 intopartial tasks 98, where the number ofpartial tasks 98 may correspond to the number ofslice groupings 96. - The outbound
DST processing section 80 then sends, via thenetwork 24, theslice groupings 96 and thepartial tasks 98 to the DST execution units 1-n of theDSTN module 22 ofFIG. 1 . For example, the outboundDST processing section 80 sendsslice group 1 andpartial task 1 toDST execution unit 1. As another example, the outboundDST processing section 80 sends slice group #n and partial task #n to DST execution unit #n. - Each DST execution unit performs its
partial task 98 upon itsslice group 96 to producepartial results 102. For example, DSTexecution unit # 1 performspartial task # 1 onslice group # 1 to produce apartial result # 1, for results. As a more specific example,slice group # 1 corresponds to a data partition of a series of digital books and thepartial task # 1 corresponds to searching for specific phrases, recording where the phrase is found, and establishing a phrase count. In this more specific example, thepartial result # 1 includes information as to where the phrase was found and includes the phrase count. - Upon completion of generating their respective
partial results 102, the DST execution units send, via thenetwork 24, theirpartial results 102 to the inboundDST processing section 82 of theDST client module 34. The inboundDST processing section 82 processes the receivedpartial results 102 to produce aresult 104. Continuing with the specific example of the preceding paragraph, the inboundDST processing section 82 combines the phrase count from each of theDST execution units 36 to produce a total phrase count. In addition, the inboundDST processing section 82 combines the ‘where the phrase was found’ information from each of theDST execution units 36 within their respective data partitions to produce ‘where the phrase was found’ information for the series of digital books. - In another example of operation, the
DST client module 34 requests retrieval of stored data within the memory of the DST execution units 36 (e.g., memory of the DSTN module). In this example, thetask 94 is retrieve data stored in the memory of the DSTN module. Accordingly, the outboundDST processing section 80 converts thetask 94 into a plurality ofpartial tasks 98 and sends thepartial tasks 98 to the respective DST execution units 1-n. - In response to the
partial task 98 of retrieving stored data, aDST execution unit 36 identifies the corresponding encoded data slices 100 and retrieves them. For example, DSTexecution unit # 1 receivespartial task # 1 and retrieves, in response thereto, retrievedslices # 1. TheDST execution units 36 send their respective retrievedslices 100 to the inboundDST processing section 82 via thenetwork 24. - The inbound
DST processing section 82 converts the retrievedslices 100 intodata 92. For example, the inboundDST processing section 82 de-groups the retrievedslices 100 to produce encoded slices per data partition. The inboundDST processing section 82 then DS error decodes the encoded slices per data partition to produce data partitions. The inboundDST processing section 82 de-partitions the data partitions to recapture thedata 92. -
FIG. 4 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of an outbound distributed storage and/or task (DST)processing section 80 of aDST client module 34FIG. 1 coupled to aDSTN module 22 of aFIG. 1 (e.g., a plurality of n DST execution units 36) via anetwork 24. The outboundDST processing section 80 includes adata partitioning module 110, a dispersed storage (DS)error encoding module 112, agrouping selector module 114, acontrol module 116, and a distributedtask control module 118. - In an example of operation, the
data partitioning module 110partitions data 92 into a plurality ofdata partitions 120. The number of partitions and the size of the partitions may be selected by thecontrol module 116 viacontrol 160 based on the data 92 (e.g., its size, its content, etc.), a correspondingtask 94 to be performed (e.g., simple, complex, single step, multiple steps, etc.), DS encoding parameters (e.g., pillar width, decode threshold, write threshold, segment security parameters, slice security parameters, etc.), capabilities of the DST execution units 36 (e.g., processing resources, availability of processing recourses, etc.), and/or as may be inputted by a user, system administrator, or other operator (human or automated). For example, thedata partitioning module 110 partitions the data 92 (e.g., 100 Terabytes) into 100,000 data segments, each being 1 Gigabyte in size. Alternatively, thedata partitioning module 110 partitions thedata 92 into a plurality of data segments, where some of data segments are of a different size, are of the same size, or a combination thereof. - The DS
error encoding module 112 receives thedata partitions 120 in a serial manner, a parallel manner, and/or a combination thereof. For eachdata partition 120, the DSerror encoding module 112 DS error encodes thedata partition 120 in accordance withcontrol information 160 from thecontrol module 116 to produce encoded data slices 122. The DS error encoding includes segmenting the data partition into data segments, segment security processing (e.g., encryption, compression, watermarking, integrity check (e.g., CRC), etc.), error encoding, slicing, and/or per slice security processing (e.g., encryption, compression, watermarking, integrity check (e.g., CRC), etc.). Thecontrol information 160 indicates which steps of the DS error encoding are active for a given data partition and, for active steps, indicates the parameters for the step. For example, thecontrol information 160 indicates that the error encoding is active and includes error encoding parameters (e.g., pillar width, decode threshold, write threshold, read threshold, type of error encoding, etc.). - The
grouping selector module 114 groups the encodedslices 122 of a data partition into a set ofslice groupings 96. The number of slice groupings corresponds to the number ofDST execution units 36 identified for aparticular task 94. For example, if fiveDST execution units 36 are identified for theparticular task 94, the group selecting module groups the encodedslices 122 of a data partition into fiveslice groupings 96. Thegrouping selector module 114 outputs theslice groupings 96 to the correspondingDST execution units 36 via thenetwork 24. - The distributed
task control module 118 receives thetask 94 and converts thetask 94 into a set ofpartial tasks 98. For example, the distributedtask control module 118 receives a task to find where in the data (e.g., a series of books) a phrase occurs and a total count of the phrase usage in the data. In this example, the distributedtask control module 118 replicates thetask 94 for eachDST execution unit 36 to produce thepartial tasks 98. In another example, the distributedtask control module 118 receives a task to find where in the data a first phrase occurs, where in the data a second phrase occurs, and a total count for each phrase usage in the data. In this example, the distributedtask control module 118 generates a first set ofpartial tasks 98 for finding and counting the first phase and a second set of partial tasks for finding and counting the second phrase. The distributedtask control module 118 sends respective first and/or secondpartial tasks 98 to eachDST execution unit 36. -
FIG. 5 is a logic diagram of an example of a method for outbound distributed storage and task (DST) processing that begins atstep 126 where a DST client module receives data and one or more corresponding tasks. The method continues atstep 128 where the DST client module determines a number of DST units to support the task for one or more data partitions. For example, the DST client module may determine the number of DST units to support the task based on the size of the data, the requested task, the content of the data, a predetermined number (e.g., user indicated, system administrator determined, etc.), available DST units, capability of the DST units, and/or any other factor regarding distributed task processing of the data. The DST client module may select the same DST units for each data partition, may select different DST units for the data partitions, or a combination thereof. - The method continues at
step 130 where the DST client module determines processing parameters of the data based on the number of DST units selected for distributed task processing. The processing parameters include data partitioning information, DS encoding parameters, and/or slice grouping information. The data partitioning information includes a number of data partitions, size of each data partition, and/or organization of the data partitions (e.g., number of data blocks in a partition, the size of the data blocks, and arrangement of the data blocks). The DS encoding parameters include segmenting information, segment security information, error encoding information (e.g., dispersed storage error encoding function parameters including one or more of pillar width, decode threshold, write threshold, read threshold, generator matrix), slicing information, and/or per slice security information. The slice grouping information includes information regarding how to arrange the encoded data slices into groups for the selected DST units. As a specific example, if the DST client module determines that five DST units are needed to support the task, then it determines that the error encoding parameters include a pillar width of five and a decode threshold of three. - The method continues at
step 132 where the DST client module determines task partitioning information (e.g., how to partition the tasks) based on the selected DST units and data processing parameters. The data processing parameters include the processing parameters and DST unit capability information. The DST unit capability information includes the number of DT (distributed task) execution units, execution capabilities of each DT execution unit (e.g., MIPS capabilities, processing resources (e.g., quantity and capability of microprocessors, CPUs, digital signal processors, co-processor, microcontrollers, arithmetic logic circuitry, and/or and the other analog and/or digital processing circuitry), availability of the processing resources, memory information (e.g., type, size, availability, etc.)), and/or any information germane to executing one or more tasks. - The method continues at
step 134 where the DST client module processes the data in accordance with the processing parameters to produce slice groupings. The method continues atstep 136 where the DST client module partitions the task based on the task partitioning information to produce a set of partial tasks. The method continues atstep 138 where the DST client module sends the slice groupings and the corresponding partial tasks to respective DST units. -
FIG. 6 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of the dispersed storage (DS)error encoding module 112 of an outbound distributed storage and task (DST) processing section. The DSerror encoding module 112 includes asegment processing module 142, a segmentsecurity processing module 144, anerror encoding module 146, aslicing module 148, and a per slicesecurity processing module 150. Each of these modules is coupled to acontrol module 116 to receivecontrol information 160 therefrom. - In an example of operation, the
segment processing module 142 receives adata partition 120 from a data partitioning module and receives segmenting information as thecontrol information 160 from thecontrol module 116. The segmenting information indicates how thesegment processing module 142 is to segment thedata partition 120. For example, the segmenting information indicates how many rows to segment the data based on a decode threshold of an error encoding scheme, indicates how many columns to segment the data into based on a number and size of data blocks within thedata partition 120, and indicates how many columns to include in adata segment 152. Thesegment processing module 142 segments thedata 120 intodata segments 152 in accordance with the segmenting information. - The segment
security processing module 144, when enabled by thecontrol module 116, secures thedata segments 152 based on segment security information received ascontrol information 160 from thecontrol module 116. The segment security information includes data compression, encryption, watermarking, integrity check (e.g., cyclic redundancy check (CRC), etc.), and/or any other type of digital security. For example, when the segmentsecurity processing module 144 is enabled, it may compress adata segment 152, encrypt the compressed data segment, and generate a CRC value for the encrypted data segment to produce asecure data segment 154. When the segmentsecurity processing module 144 is not enabled, it passes thedata segments 152 to theerror encoding module 146 or is bypassed such that thedata segments 152 are provided to theerror encoding module 146. - The
error encoding module 146 encodes thesecure data segments 154 in accordance with error correction encoding parameters received ascontrol information 160 from thecontrol module 116. The error correction encoding parameters (e.g., also referred to as dispersed storage error coding parameters) include identifying an error correction encoding scheme (e.g., forward error correction algorithm, a Reed-Solomon based algorithm, an online coding algorithm, an information dispersal algorithm, etc.), a pillar width, a decode threshold, a read threshold, a write threshold, etc. For example, the error correction encoding parameters identify a specific error correction encoding scheme, specifies a pillar width of five, and specifies a decode threshold of three. From these parameters, theerror encoding module 146 encodes adata segment 154 to produce an encodeddata segment 156. - The
slicing module 148 slices the encodeddata segment 156 in accordance with the pillar width of the error correction encoding parameters received ascontrol information 160. For example, if the pillar width is five, theslicing module 148 slices an encodeddata segment 156 into a set of five encoded data slices. As such, for a plurality of encodeddata segments 156 for a given data partition, the slicing module outputs a plurality of sets of encoded data slices 158. - The per slice
security processing module 150, when enabled by thecontrol module 116, secures each encodeddata slice 158 based on slice security information received ascontrol information 160 from thecontrol module 116. The slice security information includes data compression, encryption, watermarking, integrity check (e.g., CRC, etc.), and/or any other type of digital security. For example, when the per slicesecurity processing module 150 is enabled, it compresses an encodeddata slice 158, encrypts the compressed encoded data slice, and generates a CRC value for the encrypted encoded data slice to produce a secure encodeddata slice 122. When the per slicesecurity processing module 150 is not enabled, it passes the encoded data slices 158 or is bypassed such that the encoded data slices 158 are the output of the DSerror encoding module 112. Note that thecontrol module 116 may be omitted and each module stores its own parameters. -
FIG. 7 is a diagram of an example of a segment processing of a dispersed storage (DS) error encoding module. In this example, asegment processing module 142 receives adata partition 120 that includes 45 data blocks (e.g., d1-d45), receives segmenting information (i.e., control information 160) from a control module, and segments thedata partition 120 in accordance with thecontrol information 160 to producedata segments 152. Each data block may be of the same size as other data blocks or of a different size. In addition, the size of each data block may be a few bytes to megabytes of data. As previously mentioned, the segmenting information indicates how many rows to segment the data partition into, indicates how many columns to segment the data partition into, and indicates how many columns to include in a data segment. - In this example, the decode threshold of the error encoding scheme is three; as such the number of rows to divide the data partition into is three. The number of columns for each row is set to 15, which is based on the number and size of data blocks. The data blocks of the data partition are arranged in rows and columns in a sequential order (i.e., the first row includes the first 15 data blocks; the second row includes the second 15 data blocks; and the third row includes the last 15 data blocks).
- With the data blocks arranged into the desired sequential order, they are divided into data segments based on the segmenting information. In this example, the data partition is divided into 8 data segments; the first 7 include 2 columns of three rows and the last includes 1 column of three rows. Note that the first row of the 8 data segments is in sequential order of the first 15 data blocks; the second row of the 8 data segments in sequential order of the second 15 data blocks; and the third row of the 8 data segments in sequential order of the last 15 data blocks. Note that the number of data blocks, the grouping of the data blocks into segments, and size of the data blocks may vary to accommodate the desired distributed task processing function.
-
FIG. 8 is a diagram of an example of error encoding and slicing processing of the dispersed error encoding processing the data segments ofFIG. 7 . In this example,data segment 1 includes 3 rows with each row being treated as one word for encoding. As such,data segment 1 includes three words for encoding:word 1 including data blocks d1 and d2,word 2 including data blocks d16 and d17, andword 3 including data blocks d31 and d32. Each of data segments 2-7 includes three words where each word includes two data blocks.Data segment 8 includes three words where each word includes a single data block (e.g., d15, d30, and d45). - In operation, an
error encoding module 146 and aslicing module 148 convert each data segment into a set of encoded data slices in accordance with error correction encoding parameters ascontrol information 160. More specifically, when the error correction encoding parameters indicate a unity matrix Reed-Solomon based encoding algorithm, 5 pillars, and decode threshold of 3, the first three encoded data slices of the set of encoded data slices for a data segment are substantially similar to the corresponding word of the data segment. For instance, when the unity matrix Reed-Solomon based encoding algorithm is applied todata segment 1, the content of the first encoded data slice (DS1_d1&2) of the first set of encoded data slices (e.g., corresponding to data segment 1) is substantially similar to content of the first word (e.g., d1 & d2); the content of the second encoded data slice (DS1_d16&17) of the first set of encoded data slices is substantially similar to content of the second word (e.g., d16 & d17); and the content of the third encoded data slice (DS1_d31&32) of the first set of encoded data slices is substantially similar to content of the third word (e.g., d31 & d32). - The content of the fourth and fifth encoded data slices (e.g.,
ES1 —1 and ES1—2) of the first set of encoded data slices include error correction data based on the first-third words of the first data segment. With such an encoding and slicing scheme, retrieving any three of the five encoded data slices allows the data segment to be accurately reconstructed. - The encoding and slices of data segments 2-7 yield sets of encoded data slices similar to the set of encoded data slices of
data segment 1. For instance, the content of the first encoded data slice (DS2_d3&4) of the second set of encoded data slices (e.g., corresponding to data segment 2) is substantially similar to content of the first word (e.g., d3 & d4); the content of the second encoded data slice (DS2_d18&19) of the second set of encoded data slices is substantially similar to content of the second word (e.g., d18 & d19); and the content of the third encoded data slice (DS2_d33&34) of the second set of encoded data slices is substantially similar to content of the third word (e.g., d33 & d34). The content of the fourth and fifth encoded data slices (e.g.,ES1 —1 and ES1—2) of the second set of encoded data slices includes error correction data based on the first-third words of the second data segment. -
FIG. 9 is a diagram of an example of grouping selection processing of an outbound distributed storage and task (DST) processing in accordance with group selection information ascontrol information 160 from a control module. Encoded slices fordata partition 122 are grouped in accordance with thecontrol information 160 to produceslice groupings 96. In this example, agrouping selection module 114 organizes the encoded data slices into five slice groupings (e.g., one for each DST execution unit of a distributed storage and task network (DSTN) module). As a specific example, thegrouping selection module 114 creates a first slice grouping for a DSTexecution unit # 1, which includes first encoded slices of each of the sets of encoded slices. As such, the first DST execution unit receives encoded data slices corresponding to data blocks 1-15 (e.g., encoded data slices of contiguous data). - The
grouping selection module 114 also creates a second slice grouping for a DSTexecution unit # 2, which includes second encoded slices of each of the sets of encoded slices. As such, the second DST execution unit receives encoded data slices corresponding to data blocks 16-30. Thegrouping selection module 114 further creates a third slice grouping for DSTexecution unit # 3, which includes third encoded slices of each of the sets of encoded slices. As such, the third DST execution unit receives encoded data slices corresponding to data blocks 31-45. - The
grouping selection module 114 creates a fourth slice grouping for DSTexecution unit # 4, which includes fourth encoded slices of each of the sets of encoded slices. As such, the fourth DST execution unit receives encoded data slices corresponding to first error encoding information (e.g., encoded data slices of error coding (EC) data). Thegrouping selection module 114 further creates a fifth slice grouping for DSTexecution unit # 5, which includes fifth encoded slices of each of the sets of encoded slices. As such, the fifth DST execution unit receives encoded data slices corresponding to second error encoding information. -
FIG. 10 is a diagram of an example of convertingdata 92 into slice groups that expands on the preceding figures. As shown, thedata 92 is partitioned in accordance with apartitioning function 164 into a plurality of data partitions (1-x, where x is an integer greater than 4). Each data partition (or chunkset of data) is encoded and grouped into slice groupings as previously discussed by an encoding andgrouping function 166. For a given data partition, the slice groupings are sent to distributed storage and task (DST) execution units. From data partition to data partition, the ordering of the slice groupings to the DST execution units may vary. - For example, the slice groupings of
data partition # 1 is sent to the DST execution units such that the first DST execution receives first encoded data slices of each of the sets of encoded data slices, which corresponds to a first continuous data chunk of the first data partition (e.g., refer toFIG. 9 ), a second DST execution receives second encoded data slices of each of the sets of encoded data slices, which corresponds to a second continuous data chunk of the first data partition, etc. - For the second data partition, the slice groupings may be sent to the DST execution units in a different order than it was done for the first data partition. For instance, the first slice grouping of the second data partition (e.g.,
slice group 2—1) is sent to the second DST execution unit; the second slice grouping of the second data partition (e.g.,slice group 2—2) is sent to the third DST execution unit; the third slice grouping of the second data partition (e.g.,slice group 2—3) is sent to the fourth DST execution unit; the fourth slice grouping of the second data partition (e.g.,slice group 2—4, which includes first error coding information) is sent to the fifth DST execution unit; and the fifth slice grouping of the second data partition (e.g.,slice group 2—5, which includes second error coding information) is sent to the first DST execution unit. - The pattern of sending the slice groupings to the set of DST execution units may vary in a predicted pattern, a random pattern, and/or a combination thereof from data partition to data partition. In addition, from data partition to data partition, the set of DST execution units may change. For example, for the first data partition, DST execution units 1-5 may be used; for the second data partition, DST execution units 6-10 may be used; for the third data partition, DST execution units 3-7 may be used; etc. As is also shown, the task is divided into partial tasks that are sent to the DST execution units in conjunction with the slice groupings of the data partitions.
-
FIG. 11 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of a DST (distributed storage and/or task) execution unit that includes aninterface 169, acontroller 86,memory 88, one or more DT (distributed task)execution modules 90, and aDST client module 34. Thememory 88 is of sufficient size to store a significant number of encoded data slices (e.g., thousands of slices to hundreds-of-millions of slices) and may include one or more hard drives and/or one or more solid-state memory devices (e.g., flash memory, DRAM, etc.). - In an example of storing a slice group, the DST execution module receives a slice grouping 96 (e.g., slice group #1) via
interface 169. Theslice grouping 96 includes, per partition, encoded data slices of contiguous data or encoded data slices of error coding (EC) data. Forslice group # 1, the DST execution module receives encoded data slices of contiguous data forpartitions # 1 and #x (and potentially others between 3 and x) and receives encoded data slices of EC data forpartitions # 2 and #3 (and potentially others between 3 and x). Examples of encoded data slices of contiguous data and encoded data slices of error coding (EC) data are discussed with reference toFIG. 9 . Thememory 88 stores the encoded data slices ofslice groupings 96 in accordance withmemory control information 174 it receives from thecontroller 86. - The controller 86 (e.g., a processing module, a CPU, etc.) generates the
memory control information 174 based on a partial task(s) 98 and distributed computing information (e.g., user information (e.g., user ID, distributed computing permissions, data access permission, etc.), vault information (e.g., virtual memory assigned to user, user group, temporary storage for task processing, etc.), task validation information, etc.). For example, thecontroller 86 interprets the partial task(s) 98 in light of the distributed computing information to determine whether a requestor is authorized to perform thetask 98, is authorized to access the data, and/or is authorized to perform the task on this particular data. When the requestor is authorized, thecontroller 86 determines, based on thetask 98 and/or another input, whether the encoded data slices of theslice grouping 96 are to be temporarily stored or permanently stored. Based on the foregoing, thecontroller 86 generates thememory control information 174 to write the encoded data slices of theslice grouping 96 into thememory 88 and to indicate whether theslice grouping 96 is permanently stored or temporarily stored. - With the
slice grouping 96 stored in thememory 88, thecontroller 86 facilitates execution of the partial task(s) 98. In an example, thecontroller 86 interprets thepartial task 98 in light of the capabilities of the DT execution module(s) 90. The capabilities include one or more of MIPS capabilities, processing resources (e.g., quantity and capability of microprocessors, CPUs, digital signal processors, co-processor, microcontrollers, arithmetic logic circuitry, and/or any other analog and/or digital processing circuitry), availability of the processing resources, etc. If thecontroller 86 determines that the DT execution module(s) 90 have sufficient capabilities, it generatestask control information 176. - The task control
information 176 may be a generic instruction (e.g., perform the task on the stored slice grouping) or a series of operational codes. In the former instance, theDT execution module 90 includes a co-processor function specifically configured (fixed or programmed) to perform the desiredtask 98. In the latter instance, theDT execution module 90 includes a general processor topology where the controller stores an algorithm corresponding to theparticular task 98. In this instance, thecontroller 86 provides the operational codes (e.g., assembly language, source code of a programming language, object code, etc.) of the algorithm to theDT execution module 90 for execution. - Depending on the nature of the
task 98, theDT execution module 90 may generate intermediatepartial results 102 that are stored in thememory 88 or in a cache memory (not shown) within theDT execution module 90. In either case, when theDT execution module 90 completes execution of thepartial task 98, it outputs one or morepartial results 102. Thepartial results 102 may also be stored inmemory 88. - If, when the
controller 86 is interpreting whether capabilities of the DT execution module(s) 90 can support thepartial task 98, thecontroller 86 determines that the DT execution module(s) 90 cannot adequately support the task 98 (e.g., does not have the right resources, does not have sufficient available resources, available resources would be too slow, etc.), it then determines whether thepartial task 98 should be fully offloaded or partially offloaded. - If the
controller 86 determines that thepartial task 98 should be fully offloaded, it generatesDST control information 178 and provides it to theDST client module 34. TheDST control information 178 includes thepartial task 98, memory storage information regarding theslice grouping 96, and distribution instructions. The distribution instructions instruct theDST client module 34 to divide thepartial task 98 intosub-partial tasks 172, to divide theslice grouping 96 intosub-slice groupings 170, and identify other DST execution units. TheDST client module 34 functions in a similar manner as theDST client module 34 ofFIGS. 3-10 to produce thesub-partial tasks 172 and thesub-slice groupings 170 in accordance with the distribution instructions. - The
DST client module 34 receives DST feedback 168 (e.g., sub-partial results), via theinterface 169, from the DST execution units to which the task was offloaded. TheDST client module 34 provides the sub-partial results to the DST execution unit, which processes the sub-partial results to produce the partial result(s) 102. - If the
controller 86 determines that thepartial task 98 should be partially offloaded, it determines what portion of thetask 98 and/orslice grouping 96 should be processed locally and what should be offloaded. For the portion that is being locally processed, thecontroller 86 generatestask control information 176 as previously discussed. For the portion that is being offloaded, thecontroller 86 generatesDST control information 178 as previously discussed. - When the
DST client module 34 receives DST feedback 168 (e.g., sub-partial results) from the DST executions units to which a portion of the task was offloaded, it provides the sub-partial results to theDT execution module 90. TheDT execution module 90 processes the sub-partial results with the sub-partial results it created to produce the partial result(s) 102. - The
memory 88 may be further utilized to retrieve one or more of storedslices 100, storedresults 104, andpartial results 102 when theDT execution module 90 storespartial results 102 and/orresults 104 and thememory 88. For example, when thepartial task 98 includes a retrieval request, thecontroller 86 outputs thememory control 174 to thememory 88 to facilitate retrieval ofslices 100 and/or results 104. -
FIG. 12 is a schematic block diagram of an example of operation of a distributed storage and task (DST) execution unit storing encoded data slices and executing a task thereon. To store the encoded data slices of apartition 1 ofslice grouping 1, acontroller 86 generates write commands asmemory control information 174 such that the encoded slices are stored in desired locations (e.g., permanent or temporary) withinmemory 88. - Once the encoded slices are stored, the
controller 86 providestask control information 176 to a distributed task (DT)execution module 90. As a first step executing the task in accordance with thetask control information 176, theDT execution module 90 retrieves the encoded slices frommemory 88. TheDT execution module 90 then reconstructs contiguous data blocks of a data partition. As shown for this example, reconstructed contiguous data blocks ofdata partition 1 include data blocks 1-15 (e.g., d1-d15). - With the contiguous data blocks reconstructed, the
DT execution module 90 performs the task on the reconstructed contiguous data blocks. For example, the task may be to search the reconstructed contiguous data blocks for a particular word or phrase, identify where in the reconstructed contiguous data blocks the particular word or phrase occurred, and/or count the occurrences of the particular word or phrase on the reconstructed contiguous data blocks. The DST execution unit continues in a similar manner for the encoded data slices of other partitions inslice grouping 1. Note that with using the unity matrix error encoding scheme previously discussed, if the encoded data slices of contiguous data are uncorrupted, the decoding of them is a relatively straightforward process of extracting the data. - If, however, an encoded data slice of contiguous data is corrupted (or missing), it can be rebuilt by accessing other DST execution units that are storing the other encoded data slices of the set of encoded data slices of the corrupted encoded data slice. In this instance, the DST execution unit having the corrupted encoded data slices retrieves at least three encoded data slices (of contiguous data and of error coding data) in the set from the other DST execution units (recall for this example, the pillar width is 5 and the decode threshold is 3). The DST execution unit decodes the retrieved data slices using the DS error encoding parameters to recapture the corresponding data segment. The DST execution unit then re-encodes the data segment using the DS error encoding parameters to rebuild the corrupted encoded data slice. Once the encoded data slice is rebuilt, the DST execution unit functions as previously described.
-
FIG. 13 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of an inbound distributed storage and/or task (DST)processing section 82 of a DST client module coupled to DST execution units of a distributed storage and task network (DSTN) module via anetwork 24. The inboundDST processing section 82 includes ade-grouping module 180, a DS (dispersed storage)error decoding module 182, adata de-partitioning module 184, acontrol module 186, and a distributedtask control module 188. Note that thecontrol module 186 and/or the distributedtask control module 188 may be separate modules from corresponding ones of outbound DST processing section or may be the same modules. - In an example of operation, the DST execution units have completed execution of corresponding partial tasks on the corresponding slice groupings to produce
partial results 102. The inboundDST processing section 82 receives thepartial results 102 via the distributedtask control module 188. The inboundDST processing section 82 then processes thepartial results 102 to produce a final result, or results 104. For example, if the task was to find a specific word or phrase within data, thepartial results 102 indicate where in each of the prescribed portions of the data the corresponding DST execution units found the specific word or phrase. The distributedtask control module 188 combines the individualpartial results 102 for the corresponding portions of the data into afinal result 104 for the data as a whole. - In another example of operation, the inbound
DST processing section 82 is retrieving stored data from the DST execution units (i.e., the DSTN module). In this example, the DST execution units output encoded data slices 100 corresponding to the data retrieval requests. Thede-grouping module 180 receives retrievedslices 100 and de-groups them to produce encoded data slices perdata partition 122. The DSerror decoding module 182 decodes, in accordance with DS error encoding parameters, the encoded data slices perdata partition 122 to producedata partitions 120. - The data
de-partitioning module 184 combines thedata partitions 120 into thedata 92. Thecontrol module 186 controls the conversion of retrieveslices 100 into thedata 92 usingcontrol signals 190 to each of the modules. For instance, thecontrol module 186 provides de-grouping information to thede-grouping module 180, provides the DS error encoding parameters to the DSerror decoding module 182, and provides de-partitioning information to the datade-partitioning module 184. -
FIG. 14 is a logic diagram of an example of a method that is executable by distributed storage and task (DST) client module regarding inbound DST processing. The method begins atstep 194 where the DST client module receives partial results. The method continues atstep 196 where the DST client module retrieves the task corresponding to the partial results. For example, the partial results include header information that identifies the requesting entity, which correlates to the requested task. - The method continues at
step 198 where the DST client module determines result processing information based on the task. For example, if the task were to identify a particular word or phrase within the data, the result processing information would indicate to aggregate the partial results for the corresponding portions of the data to produce the final result. As another example, if the task were to count the occurrences of a particular word or phrase within the data, results of processing the information would indicate to add the partial results to produce the final results. The method continues atstep 200 where the DST client module processes the partial results in accordance with the result processing information to produce the final result or results. -
FIG. 15 is a diagram of an example of de-grouping selection processing of an inbound distributed storage and task (DST) processing section of a DST client module. In general, this is an inverse process of the grouping module of the outbound DST processing section ofFIG. 9 . Accordingly, for each data partition (e.g., partition #1), the de-grouping module retrieves the corresponding slice grouping from the DST execution units (EU) (e.g., DST 1-5). - As shown, DST
execution unit # 1 provides a first slice grouping, which includes the first encoded slices of each of the sets of encoded slices (e.g., encoded data slices of contiguous data of data blocks 1-15); DSTexecution unit # 2 provides a second slice grouping, which includes the second encoded slices of each of the sets of encoded slices (e.g., encoded data slices of contiguous data of data blocks 16-30); DSTexecution unit # 3 provides a third slice grouping, which includes the third encoded slices of each of the sets of encoded slices (e.g., encoded data slices of contiguous data of data blocks 31-45); DSTexecution unit # 4 provides a fourth slice grouping, which includes the fourth encoded slices of each of the sets of encoded slices (e.g., first encoded data slices of error coding (EC) data); and DSTexecution unit # 5 provides a fifth slice grouping, which includes the fifth encoded slices of each of the sets of encoded slices (e.g., first encoded data slices of error coding (EC) data). - The de-grouping module de-groups the slice groupings (e.g., received slices 100) using a
de-grouping selector 180 controlled by acontrol signal 190 as shown in the example to produce a plurality of sets of encoded data slices (e.g., retrieved slices for a partition into sets of slices 122). Each set corresponding to a data segment of the data partition. -
FIG. 16 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of a dispersed storage (DS)error decoding module 182 of an inbound distributed storage and task (DST) processing section. The DSerror decoding module 182 includes an inverse per slicesecurity processing module 202, ade-slicing module 204, anerror decoding module 206, an inversesegment security module 208, ade-segmenting processing module 210, and acontrol module 186. - In an example of operation, the inverse per slice
security processing module 202, when enabled by thecontrol module 186, unsecures each encodeddata slice 122 based on slice de-security information received as control information 190 (e.g., the compliment of the slice security information discussed with reference toFIG. 6 ) received from thecontrol module 186. The slice security information includes data decompression, decryption, de-watermarking, integrity check (e.g., CRC verification, etc.), and/or any other type of digital security. For example, when the inverse per slicesecurity processing module 202 is enabled, it verifies integrity information (e.g., a CRC value) of each encodeddata slice 122, it decrypts each verified encoded data slice, and decompresses each decrypted encoded data slice to produce slice encodeddata 158. When the inverse per slicesecurity processing module 202 is not enabled, it passes the encoded data slices 122 as the sliced encodeddata 158 or is bypassed such that the retrieved encoded data slices 122 are provided as the sliced encodeddata 158. - The
de-slicing module 204 de-slices the sliced encodeddata 158 into encodeddata segments 156 in accordance with a pillar width of the error correction encoding parameters received ascontrol information 190 from thecontrol module 186. For example, if the pillar width is five, thede-slicing module 204 de-slices a set of five encoded data slices into an encodeddata segment 156. Theerror decoding module 206 decodes the encodeddata segments 156 in accordance with error correction decoding parameters received ascontrol information 190 from thecontrol module 186 to producesecure data segments 154. The error correction decoding parameters include identifying an error correction encoding scheme (e.g., forward error correction algorithm, a Reed-Solomon based algorithm, an information dispersal algorithm, etc.), a pillar width, a decode threshold, a read threshold, a write threshold, etc. For example, the error correction decoding parameters identify a specific error correction encoding scheme, specify a pillar width of five, and specify a decode threshold of three. - The inverse segment
security processing module 208, when enabled by thecontrol module 186, unsecures thesecured data segments 154 based on segment security information received ascontrol information 190 from thecontrol module 186. The segment security information includes data decompression, decryption, de-watermarking, integrity check (e.g., CRC, etc.) verification, and/or any other type of digital security. For example, when the inverse segmentsecurity processing module 208 is enabled, it verifies integrity information (e.g., a CRC value) of eachsecure data segment 154, it decrypts each verified secured data segment, and decompresses each decrypted secure data segment to produce adata segment 152. When the inverse segmentsecurity processing module 208 is not enabled, it passes the decodeddata segment 154 as thedata segment 152 or is bypassed. - The
de-segment processing module 210 receives thedata segments 152 and receives de-segmenting information ascontrol information 190 from thecontrol module 186. The de-segmenting information indicates how thede-segment processing module 210 is to de-segment thedata segments 152 into adata partition 120. For example, the de-segmenting information indicates how the rows and columns of data segments are to be rearranged to yield thedata partition 120. -
FIG. 17 is a diagram of an example of de-slicing and error decoding processing of a dispersed error decoding module. Ade-slicing module 204 receives at least a decode threshold number of encoded data slices 158 for each data segment in accordance withcontrol information 190 and provides encodeddata 156. In this example, a decode threshold is three. As such, each set of encoded data slices 158 is shown to have three encoded data slices per data segment. Thede-slicing module 204 may receive three encoded data slices per data segment because an associated distributed storage and task (DST) client module requested retrieving only three encoded data slices per segment or selected three of the retrieved encoded data slices per data segment. As shown, which is based on the unity matrix encoding previously discussed with reference toFIG. 8 , an encoded data slice may be a data-based encoded data slice (e.g., DS1_d1&d2) or an error code based encoded data slice (e.g., ES3—1). - An
error decoding module 206 decodes the encodeddata 156 of each data segment in accordance with the error correction decoding parameters ofcontrol information 190 to produce securedsegments 154. In this example,data segment 1 includes 3 rows with each row being treated as one word for encoding. As such,data segment 1 includes three words:word 1 including data blocks d1 and d2,word 2 including data blocks d16 and d17, andword 3 including data blocks d31 and d32. Each of data segments 2-7 includes three words where each word includes two data blocks.Data segment 8 includes three words where each word includes a single data block (e.g., d15, d30, and d45). -
FIG. 18 is a diagram of an example of a de-segment processing of an inbound distributed storage and task (DST) processing. In this example, ade-segment processing module 210 receives data segments 152 (e.g., 1-8) and rearranges the data blocks of the data segments into rows and columns in accordance with de-segmenting information ofcontrol information 190 to produce adata partition 120. Note that the number of rows is based on the decode threshold (e.g., 3 in this specific example) and the number of columns is based on the number and size of the data blocks. - The
de-segmenting module 210 converts the rows and columns of data blocks into thedata partition 120. Note that each data block may be of the same size as other data blocks or of a different size. In addition, the size of each data block may be a few bytes to megabytes of data. -
FIG. 19 is a diagram of an example of converting slice groups intodata 92 within an inbound distributed storage and task (DST) processing section. As shown, thedata 92 is reconstructed from a plurality of data partitions (1-x, where x is an integer greater than 4). Each data partition (or chunk set of data) is decoded and re-grouped using a de-grouping anddecoding function 212 and ade-partition function 214 from slice groupings as previously discussed. For a given data partition, the slice groupings (e.g., at least a decode threshold per data segment of encoded data slices) are received from DST execution units. From data partition to data partition, the ordering of the slice groupings received from the DST execution units may vary as discussed with reference toFIG. 10 . -
FIG. 20 is a diagram of an example of a distributed storage and/or retrieval within the distributed computing system. The distributed computing system includes a plurality of distributed storage and/or task (DST) processing client modules 34 (one shown) coupled to a distributed storage and/or task processing network (DSTN) module, or multiple DSTN modules, via anetwork 24. TheDST client module 34 includes an outboundDST processing section 80 and an inboundDST processing section 82. The DSTN module includes a plurality of DST execution units. Each DST execution unit includes acontroller 86,memory 88, one or more distributed task (DT)execution modules 90, and aDST client module 34. - In an example of data storage, the
DST client module 34 hasdata 92 that it desires to store in the DSTN module. Thedata 92 may be a file (e.g., video, audio, text, graphics, etc.), a data object, a data block, an update to a file, an update to a data block, etc. In this instance, the outboundDST processing module 80 converts thedata 92 into encoded data slices 216 as will be further described with reference toFIGS. 21-23 . The outboundDST processing module 80 sends, via thenetwork 24, to the DST execution units for storage as further described with reference toFIG. 24 . - In an example of data retrieval, the
DST client module 34 issues a retrieve request to the DST execution units for the desireddata 92. The retrieve request may address each DST executions units storing encoded data slices of the desired data, address a decode threshold number of DST execution units, address a read threshold number of DST execution units, or address some other number of DST execution units. In response to the request, each addressed DST execution unit retrieves its encoded data slices 100 of the desired data and sends them to the inboundDST processing section 82, via thenetwork 24. - When, for each data segment, the inbound
DST processing section 82 receives at least a decode threshold number of encoded data slices 100, it converts the encoded data slices 100 into a data segment. The inboundDST processing section 82 aggregates the data segments to produce the retrieveddata 92. -
FIG. 21 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of an outbound distributed storage and/or task (DST)processing section 80 of a DST client module coupled to a distributed storage and task network (DSTN) module (e.g., a plurality of DST execution units) via anetwork 24. The outboundDST processing section 80 includes adata partitioning module 110, a dispersed storage (DS)error encoding module 112, agrouping selector module 114, acontrol module 116, and a distributedtask control module 118. - In an example of operation, the
data partitioning module 110 is by-passed such thatdata 92 is provided directly to the DSerror encoding module 112. Thecontrol module 116 coordinates the by-passing of thedata partitioning module 110 by outputting abypass 220 message to thedata partitioning module 110. - The DS
error encoding module 112 receives thedata 92 in a serial manner, a parallel manner, and/or a combination thereof. The DSerror encoding module 112 DS error encodes the data in accordance withcontrol information 160 from thecontrol module 116 to produce encoded data slices 218. The DS error encoding includes segmenting thedata 92 into data segments, segment security processing (e.g., encryption, compression, watermarking, integrity check (e.g., CRC, etc.)), error encoding, slicing, and/or per slice security processing (e.g., encryption, compression, watermarking, integrity check (e.g., CRC, etc.)). Thecontrol information 160 indicates which steps of the DS error encoding are active for thedata 92 and, for active steps, indicates the parameters for the step. For example, thecontrol information 160 indicates that the error encoding is active and includes error encoding parameters (e.g., pillar width, decode threshold, write threshold, read threshold, type of error encoding, etc.). - The
grouping selector module 114 groups the encodedslices 218 of the data segments into pillars ofslices 216. The number of pillars corresponds to the pillar width of the DS error encoding parameters. In this example, the distributedtask control module 118 facilitates the storage request. -
FIG. 22 is a schematic block diagram of an example of a dispersed storage (DS)error encoding module 112 for the example ofFIG. 21 . The DSerror encoding module 112 includes asegment processing module 142, a segmentsecurity processing module 144, anerror encoding module 146, aslicing module 148, and a per slicesecurity processing module 150. Each of these modules is coupled to acontrol module 116 to receivecontrol information 160 therefrom. - In an example of operation, the
segment processing module 142 receivesdata 92 and receives segmenting information ascontrol information 160 from thecontrol module 116. The segmenting information indicates how the segment processing module is to segment the data. For example, the segmenting information indicates the size of each data segment. Thesegment processing module 142 segments thedata 92 intodata segments 152 in accordance with the segmenting information. - The segment
security processing module 144, when enabled by thecontrol module 116, secures thedata segments 152 based on segment security information received ascontrol information 160 from thecontrol module 116. The segment security information includes data compression, encryption, watermarking, integrity check (e.g., CRC, etc.), and/or any other type of digital security. For example, when the segmentsecurity processing module 144 is enabled, it compresses adata segment 152, encrypts the compressed data segment, and generates a CRC value for the encrypted data segment to produce a secure data segment. When the segmentsecurity processing module 144 is not enabled, it passes thedata segments 152 to theerror encoding module 146 or is bypassed such that thedata segments 152 are provided to theerror encoding module 146. - The
error encoding module 146 encodes the secure data segments in accordance with error correction encoding parameters received ascontrol information 160 from thecontrol module 116. The error correction encoding parameters include identifying an error correction encoding scheme (e.g., forward error correction algorithm, a Reed-Solomon based algorithm, an information dispersal algorithm, etc.), a pillar width, a decode threshold, a read threshold, a write threshold, etc. For example, the error correction encoding parameters identify a specific error correction encoding scheme, specifies a pillar width of five, and specifies a decode threshold of three. From these parameters, theerror encoding module 146 encodes a data segment to produce an encoded data segment. - The
slicing module 148 slices the encoded data segment in accordance with a pillar width of the error correction encoding parameters. For example, if the pillar width is five, the slicing module slices an encoded data segment into a set of five encoded data slices. As such, for a plurality of data segments, theslicing module 148 outputs a plurality of sets of encoded data slices as shown within encoding and slicingfunction 222 as described. - The per slice
security processing module 150, when enabled by thecontrol module 116, secures each encoded data slice based on slice security information received ascontrol information 160 from thecontrol module 116. The slice security information includes data compression, encryption, watermarking, integrity check (e.g., CRC, etc.), and/or any other type of digital security. For example, when the per slicesecurity processing module 150 is enabled, it may compress an encoded data slice, encrypt the compressed encoded data slice, and generate a CRC value for the encrypted encoded data slice to produce a secure encoded data slice tweaking. When the per slicesecurity processing module 150 is not enabled, it passes the encoded data slices or is bypassed such that the encoded data slices 218 are the output of the DSerror encoding module 112. -
FIG. 23 is a diagram of an example of convertingdata 92 into pillar slice groups utilizing encoding, slicing andpillar grouping function 224 for storage in memory of a distributed storage and task network (DSTN) module. As previously discussed thedata 92 is encoded and sliced into a plurality of sets of encoded data slices; one set per data segment. The grouping selection module organizes the sets of encoded data slices into pillars of data slices. In this example, the DS error encoding parameters include a pillar width of 5 and a decode threshold of 3. As such, for each data segment, 5 encoded data slices are created. - The grouping selection module takes the first encoded data slice of each of the sets and forms a first pillar, which may be sent to the first DST execution unit. Similarly, the grouping selection module creates the second pillar from the second slices of the sets; the third pillar from the third slices of the sets; the fourth pillar from the fourth slices of the sets; and the fifth pillar from the fifth slices of the set.
-
FIG. 24 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of a distributed storage and/or task (DST) execution unit that includes aninterface 169, acontroller 86,memory 88, one or more distributed task (DT)execution modules 90, and aDST client module 34. Acomputing core 26 may be utilized to implement the one or moreDT execution modules 90 and theDST client module 34. Thememory 88 is of sufficient size to store a significant number of encoded data slices (e.g., thousands of slices to hundreds-of-millions of slices) and may include one or more hard drives and/or one or more solid-state memory devices (e.g., flash memory, DRAM, etc.). - In an example of storing a pillar of
slices 216, the DST execution unit receives, viainterface 169, a pillar of slices 216 (e.g.,pillar # 1 slices). Thememory 88 stores the encoded data slices 216 of the pillar of slices in accordance withmemory control information 174 it receives from thecontroller 86. The controller 86 (e.g., a processing module, a CPU, etc.) generates thememory control information 174 based on distributed storage information (e.g., user information (e.g., user ID, distributed storage permissions, data access permission, etc.), vault information (e.g., virtual memory assigned to user, user group, etc.), etc.). Similarly, when retrieving slices, the DST execution unit receives, viainterface 169, a slice retrieval request. Thememory 88 retrieves the slice in accordance withmemory control information 174 it receives from thecontroller 86. Thememory 88 outputs theslice 100, via theinterface 169, to a requesting entity. -
FIG. 25 is a schematic block diagram of an example of operation of an inbound distributed storage and/or task (DST)processing section 82 for retrieving dispersed error encodeddata 92. The inboundDST processing section 82 includes ade-grouping module 180, a dispersed storage (DS)error decoding module 182, adata de-partitioning module 184, acontrol module 186, and a distributedtask control module 188. Note that thecontrol module 186 and/or the distributedtask control module 188 may be separate modules from corresponding ones of an outbound DST processing section or may be the same modules. - In an example of operation, the inbound
DST processing section 82 is retrieving storeddata 92 from the DST execution units (i.e., the DSTN module). In this example, the DST execution units output encoded data slices corresponding to data retrieval requests from the distributedtask control module 188. Thede-grouping module 180 receives pillars ofslices 100 and de-groups them in accordance withcontrol information 190 from thecontrol module 186 to produce sets of encoded data slices 218. The DSerror decoding module 182 decodes, in accordance with the DS error encoding parameters received ascontrol information 190 from thecontrol module 186, each set of encoded data slices 218 to produce data segments, which are aggregated into retrieveddata 92. The datade-partitioning module 184 is by-passed in this operational mode via abypass signal 226 ofcontrol information 190 from thecontrol module 186. -
FIG. 26 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of a dispersed storage (DS)error decoding module 182 of an inbound distributed storage and task (DST) processing section. The DSerror decoding module 182 includes an inverse per slicesecurity processing module 202, ade-slicing module 204, anerror decoding module 206, an inversesegment security module 208, and ade-segmenting processing module 210. The dispersederror decoding module 182 is operable to de-slice and decode encoded slices perdata segment 218 utilizing a de-slicing anddecoding function 228 to produce a plurality of data segments that are de-segmented utilizing ade-segment function 230 to recoverdata 92. - In an example of operation, the inverse per slice
security processing module 202, when enabled by thecontrol module 186 viacontrol information 190, unsecures each encodeddata slice 218 based on slice de-security information (e.g., the compliment of the slice security information discussed with reference toFIG. 6 ) received ascontrol information 190 from thecontrol module 186. The slice de-security information includes data decompression, decryption, de-watermarking, integrity check (e.g., CRC verification, etc.), and/or any other type of digital security. For example, when the inverse per slicesecurity processing module 202 is enabled, it verifies integrity information (e.g., a CRC value) of each encodeddata slice 218, it decrypts each verified encoded data slice, and decompresses each decrypted encoded data slice to produce slice encoded data. When the inverse per slicesecurity processing module 202 is not enabled, it passes the encoded data slices 218 as the sliced encoded data or is bypassed such that the retrieved encoded data slices 218 are provided as the sliced encoded data. - The
de-slicing module 204 de-slices the sliced encoded data into encoded data segments in accordance with a pillar width of the error correction encoding parameters received ascontrol information 190 from acontrol module 186. For example, if the pillar width is five, the de-slicing module de-slices a set of five encoded data slices into an encoded data segment. Alternatively, the encoded data segment may include just three encoded data slices (e.g., when the decode threshold is 3). - The
error decoding module 206 decodes the encoded data segments in accordance with error correction decoding parameters received ascontrol information 190 from thecontrol module 186 to produce secure data segments. The error correction decoding parameters include identifying an error correction encoding scheme (e.g., forward error correction algorithm, a Reed-Solomon based algorithm, an information dispersal algorithm, etc.), a pillar width, a decode threshold, a read threshold, a write threshold, etc. For example, the error correction decoding parameters identify a specific error correction encoding scheme, specify a pillar width of five, and specify a decode threshold of three. - The inverse segment
security processing module 208, when enabled by thecontrol module 186, unsecures the secured data segments based on segment security information received ascontrol information 190 from thecontrol module 186. The segment security information includes data decompression, decryption, de-watermarking, integrity check (e.g., CRC, etc.) verification, and/or any other type of digital security. For example, when the inverse segment security processing module is enabled, it verifies integrity information (e.g., a CRC value) of each secure data segment, it decrypts each verified secured data segment, and decompresses each decrypted secure data segment to produce adata segment 152. When the inverse segmentsecurity processing module 208 is not enabled, it passes the decodeddata segment 152 as the data segment or is bypassed. Thede-segmenting processing module 210 aggregates thedata segments 152 into thedata 92 in accordance withcontrol information 190 from thecontrol module 186. -
FIG. 27 is a schematic block diagram of an example of a distributed storage and task processing network (DSTN) module that includes a plurality of distributed storage and task (DST) execution units (#1 through #n, where, for example, n is an integer greater than or equal to three). Each of the DST execution units includes aDST client module 34, acontroller 86, one or more DT (distributed task)execution modules 90, andmemory 88. - In this example, the DSTN module stores, in the memory of the DST execution units, a plurality of DS (dispersed storage) encoded data (e.g., 1 through n, where n is an integer greater than or equal to two) and stores a plurality of DS encoded task codes (e.g., 1 through k, where k is an integer greater than or equal to two). The DS encoded data may be encoded in accordance with one or more examples described with reference to
FIGS. 3-19 (e.g., organized in slice groupings) or encoded in accordance with one or more examples described with reference toFIGS. 20-26 (e.g., organized in pillar groups). The data that is encoded into the DS encoded data may be of any size and/or of any content. For example, the data may be one or more digital books, a copy of a company's emails, a large-scale Internet search, a video security file, one or more entertainment video files (e.g., television programs, movies, etc.), data files, and/or any other large amount of data (e.g., greater than a few Terabytes). - The tasks that are encoded into the DS encoded task code may be a simple function (e.g., a mathematical function, a logic function, an identify function, a find function, a search engine function, a replace function, etc.), a complex function (e.g., compression, human and/or computer language translation, text-to-voice conversion, voice-to-text conversion, etc.), multiple simple and/or complex functions, one or more algorithms, one or more applications, etc. The tasks may be encoded into the DS encoded task code in accordance with one or more examples described with reference to
FIGS. 3-19 (e.g., organized in slice groupings) or encoded in accordance with one or more examples described with reference toFIGS. 20-26 (e.g., organized in pillar groups). - In an example of operation, a DST client module of a user device or of a DST processing unit issues a DST request to the DSTN module. The DST request may include a request to retrieve stored data, or a portion thereof, may include a request to store data that is included with the DST request, may include a request to perform one or more tasks on stored data, may include a request to perform one or more tasks on data included with the DST request, etc. In the cases where the DST request includes a request to store data or to retrieve data, the client module and/or the DSTN module processes the request as previously discussed with reference to one or more of
FIGS. 3-19 (e.g., slice groupings) and/or 20-26 (e.g., pillar groupings). In the case where the DST request includes a request to perform one or more tasks on data included with the DST request, the DST client module and/or the DSTN module process the DST request as previously discussed with reference to one or more ofFIGS. 3-19 . - In the case where the DST request includes a request to perform one or more tasks on stored data, the DST client module and/or the DSTN module processes the DST request as will be described with reference to one or more of
FIGS. 28-39 . In general, the DST client module identifies data and one or more tasks for the DSTN module to execute upon the identified data. The DST request may be for a one-time execution of the task or for an on-going execution of the task. As an example of the latter, as a company generates daily emails, the DST request may be to daily search new emails for inappropriate content and, if found, record the content, the email sender(s), the email recipient(s), email routing information, notify human resources of the identified email, etc. -
FIG. 28 is a schematic block diagram of an example of a distributed computing system performing tasks on stored data. In this example, two distributed storage and task (DST) client modules 1-2 are shown: the first may be associated with a user device and the second may be associated with a DST processing unit or a high priority user device (e.g., high priority clearance user, system administrator, etc.). Each DST client module includes a list of storeddata 234 and a list oftasks codes 236. The list of storeddata 234 includes one or more entries of data identifying information, where each entry identifies data stored in theDSTN module 22. The data identifying information (e.g., data ID) includes one or more of a data file name, a data file directory listing, DSTN addressing information of the data, a data object identifier, etc. The list oftasks 236 includes one or more entries of task code identifying information, when each entry identifies task codes stored in theDSTN module 22. The task code identifying information (e.g., task ID) includes one or more of a task file name, a task file directory listing, DSTN addressing information of the task, another type of identifier to identify the task, etc. - As shown, the list of
data 234 and the list oftasks 236 are each smaller in number of entries for the first DST client module than the corresponding lists of the second DST client module. This may occur because the user device associated with the first DST client module has fewer privileges in the distributed computing system than the device associated with the second DST client module. Alternatively, this may occur because the user device associated with the first DST client module serves fewer users than the device associated with the second DST client module and is restricted by the distributed computing system accordingly. As yet another alternative, this may occur through no restraints by the distributed computing system, it just occurred because the operator of the user device associated with the first DST client module has selected fewer data and/or fewer tasks than the operator of the device associated with the second DST client module. - In an example of operation, the first DST client module selects one or
more data entries 238 and one ormore tasks 240 from its respective lists (e.g., selected data ID and selected task ID). The first DST client module sends its selections to atask distribution module 232. Thetask distribution module 232 may be within a stand-alone device of the distributed computing system, may be within the user device that contains the first DST client module, or may be within theDSTN module 22. - Regardless of the task distributions modules location, it generates
DST allocation information 242 from the selectedtask ID 240 and the selecteddata ID 238. TheDST allocation information 242 includes data partitioning information, task execution information, and/or intermediate result information. Thetask distribution module 232 sends theDST allocation information 242 to theDSTN module 22. Note that one or more examples of the DST allocation information will be discussed with reference to one or more ofFIGS. 29-39 . - The
DSTN module 22 interprets theDST allocation information 242 to identify the stored DS encoded data (e.g., DS error encoded data 2) and to identify the stored DS error encoded task code (e.g., DS error encoded task code 1). In addition, theDSTN module 22 interprets theDST allocation information 242 to determine how the data is to be partitioned and how the task is to be partitioned. TheDSTN module 22 also determines whether the selected DS error encodeddata 238 needs to be converted from pillar grouping to slice grouping. If so, theDSTN module 22 converts the selected DS error encoded data into slice groupings and stores the slice grouping DS error encoded data by overwriting the pillar grouping DS error encoded data or by storing it in a different location in the memory of the DSTN module 22 (i.e., does not overwrite the pillar grouping DS encoded data). - The
DSTN module 22 partitions the data and the task as indicated in theDST allocation information 242 and sends the portions to selected DST execution units of theDSTN module 22. Each of the selected DST execution units performs its partial task(s) on its slice groupings to produce partial results. TheDSTN module 22 collects the partial results from the selected DST execution units and provides them, asresult information 244, to the task distribution module. Theresult information 244 may be the collected partial results, one or more final results as produced by theDSTN module 22 from processing the partial results in accordance with theDST allocation information 242, or one or more intermediate results as produced by theDSTN module 22 from processing the partial results in accordance with theDST allocation information 242. - The
task distribution module 232 receives theresult information 244 and provides one or morefinal results 104 therefrom to the first DST client module. The final result(s) 104 may beresult information 244 or a result(s) of the task distribution module's processing of theresult information 244. - In concurrence with processing the selected task of the first DST client module, the distributed computing system may process the selected task(s) of the second DST client module on the selected data(s) of the second DST client module. Alternatively, the distributed computing system may process the second DST client module's request subsequent to, or preceding, that of the first DST client module. Regardless of the ordering and/or parallel processing of the DST client module requests, the second DST client module provides its selected
data 238 and selectedtask 240 to atask distribution module 232. If thetask distribution module 232 is a separate device of the distributed computing system or within the DSTN module, thetask distribution modules 232 coupled to the first and second DST client modules may be the same module. Thetask distribution module 232 processes the request of the second DST client module in a similar manner as it processed the request of the first DST client module. -
FIG. 29 is a schematic block diagram of an embodiment of atask distribution module 232 facilitating the example ofFIG. 28 . Thetask distribution module 232 includes a plurality of tables it uses to generate distributed storage and task (DST)allocation information 242 for selected data and selected tasks received from a DST client module. The tables includedata storage information 248,task storage information 250, distributed task (DT)execution module information 252, and task <=> sub-taskmapping information 246. - The data storage information table 248 includes a data identification (ID)
field 260, adata size field 262, an addressinginformation field 264, distributed storage (DS)information 266, and may further include other information regarding the data, how it is stored, and/or how it can be processed. For example, DS encodeddata # 1 has a data ID of 1, a data size of AA (e.g., a byte size of a few Terabytes or more), addressing information of Addr—1_AA, and DS parameters of 3/5;SEG —1; andSLC —1. In this example, the addressing information may be a virtual address corresponding to the virtual address of the first storage word (e.g., one or more bytes) of the data and information on how to calculate the other addresses, may be a range of virtual addresses for the storage words of the data, physical addresses of the first storage word or the storage words of the data, may be a list of slice names of the encoded data slices of the data, etc. The DS parameters may include identity of an error encoding scheme, decode threshold/pillar width (e.g., 3/5 for the first data entry), segment security information (e.g., SEG—1), per slice security information (e.g., SLC—1), and/or any other information regarding how the data was encoded into data slices. - The task storage information table 250 includes a task identification (ID)
field 268, atask size field 270, an addressinginformation field 272, distributed storage (DS)information 274, and may further include other information regarding the task, how it is stored, and/or how it can be used to process data. For example, DS encodedtask # 2 has a task ID of 2, a task size of XY, addressing information of Addr—2_XY, and DS parameters of 3/5;SEG —2; andSLC —2. In this example, the addressing information may be a virtual address corresponding to the virtual address of the first storage word (e.g., one or more bytes) of the task and information on how to calculate the other addresses, may be a range of virtual addresses for the storage words of the task, physical addresses of the first storage word or the storage words of the task, may be a list of slices names of the encoded slices of the task code, etc. The DS parameters may include identity of an error encoding scheme, decode threshold/pillar width (e.g., 3/5 for the first data entry), segment security information (e.g., SEG—2), per slice security information (e.g., SLC—2), and/or any other information regarding how the task was encoded into encoded task slices. Note that the segment and/or the per-slice security information include a type of encryption (if enabled), a type of compression (if enabled), watermarking information (if enabled), and/or an integrity check scheme (if enabled). - The task <=> sub-task mapping information table 246 includes a
task field 256 and asub-task field 258. Thetask field 256 identifies a task stored in the memory of a distributed storage and task network (DSTN) module and the correspondingsub-task fields 258 indicates whether the task includes sub-tasks and, if so, how many and if any of the sub-tasks are ordered. In this example, the task <=> sub-task mapping information table 246 includes an entry for each task stored in memory of the DSTN module (e.g.,task 1 through task k). In particular, this example indicates thattask 1 includes 7 sub-tasks;task 2 does not include sub-tasks, and task k includes r number of sub-tasks (where r is an integer greater than or equal to two). - The DT execution module table 252 includes a DST execution
unit ID field 276, a DT executionmodule ID field 278, and a DT executionmodule capabilities field 280. The DST executionunit ID field 276 includes the identity of DST units in the DSTN module. The DT executionmodule ID field 278 includes the identity of each DT execution unit in each DST unit. For example,DST unit 1 includes three DT executions modules (e.g., 1—1, 1—2, and 1—3). The DTexecution capabilities field 280 includes identity of the capabilities of the corresponding DT execution unit. For example,DT execution module 1—1 includes capabilities X, where X includes one or more of MIPS capabilities, processing resources (e.g., quantity and capability of microprocessors, CPUs, digital signal processors, co-processor, microcontrollers, arithmetic logic circuitry, and/or any other analog and/or digital processing circuitry), availability of the processing resources, memory information (e.g., type, size, availability, etc.), and/or any information germane to executing one or more tasks. - From these tables, the
task distribution module 232 generates theDST allocation information 242 to indicate where the data is stored, how to partition the data, where the task is stored, how to partition the task, which DT execution units should perform which partial task on which data partitions, where and how intermediate results are to be stored, etc. If multiple tasks are being performed on the same data or different data, the task distribution module factors such information into its generation of the DST allocation information. -
FIG. 30 is a diagram of a specific example of a distributed computing system performing tasks on stored data as atask flow 318. In this example, selecteddata 92 isdata 2 and selected tasks aretasks Task 1 corresponds to analyzing translation of data from one language to another (e.g., human language or computer language);task 2 corresponds to finding specific words and/or phrases in the data; andtask 3 corresponds to finding specific translated words and/or phrases in translated data. - In this example,
task 1 includes 7 sub-tasks:task 1—1—identify non-words (non-ordered);task 1—2—identify unique words (non-ordered);task 1—3—translate (non-ordered);task 1—4—translate back (ordered aftertask 1—3);task 1—5—compare to ID errors (ordered after task 1-4);task 1—6—determine non-word translation errors (ordered aftertask 1—5 and 1—1); andtask 1—7—determine correct translations (ordered after 1—5 and 1—2). The sub-task further indicates whether they are an ordered task (i.e., are dependent on the outcome of another task) or non-order (i.e., are independent of the outcome of another task).Task 2 does not include sub-tasks andtask 3 includes two sub-tasks:task 3—1 translate; andtask 3—2 find specific word or phrase in translated data. - In general, the three tasks collectively are selected to analyze data for translation accuracies, translation errors, translation anomalies, occurrence of specific words or phrases in the data, and occurrence of specific words or phrases on the translated data. Graphically, the
data 92 is translated 306 into translateddata 282; is analyzed for specific words and/orphrases 300 to produce a list of specific words and/orphrases 286; is analyzed for non-words 302 (e.g., not in a reference dictionary) to produce a list ofnon-words 290; and is analyzed forunique words 316 included in the data 92 (i.e., how many different words are included in the data) to produce a list ofunique words 298. Each of these tasks is independent of each other and can therefore be processed in parallel if desired. - The translated
data 282 is analyzed (e.g., sub-task 3—2) for specific translated words and/orphrases 304 to produce a list of specific translated words and/or phrases. The translateddata 282 is translated back 308 (e.g., sub-task 1—4) into the language of the original data to producere-translated data 284. These two tasks are dependent on the translate task (e.g.,task 1—3) and thus must be ordered after the translation task, which may be in a pipelined ordering or a serial ordering. There-translated data 284 is then compared 310 with theoriginal data 92 to find words and/or phrases that did not translate (one way and/or the other) properly to produce a list of incorrectly translatedwords 294. As such, the comparing task (e.g., sub-task 1—5) 310 is ordered after thetranslation 306 and re-translation tasks 308 (e.g., sub-tasks 1—3 and 1—4). - The list of words incorrectly translated 294 is compared 312 to the list of
non-words 290 to identify words that were not properly translated because the words are non-words to produce a list of errors due tonon-words 292. In addition, the list of words incorrectly translated 294 is compared 314 to the list ofunique words 298 to identify unique words that were properly translated to produce a list of correctly translatedwords 296. The comparison may also identify unique words that were not properly translated to produce a list of unique words that were not properly translated. Note that each list of words (e.g., specific words and/or phrases, non-words, unique words, translated words and/or phrases, etc.,) may include the word and/or phrase, how many times it is used, where in the data it is used, and/or any other information requested regarding a word and/or phrase. -
FIG. 31 is a schematic block diagram of an example of a distributed storage and task processing network (DSTN) module storing data and task codes for the example ofFIG. 30 . As shown, DS encodeddata 2 is stored as encoded data slices across the memory (e.g., stored in memories 88) of DST execution units 1-5; the DS encoded task code 1 (of task 1) and DS encodedtask 3 are stored as encoded task slices across the memory of DST execution units 1-5; and DS encoded task code 2 (of task 2) is stored as encoded task slices across the memory of DST execution units 3-7. As indicated in the data storage information table and the task storage information table ofFIG. 29 , the respective data/task has DS parameters of 3/5 for their decode threshold/pillar width; hence spanning the memory of five DST execution units. -
FIG. 32 is a diagram of an example of distributed storage and task (DST)allocation information 242 for the example ofFIG. 30 . TheDST allocation information 242 includesdata partitioning information 320,task execution information 322, andintermediate result information 324. Thedata partitioning information 320 includes the data identifier (ID), the number of partitions to split the data into, address information for each data partition, and whether the DS encoded data has to be transformed from pillar grouping to slice grouping. Thetask execution information 322 includes tabular information having atask identification field 326, atask ordering field 328, a datapartition field ID 330, and a set ofDT execution modules 332 to use for the distributed task processing per data partition. Theintermediate result information 324 includes tabular information having aname ID field 334, an ID of the DST execution unit assigned to process the correspondingintermediate result 336, a scratchpad storage field 338, and an intermediateresult storage field 340. - Continuing with the example of
FIG. 30 , where tasks 1-3 are to be distributedly performed ondata 2, the data partitioning information includes the ID ofdata 2. In addition, the task distribution module determines whether the DS encodeddata 2 is in the proper format for distributed computing (e.g., was stored as slice groupings). If not, the task distribution module indicates that the DS encodeddata 2 format needs to be changed from the pillar grouping format to the slice grouping format, which will be done the by DSTN module. In addition, the task distribution module determines the number of partitions to divide the data into (e.g., 2—1 through 2_z) and addressing information for each partition. - The task distribution module generates an entry in the task execution information section for each sub-task to be performed. For example,
task 1—1 (e.g., identify non-words on the data) has no task ordering (i.e., is independent of the results of other sub-tasks), is to be performed ondata partitions 2—1 through 2_z byDT execution modules 1—1, 2—1, 3—1, 4—1, and 5—1. For instance,DT execution modules 1—1, 2—1, 3—1, 4—1, and 5—1 search for non-words indata partitions 2—1 through 2_z to producetask 1—1 intermediate results (R1-1, which is a list of non-words).Task 1—2 (e.g., identify unique words) has similar task execution information astask 1—1 to producetask 1—2 intermediate results (R1-2, which is the list of unique words). -
Task 1—3 (e.g., translate) includes task execution information as being non-ordered (i.e., is independent), havingDT execution modules 1—1, 2—1, 3—1, 4—1, and 5—1 translatedata partitions 2—1 through 2—4 and havingDT execution modules 1—2, 2—2, 3—2, 4—2, and 5—2 translatedata partitions 2—5 through 2_z to producetask 1—3 intermediate results (R1-3, which is the translated data). In this example, the data partitions are grouped, where different sets of DT execution modules perform a distributed sub-task (or task) on each data partition group, which allows for further parallel processing. -
Task 1—4 (e.g., translate back) is ordered aftertask 1—3 and is to be executed ontask 1—3's intermediate result (e.g., R1-3—1) (e.g., the translated data).DT execution modules 1—1, 2—1, 3—1, 4—1, and 5—1 are allocated to translate backtask 1—3 intermediate result partitions R1-3—1 through R1-3—4 andDT execution modules 1—2, 2—2, 6—1, 7—1, and 7—2 are allocated to translate backtask 1—3 intermediate result partitions R1-3—5 through R1-3_z to produce task 1-4 intermediate results (R1-4, which is the translated back data). -
Task 1—5 (e.g., compare data and translated data to identify translation errors) is ordered aftertask 1—4 and is to be executed ontask 1—4's intermediate results (R4-1) and on the data.DT execution modules 1—1, 2—1, 3—1, 4—1, and 5—1 are allocated to compare the data partitions (2—1 through 2_z) with partitions of task 1-4 intermediate results partitions R1-4—1 through R1-4_z to producetask 1—5 intermediate results (R1-5, which is the list words translated incorrectly). -
Task 1—6 (e.g., determine non-word translation errors) is ordered aftertasks 1—1 and 1—5 and is to be executed ontasks 1—1's and 1—5's intermediate results (R1-1 and R1-5).DT execution modules 1—1, 2—1, 3—1, 4—1, and 5—1 are allocated to compare the partitions oftask 1—1 intermediate results (R1-1—1 through R1-1_z) with partitions of task 1-5 intermediate results partitions (R1-5—1 through R1-5_z) to producetask 1—6 intermediate results (R1-6, which is the list translation errors due to non-words). -
Task 1—7 (e.g., determine words correctly translated) is ordered aftertasks 1—2 and 1—5 and is to be executed ontasks 1—2's and 1—5's intermediate results (R1-1 and R1-5).DT execution modules 1—2, 2—2, 3—2, 4—2, and 5—2 are allocated to compare the partitions oftask 1—2 intermediate results (R1-2—1 through R1-2_z) with partitions of task 1-5 intermediate results partitions (R1-5—1 through R1-5_z) to producetask 1—7 intermediate results (R1-7, which is the list of correctly translated words). - Task 2 (e.g., find specific words and/or phrases) has no task ordering (i.e., is independent of the results of other sub-tasks), is to be performed on
data partitions 2—1 through 2_z byDT execution modules 3—1, 4—1, 5—1, 6—1, and 7—1. For instance,DT execution modules 3—1, 4—1, 5—1, 6—1, and 7—1 search for specific words and/or phrases indata partitions 2—1 through 2_z to producetask 2 intermediate results (R2, which is a list of specific words and/or phrases). -
Task 3—2 (e.g., find specific translated words and/or phrases) is ordered aftertask 1—3 (e.g., translate) is to be performed on partitions R1-3—1 through R1-3_z byDT execution modules 1—2, 2—2, 3—2, 4—2, and 5—2. For instance,DT execution modules 1—2, 2—2, 3—2, 4—2, and 5—2 search for specific translated words and/or phrases in the partitions of the translated data (R1-3—1 through R1-3_z) to producetask 3—2 intermediate results (R3-2, which is a list of specific translated words and/or phrases). - For each task, the intermediate result information indicates which DST unit is responsible for overseeing execution of the task and, if needed, processing the partial results generated by the set of allocated DT execution units. In addition, the intermediate result information indicates a scratch pad memory for the task and where the corresponding intermediate results are to be stored. For example, for intermediate result R1-1 (the intermediate result of
task 1—1),DST unit 1 is responsible for overseeing execution of thetask 1—1 and coordinates storage of the intermediate result as encoded intermediate result slices stored in memory of DST execution units 1-5. In general, the scratch pad is for storing non-DS encoded intermediate results and the intermediate result storage is for storing DS encoded intermediate results. -
FIGS. 33-38 are schematic block diagrams of the distributed storage and task network (DSTN) module performing the example ofFIG. 30 . InFIG. 33 , the DSTN module accesses thedata 92 and partitions it into a plurality of partitions 1-z in accordance with distributed storage and task network (DST) allocation information. For each data partition, the DSTN identifies a set of its DT (distributed task)execution modules 90 to perform the task (e.g., identify non-words (i.e., not in a reference dictionary) within the data partition) in accordance with the DST allocation information. From data partition to data partition, the set ofDT execution modules 90 may be the same, different, or a combination thereof (e.g., some data partitions use the same set while other data partitions use different sets). - For the first data partition, the first set of DT execution modules (e.g., 1—1, 2—1, 3—1, 4—1, and 5—1 per the DST allocation information of
FIG. 32 ) executestask 1—1 to produce a firstpartial result 102 of non-words found in the first data partition. The second set of DT execution modules (e.g., 1—1, 2—1, 3—1, 4—1, and 5—1 per the DST allocation information ofFIG. 32 ) executestask 1—1 to produce a secondpartial result 102 of non-words found in the second data partition. The sets of DT execution modules (as per the DST allocation information) performtask 1—1 on the data partitions until the “z” set of DT execution modules performstask 1—1 on the “zth” data partition to produce a “zth”partial result 102 of non-words found in the “zth” data partition. - As indicated in the DST allocation information of
FIG. 32 ,DST execution unit 1 is assigned to process the first through “zth” partial results to produce the first intermediate result (R1-1), which is a list of non-words found in the data. For instance, each set ofDT execution modules 90 stores its respective partial result in the scratchpad memory of DST execution unit 1 (which is identified in the DST allocation or may be determined by DST execution unit 1). A processing module ofDST execution 1 is engaged to aggregate the first through “zth” partial results to produce the first intermediate result (e.g., R1—1). The processing module stores the first intermediate result as non-DS error encoded data in the scratchpad memory or in another section of memory ofDST execution unit 1. -
DST execution unit 1 engages its DST client module to slice grouping based DS error encode the first intermediate result (e.g., the list of non-words). To begin the encoding, the DST client module determines whether the list of non-words is of a sufficient size to partition (e.g., greater than a Terabytes). If yes, it partitions the first intermediate result (R1-1) into a plurality of partitions (e.g., R1-1—1 through R1-1_m). If the first intermediate result is not of sufficient size to partition, it is not partitioned. - For each partition of the first intermediate result, or for the first intermediate result, the DST client module uses the DS error encoding parameters of the data (e.g., DS parameters of
data 2, which includes 3/5 decode threshold/pillar width ratio) to produce slice groupings. The slice groupings are stored in the intermediate result memory (e.g., allocated memory in the memories of DST execution units 1-5). - In
FIG. 34 , the DSTN module is performingtask 1—2 (e.g., find unique words) on thedata 92. To begin, the DSTN module accesses thedata 92 and partitions it into a plurality of partitions 1-z in accordance with the DST allocation information or it may use the data partitions oftask 1—1 if the partitioning is the same. For each data partition, the DSTN identifies a set of its DT execution modules to performtask 1—2 in accordance with the DST allocation information. From data partition to data partition, the set of DT execution modules may be the same, different, or a combination thereof. For the data partitions, the allocated set of DT execution modules executestask 1—2 to produce a partial results (e.g., 1st through “zth”) of unique words found in the data partitions. - As indicated in the DST allocation information of
FIG. 32 ,DST execution unit 1 is assigned to process the first through “zth”partial results 102 oftask 1—2 to produce the second intermediate result (R1-2), which is a list of unique words found in thedata 92. The processing module ofDST execution 1 is engaged to aggregate the first through “zth” partial results of unique words to produce the second intermediate result. The processing module stores the second intermediate result as non-DS error encoded data in the scratchpad memory or in another section of memory ofDST execution unit 1. -
DST execution unit 1 engages its DST client module to slice grouping based DS error encode the second intermediate result (e.g., the list of non-words). To begin the encoding, the DST client module determines whether the list of unique words is of a sufficient size to partition (e.g., greater than a Terabytes). If yes, it partitions the second intermediate result (R1-2) into a plurality of partitions (e.g., R1-2—1 through R1-2_m). If the second intermediate result is not of sufficient size to partition, it is not partitioned. - For each partition of the second intermediate result, or for the second intermediate results, the DST client module uses the DS error encoding parameters of the data (e.g., DS parameters of
data 2, which includes 3/5 decode threshold/pillar width ratio) to produce slice groupings. The slice groupings are stored in the intermediate result memory (e.g., allocated memory in the memories of DST execution units 1-5). - In
FIG. 35 , the DSTN module is performingtask 1—3 (e.g., translate) on thedata 92. To begin, the DSTN module accesses thedata 92 and partitions it into a plurality of partitions 1-z in accordance with the DST allocation information or it may use the data partitions oftask 1—1 if the partitioning is the same. For each data partition, the DSTN identifies a set of its DT execution modules to performtask 1—3 in accordance with the DST allocation information (e.g.,DT execution modules 1—1, 2—1, 3—1, 4—1, and 5—1 translatedata partitions 2—1 through 2—4 andDT execution modules 1—2, 2—2, 3—2, 4—2, and 5—2 translatedata partitions 2—5 through 2_z). For the data partitions, the allocated set ofDT execution modules 90 executestask 1—3 to produce partial results 102 (e.g., 1st through “zth”) of translated data. - As indicated in the DST allocation information of
FIG. 32 ,DST execution unit 2 is assigned to process the first through “zth” partial results oftask 1—3 to produce the third intermediate result (R1-3), which is translated data. The processing module ofDST execution 2 is engaged to aggregate the first through “zth” partial results of translated data to produce the third intermediate result. The processing module stores the third intermediate result as non-DS error encoded data in the scratchpad memory or in another section of memory ofDST execution unit 2. -
DST execution unit 2 engages its DST client module to slice grouping based DS error encode the third intermediate result (e.g., translated data). To begin the encoding, the DST client module partitions the third intermediate result (R1-3) into a plurality of partitions (e.g., R1-3—1 through R1-3_y). For each partition of the third intermediate result, the DST client module uses the DS error encoding parameters of the data (e.g., DS parameters ofdata 2, which includes 3/5 decode threshold/pillar width ratio) to produce slice groupings. The slice groupings are stored in the intermediate result memory (e.g., allocated memory in the memories of DST execution units 2-6 per the DST allocation information). - As is further shown in
FIG. 35 , the DSTN module is performingtask 1—4 (e.g., retranslate) on the translated data of the third intermediate result. To begin, the DSTN module accesses the translated data (from the scratchpad memory or from the intermediate result memory and decodes it) and partitions it into a plurality of partitions in accordance with the DST allocation information. For each partition of the third intermediate result, the DSTN identifies a set of itsDT execution modules 90 to performtask 1—4 in accordance with the DST allocation information (e.g.,DT execution modules 1—1, 2—1, 3—1, 4—1, and 5—1 are allocated to translate back partitions R1-3—1 through R1-3—4 andDT execution modules 1—2, 2—2, 6—1, 7—1, and 7—2 are allocated to translate back partitions R1-3—5 through R1-3_z). For the partitions, the allocated set of DT execution modules executestask 1—4 to produce partial results 102 (e.g., 1st through “zth”) of re-translated data. - As indicated in the DST allocation information of
FIG. 32 ,DST execution unit 3 is assigned to process the first through “zth” partial results oftask 1—4 to produce the fourth intermediate result (R1-4), which is retranslated data. The processing module ofDST execution 3 is engaged to aggregate the first through “zth” partial results of retranslated data to produce the fourth intermediate result. The processing module stores the fourth intermediate result as non-DS error encoded data in the scratchpad memory or in another section of memory ofDST execution unit 3. -
DST execution unit 3 engages its DST client module to slice grouping based DS error encode the fourth intermediate result (e.g., retranslated data). To begin the encoding, the DST client module partitions the fourth intermediate result (R1-4) into a plurality of partitions (e.g., R1-4—1 through R1-4_z). For each partition of the fourth intermediate result, the DST client module uses the DS error encoding parameters of the data (e.g., DS parameters ofdata 2, which includes 3/5 decode threshold/pillar width ratio) to produce slice groupings. The slice groupings are stored in the intermediate result memory (e.g., allocated memory in the memories of DST execution units 3-7 per the DST allocation information). - In
FIG. 36 , a distributed storage and task network (DSTN) module is performingtask 1—5 (e.g., compare) ondata 92 and retranslated data ofFIG. 35 . To begin, the DSTN module accesses thedata 92 and partitions it into a plurality of partitions in accordance with the DST allocation information or it may use the data partitions oftask 1—1 if the partitioning is the same. The DSTN module also accesses the retranslated data from the scratchpad memory, or from the intermediate result memory and decodes it, and partitions it into a plurality of partitions in accordance with the DST allocation information. The number of partitions of the retranslated data corresponds to the number of partitions of the data. - For each pair of partitions (e.g.,
data partition 1 and retranslated data partition 1), the DSTN identifies a set of itsDT execution modules 90 to performtask 1—5 in accordance with the DST allocation information (e.g.,DT execution modules 1—1, 2—1, 3—1, 4—1, and 5—1). For each pair of partitions, the allocated set of DT execution modules executestask 1—5 to produce partial results 102 (e.g., 1st through “zth”) of a list of incorrectly translated words and/or phrases. - As indicated in the DST allocation information of
FIG. 32 ,DST execution unit 1 is assigned to process the first through “zth” partial results oftask 1—5 to produce the fifth intermediate result (R1-5), which is the list of incorrectly translated words and/or phrases. In particular, the processing module ofDST execution 1 is engaged to aggregate the first through “zth” partial results of the list of incorrectly translated words and/or phrases to produce the fifth intermediate result. The processing module stores the fifth intermediate result as non-DS error encoded data in the scratchpad memory or in another section of memory ofDST execution unit 1. -
DST execution unit 1 engages its DST client module to slice grouping based DS error encode the fifth intermediate result. To begin the encoding, the DST client module partitions the fifth intermediate result (R1-5) into a plurality of partitions (e.g., R1-5—1 through R1-5_z). For each partition of the fifth intermediate result, the DST client module uses the DS error encoding parameters of the data (e.g., DS parameters ofdata 2, which includes 3/5 decode threshold/pillar width ratio) to produce slice groupings. The slice groupings are stored in the intermediate result memory (e.g., allocated memory in the memories of DST execution units 1-5 per the DST allocation information). - As is further shown in
FIG. 36 , the DSTN module is performingtask 1—6 (e.g., translation errors due to non-words) on the list of incorrectly translated words and/or phrases (e.g., the fifth intermediate result R1-5) and the list of non-words (e.g., the first intermediate result R1-1). To begin, the DSTN module accesses the lists and partitions them into a corresponding number of partitions. - For each pair of partitions (e.g., partition R1-1—1 and partition R1-5—1), the DSTN identifies a set of its
DT execution modules 90 to performtask 1—6 in accordance with the DST allocation information (e.g.,DT execution modules 1—1, 2—1, 3—1, 4—1, and 5—1). For each pair of partitions, the allocated set of DT execution modules executestask 1—6 to produce partial results 102 (e.g., 1st through “zth”) of a list of incorrectly translated words and/or phrases due to non-words. - As indicated in the DST allocation information of
FIG. 32 ,DST execution unit 2 is assigned to process the first through “zth” partial results oftask 1—6 to produce the sixth intermediate result (R1-6), which is the list of incorrectly translated words and/or phrases due to non-words. In particular, the processing module ofDST execution 2 is engaged to aggregate the first through “zth” partial results of the list of incorrectly translated words and/or phrases due to non-words to produce the sixth intermediate result. The processing module stores the sixth intermediate result as non-DS error encoded data in the scratchpad memory or in another section of memory ofDST execution unit 2. -
DST execution unit 2 engages its DST client module to slice grouping based DS error encode the sixth intermediate result. To begin the encoding, the DST client module partitions the sixth intermediate result (R1-6) into a plurality of partitions (e.g., R1-6—1 through R1-6_z). For each partition of the sixth intermediate result, the DST client module uses the DS error encoding parameters of the data (e.g., DS parameters ofdata 2, which includes 3/5 decode threshold/pillar width ratio) to produce slice groupings. The slice groupings are stored in the intermediate result memory (e.g., allocated memory in the memories of DST execution units 2-6 per the DST allocation information). - As is still further shown in
FIG. 36 , the DSTN module is performingtask 1—7 (e.g., correctly translated words and/or phrases) on the list of incorrectly translated words and/or phrases (e.g., the fifth intermediate result R1-5) and the list of unique words (e.g., the second intermediate result R1-2). To begin, the DSTN module accesses the lists and partitions them into a corresponding number of partitions. - For each pair of partitions (e.g., partition R1-2—1 and partition R1-5—1), the DSTN identifies a set of its
DT execution modules 90 to performtask 1—7 in accordance with the DST allocation information (e.g.,DT execution modules 1—2, 2—2, 3—2, 4—2, and 5—2). For each pair of partitions, the allocated set of DT execution modules executestask 1—7 to produce partial results 102 (e.g., 1st through “zth”) of a list of correctly translated words and/or phrases. - As indicated in the DST allocation information of
FIG. 32 ,DST execution unit 3 is assigned to process the first through “zth” partial results oftask 1—7 to produce the seventh intermediate result (R1-7), which is the list of correctly translated words and/or phrases. In particular, the processing module ofDST execution 3 is engaged to aggregate the first through “zth” partial results of the list of correctly translated words and/or phrases to produce the seventh intermediate result. The processing module stores the seventh intermediate result as non-DS error encoded data in the scratchpad memory or in another section of memory ofDST execution unit 3. -
DST execution unit 3 engages its DST client module to slice grouping based DS error encode the seventh intermediate result. To begin the encoding, the DST client module partitions the seventh intermediate result (R1-7) into a plurality of partitions (e.g., R1-7—1 through R1-7_z). For each partition of the seventh intermediate result, the DST client module uses the DS error encoding parameters of the data (e.g., DS parameters ofdata 2, which includes 3/5 decode threshold/pillar width ratio) to produce slice groupings. The slice groupings are stored in the intermediate result memory (e.g., allocated memory in the memories of DST execution units 3-7 per the DST allocation information). - In
FIG. 37 , the distributed storage and task network (DSTN) module is performing task 2 (e.g., find specific words and/or phrases) on thedata 92. To begin, the DSTN module accesses the data and partitions it into a plurality of partitions 1-z in accordance with the DST allocation information or it may use the data partitions oftask 1—1 if the partitioning is the same. For each data partition, the DSTN identifies a set of itsDT execution modules 90 to performtask 2 in accordance with the DST allocation information. From data partition to data partition, the set of DT execution modules may be the same, different, or a combination thereof. For the data partitions, the allocated set of DT execution modules executestask 2 to produce partial results 102 (e.g., 1st through “zth”) of specific words and/or phrases found in the data partitions. - As indicated in the DST allocation information of
FIG. 32 ,DST execution unit 7 is assigned to process the first through “zth” partial results oftask 2 to producetask 2 intermediate result (R2), which is a list of specific words and/or phrases found in the data. The processing module ofDST execution 7 is engaged to aggregate the first through “zth” partial results of specific words and/or phrases to produce thetask 2 intermediate result. The processing module stores thetask 2 intermediate result as non-DS error encoded data in the scratchpad memory or in another section of memory ofDST execution unit 7. -
DST execution unit 7 engages its DST client module to slice grouping based DS error encode thetask 2 intermediate result. To begin the encoding, the DST client module determines whether the list of specific words and/or phrases is of a sufficient size to partition (e.g., greater than a Terabytes). If yes, it partitions thetask 2 intermediate result (R2) into a plurality of partitions (e.g.,R2 —1 through R2_m). If thetask 2 intermediate result is not of sufficient size to partition, it is not partitioned. - For each partition of the
task 2 intermediate result, or for thetask 2 intermediate results, the DST client module uses the DS error encoding parameters of the data (e.g., DS parameters ofdata 2, which includes 3/5 decode threshold/pillar width ratio) to produce slice groupings. The slice groupings are stored in the intermediate result memory (e.g., allocated memory in the memories of DST execution units 1-4, and 7). - In
FIG. 38 , the distributed storage and task network (DSTN) module is performing task 3 (e.g., find specific translated words and/or phrases) on the translated data (R1-3). To begin, the DSTN module accesses the translated data (from the scratchpad memory or from the intermediate result memory and decodes it) and partitions it into a plurality of partitions in accordance with the DST allocation information. For each partition, the DSTN identifies a set of its DT execution modules to performtask 3 in accordance with the DST allocation information. From partition to partition, the set of DT execution modules may be the same, different, or a combination thereof. For the partitions, the allocated set ofDT execution modules 90 executestask 3 to produce partial results 102 (e.g., 1st through “zth”) of specific translated words and/or phrases found in the data partitions. - As indicated in the DST allocation information of
FIG. 32 ,DST execution unit 5 is assigned to process the first through “zth” partial results oftask 3 to producetask 3 intermediate result (R3), which is a list of specific translated words and/or phrases found in the translated data. In particular, the processing module ofDST execution 5 is engaged to aggregate the first through “zth” partial results of specific translated words and/or phrases to produce thetask 3 intermediate result. The processing module stores thetask 3 intermediate result as non-DS error encoded data in the scratchpad memory or in another section of memory ofDST execution unit 7. -
DST execution unit 5 engages its DST client module to slice grouping based DS error encode thetask 3 intermediate result. To begin the encoding, the DST client module determines whether the list of specific translated words and/or phrases is of a sufficient size to partition (e.g., greater than a Terabytes). If yes, it partitions thetask 3 intermediate result (R3) into a plurality of partitions (e.g.,R3 —1 through R3_m). If thetask 3 intermediate result is not of sufficient size to partition, it is not partitioned. - For each partition of the
task 3 intermediate result, or for thetask 3 intermediate results, the DST client module uses the DS error encoding parameters of the data (e.g., DS parameters ofdata 2, which includes 3/5 decode threshold/pillar width ratio) to produce slice groupings. The slice groupings are stored in the intermediate result memory (e.g., allocated memory in the memories of DST execution units 1-4, 5, and 7). -
FIG. 39 is a diagram of an example of combining result information intofinal results 104 for the example ofFIG. 30 . In this example, the result information includes the list of specific words and/or phrases found in the data (task 2 intermediate result), the list of specific translated words and/or phrases found in the data (task 3 intermediate result), the list of non-words found in the data (task 1 first intermediate result R1-1), the list of unique words found in the data (task 1 second intermediate result R1-2), the list of translation errors due to non-words (task 1 sixth intermediate result R1-6), and the list of correctly translated words and/or phrases (task 1 seventh intermediate result R1-7). The task distribution module provides the result information to the requesting DST client module as theresults 104. -
FIGS. 40A-40D are schematic block diagrams of an embodiment of a dispersed storage network (DSN) illustrating an example of storing data in DSN memory. The DSN includes the distributed storage and task (DST)client module 34 ofFIG. 1 , thenetwork 24 ofFIG. 1 , and the distributed storage and task network (DSTN)module 22 ofFIG. 1 . Hereafter, theDSTN module 22 may be referred to interchangeably as the DSN memory. TheDSTN module 22 includes one or more storage generations, where each storage generation is associated with a vault of the DSN. A vault includes virtual storage of the DSN and may be associated with one or more users of the DSN. Incremental storage generations may be added over time to provide incremental storage capacity as a total amount of data stored associated with the vault grows. For example, theDSTN module 22 includes storage generations 1-3 during a first timeframe (e.g., as illustrated inFIGS. 40A-B ) and includes storage generations 1-5 during a second timeframe (e.g., as illustrated inFIGS. 40C-D ). Each storage generation includes a set of DST execution (EX) units 1-n. Each DST execution unit may be implemented utilizing theDST execution unit 36 ofFIG. 1 . Hereafter, the DST execution unit may be referred to interchangeably as a storage unit of a set of storage units associated with each storage generation. - The
DST client module 34 includes theoutbound DST processing 80 ofFIG. 3 , theinbound DST processing 82 ofFIG. 3 , and aslice name module 350. Theslice name module 350 may be implemented utilizing theprocessing module 84 ofFIG. 3 . TheDST client module 34 further includes a dispersed storage (DS)module 351. TheDS module 351 may be implemented utilizing a plurality of processing modules. For instance, the plurality of processing modules may include theprocessing module 84 ofFIG. 3 . As a specific example, the plurality of processing module includes a first module, a second module, a third module, a fourth module, a fifth module, and a sixth module. The first through sixth modules may be utilized to implement theoutbound DST processing 80, theinbound DST processing 82, and theslice name module 350. The DSN functions to accessdata 352 in theDSTN module 22 without utilizing a directory. The accessing of thedata 352 includes storing of thedata 352 and retrieving stored data to reproduce thedata 352. -
FIG. 40A illustrates initial steps of an example of the storing of thedata 352, where theoutbound DST processing 80 receives thedata 352 for storage, where the data has a data name. The data name includes file system information. The file system information includes one or more of a user identifier (ID), a vault identifier, and a file system path name for the data. Having received thedata 352, theoutbound DST processing 80 dispersed storage error encodes thedata 352 to produce a plurality of sets of encoded data slices. - Having produced the plurality of sets of encoded data slices, the
outbound DST processing 80 generates a plurality of sets of DSN data addresses based on a data object number associated with the data and data storage information. Each set of the plurality of sets of DSN data addresses includes a set of DSN addresses, where the set of DSN addresses includes a set of slice names. Each slice name includes one or more of a slice index corresponding to a particular slice of the set of encoded data slices, a vault ID corresponding to an associated vault, a generation number corresponding to one of the storage generations, the data object number, and a segment number corresponding to the set of encoded data slices. As a specific example, theoutbound DST processing 80 utilizes a pseudo random number generator to produce the data object number, performs a system registry lookup to retrieve the vault ID corresponding to a requesting entity, and selects a storage generation of the storage generations to produce the generation number. - The selecting of the storage generation for storing of the
data 352 includes at least one of a random selection, selecting a most recently activated storage generation, selecting a storage generation associated with a highest storage availability level, selecting a storage generation based on interpreting a data storage request, selecting a storage generation based on interpreting a system registry entry, and selecting a storage generation associated with a storage availability level that is greater than a storage availability threshold level. For instance, theoutbound DST processing 80 selects a most recently activatedstorage generation 3 as the selected storage generation to producegeneration number 3. - The data storage information includes dispersed storage error encoding parameters. The dispersed storage error encoding parameters includes one or more of data segmenting information regarding segmenting the
data 352 into a plurality of data segments, a total number of encoded data slices per set of encoded data slices, a decode threshold number of encoded data slices per set of encoded data slices, a read threshold number of encoded data slices per set of encoded data slices, and a write threshold number of encoded data slices per the set of encoded data slices. Theoutbound DST processing 80 determines the data storage information. The determining includes at least one of performing a system registry lookup, receiving the dispersed storage error encoding parameters, and determining the dispersed storage error encoding parameters based on one or more of received storage requirements and an estimated DSN performance level. - Having generated the plurality of sets of DSN data addresses, the
outbound DST processing 80 sends, via thenetwork 24, the plurality of sets of encoded data slices to the DSTN module 22 (e.g., DSN memory) for storage in accordance with the plurality of sets of DSN data addresses. As a specific example, theoutbound DST processing 80 generates a set of write slice requests that includes the plurality of sets of encoded data slices and the plurality of sets of DSN data addresses, and outputs the set of write slice requests that includes the plurality of sets of encoded data slices (EDS) 1-n ofgeneration 3 to the set of DST execution units 1-n of thestorage generation 3. -
FIG. 40B illustrates final steps of the example of the storing of thedata 352, where theoutbound DST processing 80 generates retrieval data that is based on the data object number and the data storage information. As a specific example, theoutbound DST processing 80 aggregates the data object number, the vault ID and the generation number to produce the retrieval data. Having generated the retrieval data, theoutbound DST processing 80 dispersed storage error encodes the retrieval data to produce a set of encoded retrieval data slices. - With the set of encoded retrieval data slices produced, the
slice name module 350 generates a set of DSN retrieval data addresses 356 based on thedata name 354 and on retrieval data storage information. The set of DSN retrieval data addresses 356 includes a set of slice names for the set of encoded retrieval data slices. Each slice name for a corresponding encoded retrieval data slice includes one or more of a slice index corresponding to a particular slice of the set of encoded retrieval data slices, the vault ID, a generation number for the retrieval data corresponding to at least one of the storage generations, a retrieval data object number, and a segment number corresponding to the set of encoded retrieval data slices. As a specific example,slice name module 350 performs a deterministic function on thedata name 354 to produce the retrieval data object number, and selects at least one storage generation of the storage generations to produce the generation number. The deterministic function includes one or more of a hashing function, a hash-based message authentication code function, a mask generating function, and a sponge function. For instance, theslice name module 350 performs the mask generating function on thedata name 354 to directly produce the retrieval data object number. - The selecting of the at least one storage generation for storing of the retrieval data includes at least one of a random selection, applying a deterministic function to the
data name 354, selecting the most recently activated storage generation, selecting the storage generation associated with the highest storage availability level, selecting the storage generation based on interpreting the data storage request, selecting the storage generation based on interpreting the system registry entry, and selecting the storage generation associated with the storage availability level that is greater than the storage availability threshold level. For instance, theslice name module 350 performs the hashing function on thedata name 354 to produce an intermediate result, and takes the intermediate result modulo a number of current storage generations to producegeneration number 2. - The retrieval data storage information includes dispersed storage error encoding parameters for the retrieval data. The dispersed storage error encoding parameters for the retrieval data includes one or more of a total number of encoded retrieval data slices for the set of encoded retrieval data slices, a decode threshold number of encoded retrieval data slices for the set of encoded retrieval data slices, a read threshold number of encoded retrieval data slices for the set of encoded retrieval data slices, and a write threshold number of encoded retrieval data slices for the set of encoded retrieval data slices. The
outbound DST processing 80 determines the retrieval data storage information. Alternatively, theslice name module 350 determines the retrieval data storage information. The determining includes at least one of performing a system registry lookup, receiving the dispersed storage error encoding parameters for the retrieval data, utilizing the dispersed storage error encoding parameters of thedata 352, and determining the dispersed storage error encoding parameters for the retrieval data based on one or more of further received storage requirements and the estimated DSN performance level. - With the DSN retrieval data addresses 356 produced, the
outbound DST processing 80 sends, via thenetwork 24, the set of encoded retrieval data slices to the DSTN module 22 (e.g., DSN memory) for storage in accordance with the set of DSN retrieval data addresses 356. As a specific example, theoutbound DST processing 80 generates another set of write slice requests that includes the set of encoded retrieval data slices and the set of DSN retrieval data addresses 356; and outputs the other set of write slice requests that includes the set of encoded retrieval data slices (ERDS) 1-n ofgeneration 2 to the set of DST execution units 1-n of thestorage generation 2. - Alternatively, or in addition to, one or more of the
slice name module 350 and theoutbound DST processing 80 may determine to store the retrieval data in at least one other storage generation. As a specific example, theslice name module 350 determines to store multiple copies of the set of encoded retrieval data slices and identifies multiple sets of storage units of the DSN memory for storing the multiple copies. The multiple sets of storage units being part of a logical storage vault within the DSN memory, where a first set of storage units of the set of storage units corresponds to a first generation of the DSN memory and a second set of storage units of the set of storage units corresponds to a second generation of the DSN memory. The determining includes one or more of detecting that a size of the retrieval data is less than a size threshold level, detecting that an available storage capacity level is greater than an available storage capacity threshold level, interpreting a system registry entry, and interpreting a request. - When determining to store multiple copies of the set of encoded retrieval data slices, the
slice name module 350 generates a unique set of DSN retrieval data addresses based on the data name, on the retrieval data storage information, and on a corresponding one of the multiple sets of storage units. As a specific example, theslice name module 350 generates another set of DSN retrieval data addresses that includesgeneration 3 when identifyingstorage generation 3. With the other set of DSN retrieval data addresses, theoutbound DST processing 80 sends, via thenetwork 24, the set of encoded retrieval data slices to the corresponding one of the multiple sets of storage units for storage in accordance with the other set of DSN retrieval data addresses. As a specific example, theoutbound DST processing 80 generates yet another set of write slice requests that includes the set of encoded retrieval data slices and the other set of DSN retrieval data addresses 356; and outputs the yet another set of write slice requests that includes the set of encoded retrieval data slices (ERDS) 1-n ofgeneration 3 to the set of DST execution units 1-n of thestorage generation 3. -
FIG. 40C illustrates initial steps of the example of the retrieving of the stored data to reproduce thedata 352, where theinbound DST processing 82 receives a read request regarding the data, where the read request includes thedata name 354. Having received thedata name 354, theinbound DST processing 82 estimates likely retrieval data storage information. Alternatively, theslice name module 350 estimates the likely retrieval data storage information. As a specific example, theslice name module 350 determines a logical DSN address to physical storage device mapping (e.g., identifies DSN address ranges corresponding to each current storage generation). As another specific example, theslice name module 350 determines historical use patterns of the DSN memory (e.g., which storage generations hold the most retrieval data). As yet another specific example, theslice name module 350 determines historical storage patterns of a requesting entity that is requesting the read request (e.g., identify likely storage generations associated with storage of retrieval data associated with the requesting entity). - Having estimated the likely retrieval data storage information, the
slice name module 350 generates likely DSN retrieval data addresses 358 based on thedata name 354 and the likely retrieval data storage information. As a specific example, theslice name module 350 generates the likely DSN retrieval data addresses 358 to includegeneration 3 when the likely retrieval data storage information includes identification ofstorage generation 3. - With the likely DSN retrieval data addresses 358 being generated, the
inbound DST processing 82 sends read requests to the likely DSN retrieval data addresses 358. As a specific example, theinbound DST processing 82 sends, via thenetwork 24, retrieval data read requests forgeneration 3, that includes a set of read slice requests 1-n, to the set of DST execution units associated withstorage generation 3. The set of DST execution units 1-n issues read slice responses to theinbound DST processing 82, where the read slice responses includes encoded retrieval data slices ofgeneration 3. - When favorable responses to the read requests have been received, the
inbound DST processing 82 reconstructs the retrieval data. Having reconstructive the retrieval data, theinbound DST processing 82 utilizes the retrieval data to reconstruct the data. The reconstruction of the data is discussed in greater detail with reference toFIG. 40D . - When the favorable responses to the read requests have not been received (e.g., if the read requests were sent to
storage generation 4 instead of 3), at least one of theinbound DST processing 82 and theslice name module 350 estimates a second likely retrieval data storage information and generates second likely DSN retrieval data addresses based on the data name and the second likely retrieval data storage information. For example, theslice name module 350 generates second likely DSN retrieval data addresses forgeneration 3. Having generated the second likely DSN retrieval data addresses, theinbound DST processing 82 sends second read requests to the second likely DSN retrieval data addresses. For example, theinbound DST processing 82 sends, via thenetwork 24, retrieval data read requests forgeneration 3 to the set of DST execution units associated withstorage generation 3. When favorable responses to the second read requests have been received, theinbound DST processing 82 reconstructs the retrieval data and utilizes the retrieval data to reconstruct the data. - Alternatively, or in addition to, at least one of the
inbound DST processing 82 and theslice name module 350 determines to recover the retrieval data from at least two storage generations. The determining includes at least one of interpreting a request, interpreting another system registry entry, and detecting that a system loading level is less than a system loading threshold level. When recovering from the at least two storage generations, at least one of theinbound DST processing 82 and theslice name module 350 estimates the second likely retrieval data storage information. With the second likely retrieval data storage information, theslice name module 350 generates the second likely DSN retrieval data addresses based on thedata name 354 and the second likely retrieval data storage information. With the second likely DSN retrieval data addresses, theinbound DST processing 82 sends, via thenetwork 24, the second read requests to the second likely DSN retrieval data addresses. When favorable responses to either of the read requests or the second read requests have been received, theinbound DST processing 82 reconstructs the retrieval data and utilizes the retrieval data to reconstruct the data. -
FIG. 40D illustrates final steps of the example of the retrieving of the stored data to reproduce thedata 352, where theinbound DST processing 82 extracts the DSN data addresses from the reconstructed retrieval data and issues a data retrieval requests to theDSTN module 22 in accordance with the extracted DSN data addresses. As a specific example, theinbound DST processing 82 generates a set of read slice requests that includes the plurality of sets of DSN data addresses based on the extracted DSN data addresses. Having generated the set of read slice request, theinbound DST processing 82 sends the set of read slice requests to the set of DST execution units 1-n ofstorage generation 3, where the read slice requests includes read slice requests for the plurality of encoded data slices stored instorage generation 3. The set of DST execution units 1-n ofstorage generation 3 sends encoded data slices ofgeneration 3 to theinbound DST processing 82. Theinbound DST processing 82 decodes received encoded data slices to reproduce thedata 352. -
FIG. 40E is a flowchart illustrating an example of accessing data. The method includes storage where at step 360 a processing module (e.g., of a distributed storage and task (DST) client module of a dispersed storage network (DSN)) sends a plurality of sets of encoded data slices to DSN memory for storage in accordance with a plurality of sets of DSN data addresses. The data was dispersed storage error encoded to produce the plurality of sets of encoded data slices. The data has a data name and the plurality of sets of DSN data addresses is generated based on a data object number associated with the data and data storage information. The data name includes file system information. The processing module may utilize a pseudo random number generator to produce the data object number. The processing module may determine, as the data storage information, dispersed storage error encoding parameters. - The method continues at
step 362 where the processing module generates retrieval data that is based on the data object number and the data storage information. For example, the processing module generates the retrieval data to include a source name associated with the sets of DSN data addresses. The method continues atstep 364 where the processing module dispersed storage error encodes the retrieval data to produce a set of encoded retrieval data slices. - The method continues at
step 366 where the processing module generates a set of DSN retrieval data addresses based on the data name and on retrieval data storage information. For example, the processing module performs a deterministic function on the data name to produce a retrieval data object number. The processing module may determine, as the retrieval data storage information, dispersed storage error encoding parameters. The method continues atstep 368 where the processing module sends the set of encoded retrieval data slices to the DSN memory for storage therein in accordance with the set of DSN retrieval data addresses. - The processing module may facilitate storage of multiple copies of the set of encoded retrieval data slices. The method continues at
step 370 where the processing module determines to store multiple copies of the set of encoded retrieval data slices. The method continues atstep 372 where the processing module identifies multiple sets of storage units of the DSN memory for storing the multiple copies. The multiple sets of storage units being part of a logical storage vault within the DSN memory, where a first set of storage units of the set of storage units corresponds to a first generation of the DSN memory and a second set of storage units of the set of storage units corresponds to a second generation of the DSN memory. - For each copy of the multiple copies, the method continues at
step 374 where the processing module stores the multiple copies in the identified multiple sets of storage units. For example, the processing module generates a unique set of DSN retrieval data addresses based on the data name, on the retrieval data storage information, and on a corresponding one of the multiple sets of storage units. Next, the processing module sends the set of encoded retrieval data slices to the corresponding one of the multiple sets of storage units for storage therein in accordance with the unique set of DSN retrieval data addresses. - When retrieving the data, the method includes
step 376 where the processing module receives a read request regarding the data, where the read request includes the data name. The method continues atstep 378 where the processing module estimates likely retrieval data storage information (e.g., estimates most probable generations). The estimating the likely retrieval data storage information includes one or more of determining a logical DSN address to physical storage device mapping, determining historical use patterns of the DSN memory, and determining historical storage patterns of a requesting entity that is requesting the read request. - The method continues at
step 380 where the processing module generates likely DSN retrieval data addresses based on the data name and the likely retrieval data storage information. The method continues atstep 382 where the processing module sends read requests to the likely DSN retrieval data addresses. The processing module may receive responses to the read requests. When favorable write responses to the read requests have been received, the method branches to step 390. When the favorable responses to the read requests have not been received, the method continues to step 384. - The method continues at
step 384 where the processing module estimates a second likely retrieval data storage information when the favorable responses to the read requests have not been received. The method continues atstep 386 where the processing module generates second likely DSN retrieval data addresses based on the data name and the second likely retrieval data storage information. The method continues atstep 388 where the processing module sends second read requests to the second likely DSN retrieval data addresses. When the favorable responses to the read requests or second read requests have been received, the method continues atstep 390 where the processing module reconstructs the retrieval data and utilizes the retrieval data to reconstruct the data. - Alternatively, or in addition to, the processing module may attempt to recover the retrieval data from multiple potential storage locations. As a specific example, the processing module estimates the second likely retrieval data storage information and generates the second likely DSN retrieval data addresses based on the data name and the second likely retrieval data storage information. The processing module sends the second read requests to the second likely DSN retrieval data addresses. When the favorable responses to either of the read requests or the second read requests have been received, the processing module reconstructs the retrieval data and utilizes the retrieval data to reconstruct the data.
-
FIG. 41 is a flowchart illustrating an example of updating a dispersed storage network (DSN) address. The method includesstep 400 where a processing module (e.g., of a distributed storage and task (DST) processing unit) determines to adjust a number of generations associated with a data object stored in a dispersed storage network (DSN). The determining may include at least one of determining to add a generation when an amount of data associated with the data is growing and determining to delete a generation when the amount of data associated with the data a shrinking. - The method continues at
step 402 where the processing module identifies a number of generations associated with the data. The identifying includes looking up a current number of generations associated with the data for a write request and estimating a number of generations that existed when the data was written when the access is the read request. The method continues atstep 404 where the processing module generates a generation number based on the number of generations. The generating includes performing a deterministic function on the data identifier and the number of generations to produce the generation number. For example, the processing module obtains at least a portion (e.g., a vault identifier (ID) field entry, an object number field entry) of a dispersed storage network (DSN) address associated with the data, performs a deterministic function on the portion of the DSN address to produce a source name reference, and taking the source name reference modulo the number of generations to produce the generation number. - The method continues at
step 406 where the processing module generates a DSN address using the generation number and based on the data. For example, the processing module utilizes the generation number in a generation field of the DSN address, obtains a data ID, performs a registry lookup to identify the vault ID for a vault ID field of the DSN address based on a accessing entity ID, and obtains an object number for an object number field of the DSN address associated with the data ID (e.g., look up in a directory or a dispersed hierarchical index; generate as a random number when writing the data). The method continues atstep 408 where the processing module identifies a set of storage units based on the DSN address. The identifying includes at least one of performing a DSN address-to-physical address table lookup using the DSN address, initiating a query, and performing a generation-to-storage set table lookup using the generation number. - The method continues at
step 410 where the processing module accesses the set of storage units using the DSN address to retrieve a plurality of sets of encoded data slices associated the data. For example, the processing module generates and sends a plurality of sets of read slice requests to the set of storage units and receive a plurality of at least a decode threshold number of read slice responses for each of the sets of read slice requests. The method continues atstep 412 where the processing module identifies an updated number of generations associated with the data. The identifying includes adding or subtracting a generation based on one or more of a volume of stored data trend, a request, receiving an error message, and detecting a new set of storage units. For example, the processing module determines to add a new generation when detecting the new set of storage units. As another example, the processing module determines to delete a generation when detecting that a current volume of stored data is less than a low store data threshold level. - The method continues at
step 414 where the processing module generates an updated generation number based on the updated number of generations. For example, the processing module performs a deterministic function on a data identifier and the updated number of generations to produce the updated generation number. The method continues atstep 416 where the processing module generates an updated DSN address using the updated generation number and based on the data. The generating includes at least one of obtaining a data identifier, performing a lookup based on a vault identifier, obtaining an object number, and performing a lookup. The lookup may include one or more of accessing a registry, accessing a directory, and accessing a dispersed hierarchical index. The method continues atstep 418 where the processing module identifies another set of storage units based on the updated DSN address. The identifying includes at least one of performing a lookup, initiating a query, and identifying the other set of storage units based on the updated generation number of the updated DSN address. - The method continues at
step 420 where the processing module accesses the other set of storage units using the updated DSN address to store the plurality of sets of encoded data slices associated with the data. The accessing includes issuing one or more sets of write slice requests to the other set of storage units where the requests includes slice names based on the updated DSN address. When the plurality of sets of encoded data slices have been successfully stored, the method continues atstep 422 where the processing module deletes the plurality of sets of encoded data slices from the set of storage units using the DSN address. The deleting includes issuing one or more sets of delete slice requests to the set of storage units that includes slice names based on the DSN address. -
FIG. 42 is a flowchart illustrating an example of accessing an encoded data slice, which includes similar steps toFIG. 41 . The method includesstep 424 where a processing module (e.g., of a distributed storage and task (DST) execution unit) receives a read slice request that includes a slice name, where the slice name includes a generation number. The method continues atstep 426 where the processing module determines whether the generation number is associated with a locally stored encoded data slice. The determining may be based on accessing a local slice list. The method continues withstep 402 ofFIG. 41 where the processing module identifies a number of generations associated with the data. - The method continues at
step 428 where the processing module generates an alternate generation number based on the generation number and the number of generations. The processing module may increment or decrement the generation number based on a comparison of another generation number that is associated with locally stored encoded data slices and perform a deterministic function on the data identifier and the number of generations. The method continues atstep 430 where the processing module generates an alternate slice name using the alternate generation number and the slice name. The generating includes replacing the generation number with the alternate generation number in the slice name to produce the alternate slice name. - The method continues at
step 432 where the processing module identifies another storage unit based on the alternate slice name. The identifying includes accessing a list of storage units associated with a set of generation number is associated with the slice name. The method continues atstep 434 where the processing module retrieves an encoded data slice from the other storage units using the alternate slice name. The retrieving includes issuing a read slice requests to the other storage unit, where the request includes the alternate slice name. The processing module receives the encoded data slice from the other storage unit. The method continues atstep 436 where the processing module outputs the encoded data slice to a requesting entity. Alternatively, or in addition to, the processing module stores the encoded data slice in a local memory and updates slice location information. -
FIGS. 43A , 43C-F are schematic block diagrams of an embodiment of a dispersed storage network (DSN) illustrating an example of time-based storage of data. The DSN includes the distributed storage and task (DST)client module 34 ofFIG. 1 , thenetwork 24 ofFIG. 1 , and the distributed storage and a DST execution (EX)unit set 438. The DST execution unit set 438 includes a set of DST execution units 1-5. Each DST execution unit may be implemented utilizing theDST execution unit 36 ofFIG. 1 . Hereafter, the DST execution unit set 438 may be referred to interchangeably as one or more of DSN memory, a set of storage units, and a storage unit set; and the DST execution unit may be referred to interchangeably as a storage unit. - The
DST client module 34 includes theoutbound DST processing 80 ofFIG. 3 . TheDST client module 34 may further include a dispersed storage (DS) module 441. The DS module 441 may be implemented utilizing a plurality of processing modules. For instance, the plurality of processing modules may include theprocessing module 84 ofFIG. 3 . As a specific example, the plurality of processing module includes a first module, a second module, a third module, and a fourth module. The first through fourth modules may be utilized to implement theoutbound DST processing 80. The DSN functions to time-based store a large data object 442 in the DST execution unit set 438. The large data object 442 may include at least one of a video file, a records file, a collection of images file a documentation file, or any other data object that has a data object size greater than a size threshold level, where the size threshold level is associated with a storage process that has a time to completion of storage that compares unfavorably to a potential change in availability of the DST execution unit set 438. For example, the availability of the DST execution unit set 438 may change during a time frame that the large data object is being stored to the DST execution unit set 438. -
FIG. 43A illustrates initial steps of an example of the storing of the large data object 442, where theoutbound DST processing 80 receives the large data object 442. Having received the large data object 442, theoutbound DST processing 80 encodes the large data object 442 in accordance with a dispersed storage error coding function to produce a plurality of sets of encoded data slices. As a specific example, theoutbound DST processing 80 generates encoded data slice sets 1-M as the plurality of sets of encoded data slices and temporarily stores the encoded data slice sets 1-M in asend queue 440. - Having cached the encoded data slice sets 1-M, the
outbound DST processing 80 obtains estimated future availability information for storage units of the DSN. As a specific example, theoutbound DST processing 80 obtainsavailability information 444 from the DST execution unit set 438. Theavailability information 444 includes one or more of an expected pattern of availability, expected start time of and availability level transition, expected duration of a next availability period, a maintenance schedule, a historical availability record, and an indication of a pending software update. As a specific example, the set of DST execution units 1-5 send, via thenetwork 24, availability information 1-5 as theavailability information 444 to theoutbound DST processing 80. Having received theavailability information 444, theoutbound DST processing 80 interprets theavailability information 444 to produce the estimated future availability information for the storage units. The generation and utilization of the estimated future availability information is discussed in greater detail with reference toFIG. 43B . -
FIG. 43B is a timing diagram illustrating an example of generating a time-availability pattern. The timing diagram includes a mapping of the estimatedfuture availability information 446 versustime 448 and to a time-availability pattern 450. As a specific example, the mapping of the estimatedfuture availability information 446 versustime 444 indicates thatDST execution unit 1 is expected to be available from a current time of t0 until a time of t2, unavailable from t2 to t8 due to a scheduled software update, and available again from t8 to t10. The example mapping also indicates thatDST execution unit 2 is expected to be available from t0 to t5, unavailable from t5 to t8 due to scheduled maintenance, and available from t8 to t10. The example mapping also indicates thatDST execution unit 3 is expected to be available from t0 to t6 and unavailable from t6 to t10 due to a scheduled power shutdown. The example mapping also indicates thatDST execution units - Having obtained the estimated
future availability information 446, theoutbound DST processing 80 ofFIG. 43A organizes the plurality of sets of encoded data slices into a plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices, where a group-set of encoded data slices includes multiple sets of encoded data slices. As a specific example, theoutbound DST processing 80 organizes encoded slice sets 1 through M1 (e.g., of encoded slice sets 1-M) into a first group-set of encoded data slices to be associated with a first write transaction, encoded slice sets M1+1 through M2 into a second group-set of encoded data slices to be associated with a second write transaction, encoded slice sets M2+1 through M3 into a third group-set of encoded data slices to be associated with a third write transaction, and encoded slice sets M3+1 through M into a fourth group-set of encoded data slices to be associated with a fourth write transaction. - For each of the plurality of group-set of encoded data slices, the
outbound DST processing 80 estimates an approximate storage completion time to produce a plurality of approximate storage completion times. The estimating of the approximate storage completion time may be based on one or more of a network performance level of thenetwork 24, a loading level for the DST execution unit set 438, a previous write transaction, a number of encoded data slices of the group-set of encoded data slices, and a size of each of the encoded data slices. As a specific example, theoutbound DST processing 80 estimates that the first group-set of encoded data slices has an approximate storage completion time of a time duration associated with a time from t0 to t2. - Having estimated the approximate storage completion times, the
outbound DST processing 80 obtains a write threshold number. The write threshold number includes a minimum number of available storage units of the set of storage units to facilitate favorable write transactions of each of the group-sets of encoded data slices. The write threshold number is greater than or equal to a decode threshold number and is less than or equal to an information dispersal algorithm (IDA) width, where the decode threshold number and IDA width are associated with the dispersed storage error coding function. The IDA width includes a number of encoded data slices of each set of encoded data slices and the decode threshold number includes a minimum number of encoded data slices required to recover data associated with a set of encoded data slices. - Having obtained the write threshold number, the
outbound DST processing 80 establishes the time-availability pattern 450 for writing the plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices to the storage units based on the estimated future availability information, the plurality of approximate storage completion times, and the write threshold number. The time-availability pattern 450 includes a plurality of time intervals and an availability indication for each of the storage units in each time interval of the plurality of time intervals. The storing of a group-set of the plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices spans at least one time interval of the plurality of time intervals. - As a specific example of the time-
availability pattern 450, theoutbound DST processing 80 establishes the time-availability pattern 450 to include writing the first group-set of encoded data slices during time interval t0-t2 when all five storage units are expected to be available, writing the second group-set of encoded data slices during time interval t2-t5 when four of the five storage units are available and the write threshold number is three, writing the third group-set of encoded data slices during time interval t5-t6 when three of the five storage units are available and the write threshold number is three, performing no writing during time interval t6-t8 when less than the write threshold number of storage units are expected to be available, and writing the fourth-set of encoded data slices during time interval t8-t10 when four of the five storage units are expected to be available and the write threshold number is three. - The time-
availability pattern 450 may further include an indication to send or withhold particular encoded data slices of a given set of encoded data slices based on the estimatedfuture availability information 446. As a specific example, theoutbound DST processing 80 determines to withhold sending encoded data slices toDST execution unit 1 during the timeframe t2-t5 associated with the second write transaction whenDST execution unit 1 is expected to be unavailable. For instance, theoutbound DST processing 80 holds encoded data slices associated withDST execution unit 1 in thesend queue 440 during time interval t2-t8 and sends the held encoded data slices (e.g., unwritten encoded data slices from the second and third write transactions) to theDST execution unit 1 over the time interval t8-t10. -
FIG. 43C illustrates further steps of an example of the storing of the large data object 442, where theoutbound DST processing 80 sends the plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices to at least some of the storage units for storage in accordance with the time-availability pattern 450. The sending includes, for each of the plurality of group-set of encoded data slices, theoutbound DST processing 80 assigning a transaction number (e.g., transaction numbers 1-4 for the four group-sets of encoded data slices) and generating a write request for each available storage unit per the time-availability pattern 450 to produce a set of write requests, where each write request of the set of write requests includes the transaction number. As a specific example, theoutbound DST processing 80 initiates awrite transaction 1 at time t0. For instance, theoutbound DST processing 80 sends, via thenetwork 24, a set of write slice requests 1-1 through 1-5 to DST execution units 1-5, where the set of write slice request includes the first group-set of encoded data slices and thetransaction number 1. - When, sending a given group-set of the plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices, one of the storage units was listed as unavailable, the
outbound DST processing 80 queues sending an encoded data slice of each set of the given group-set of encoded data slices and when the one of the storage units is available and when another given group-set of the plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices is being sent to the storage units, theoutbound DST processing 80 sends the encoded data slice of each set of the given group-set of encoded data slices to the one of the storage units. -
FIG. 43D illustrates further steps of an example of the storing of the large data object 442, where theoutbound DST processing 80 compares, as time passes, actual availability information of the storage units with corresponding time portions of the estimatedfuture availability information 450. As a specific example, theoutbound DST processing 80 re-obtains theavailability information 444 from the DST execution unit set 438 prior to time t2. When the actual availability information does not substantially match the estimatedfuture availability information 450 for the corresponding time portions, theoutbound DST processing 80 adjusts the time-availability pattern 450 based on a difference between the actual availability information and estimated future availability information for the corresponding time portions. For instance, theoutbound DST processing 80 suspends sending of a next group-set of encoded data slices when the actual availability information for a next time frame indicates that less than the write threshold number of storage units are estimated to be available. - Alternatively, or in addition to, when, during the sending a given group-set of the plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices, less than the write threshold number of storage units are available, the
outbound DST processing 80 ceases the sending of the given group-set of the plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices and queues the given group-set of the plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices for sending to the at least some of the storage units when at least the write threshold number of storage units are available. -
FIG. 43E illustrates further steps of an example of the storing of the large data object 442, where theoutbound DST processing 80 initiates awrite transaction 2 at time t2. For instance, theoutbound DST processing 80 sends, via thenetwork 24, a set of write slice requests 2-1 through 2-5 to DST execution units 1-5, where the set of write slice request includes the second group-set of encoded data slices and thetransaction number 2. -
FIG. 43F illustrates further steps of an example of the storing of the large data object 442, where theoutbound DST processing 80 compares further actual availability information of the storage units with corresponding time portions of the estimatedfuture availability information 450. As a specific example, theoutbound DST processing 80 re-obtains theavailability information 444 from the DST execution unit set 438 prior to time t5 and interprets there-obtained availability information 444 to produce the further actual availability information. When the further actual availability information does not substantially match the estimatedfuture availability information 450 for the corresponding time portions, theoutbound DST processing 80 adjusts the time-availability pattern 450 based on a difference between the further actual availability information and estimated future availability information for the corresponding time portions. -
FIG. 43G is a flowchart illustrating an example of time-based storage of data. In particular a method is presented for use in conjunction with one or more functions and features described in conjunction withFIGS. 1-39 and alsoFIGS. 43A-F . The method includesstep 460 where a processing module (e.g., of a distributed storage and task (DST) client module of a dispersed storage network (DSN)) obtains estimated future availability information for storage units of the DSN. For example, the processing module receives the estimated future availability information from the storage units. - The method continues at
step 462 where the processing module organizes a plurality of sets of encoded data slices into a plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices. A group-set of encoded data slices includes multiple sets of encoded data slices. The data is encoded in accordance with a dispersed storage error coding function to produce the plurality of sets of encoded data slices. Dispersal parameters are associated with the dispersed storage error coding function. The dispersal parameters includes one or more of an information dispersal algorithm width (e.g., a number of encoded data slices of each set of encoded data slices), a write threshold number (e.g., a subset number of the IDA width required to successfully write a representation of the set of encoded data slices to the storage units), and a decode threshold number (e.g., a minimum number of encoded data slices of the set of encoded data slices required to recover data represented by the set of encoded data slices). - For each of the plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices, the method continues at
step 464 where the processing module estimates an approximate storage completion time to produce a plurality of approximate storage completion times. The method continues atstep 466 of the processing module obtains the write threshold number (e.g., retrieves from system registry information, receives, determines based on storage requirements and a system performance level). - The method continues at
step 468 where the processing module establishes a time-availability pattern for writing the plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices to the storage units based on the estimated future availability information, the plurality of approximate storage completion times, and the write threshold number. The establishing may include comparing, as time passes, actual availability information of the storage units with corresponding time portions of the estimated future availability information and when the actual availability information does not substantially match the estimated future availability information for the corresponding time portions, adjusting the time-availability pattern based on a difference between the actual availability information and estimated future availability information for the corresponding time portions. - The method continues at
step 470 where the processing module sends the plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices to at least some of the storage units for storage in accordance with the time-availability pattern. The sending includes, for each of the plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices, assigning a transaction number and generating a write request for each available storage unit per the time-availability pattern to produce a set of write requests, where each write request of the set of write requests includes the transaction number. Alternatively, or in addition to, when, for the sending of a given group-set of the plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices, one of the storage units was listed as unavailable, the processing module queues sending an encoded data slice of each set of the given group-set of encoded data slices. When the one of the storage units is available and when another given group-set of the plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices is being sent to the storage units, the processing module sends the encoded data slice of each set of the given group-set of encoded data slices to the one of the storage units. - Alternatively, or in addition to, when, during the sending a given group-set of the plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices, less than the write threshold number of storage units are available, the processing module ceases the sending of the given group-set of the plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices and queues the given group-set of the plurality of group-sets of encoded data slices for sending to the at least some of the storage units when at least the write threshold number of storage units are available.
-
FIG. 44A is a schematic block diagram of another embodiment of a distributed storage and task (DST)execution unit 36 ofFIG. 11 . TheDST execution unit 36 includes aninterface 169, thememory 88, thecontroller 86, a plurality of distributed task (DT)execution modules 90, and a plurality ofDST client modules 34. In an example of operation, thecontroller 86 obtains status of the plurality ofDT execution modules 90 and the plurality ofDST client modules 34. The obtaining includes one or more of issuing atask control message 480 to the plurality ofDT execution modules 90, issuing aDST control message 482 to the plurality ofDST client modules 34, receiving atask control message 480 from one or more of theDT execution modules 90 that includes the status, and receiving aDST control message 482 from one or more of theDST client modules 34 that includes the status. The status includes one or more of processing utilization level information, memory utilization level information, garbage collection logs, error information, and pending activity information. - In an example of operation, the
controller 86 receives a request via theinterface 169, where the request includes at least one of a slice processing request and apartial task 98. Thecontroller 86 identifies a resource type based on the request (e.g., a DT execution module type for thepartial task 98 and a DST client module type for the slice processing request). Thecontroller 86 determines whether the resource type is available based on the status. When the resource type is available, thecontroller 86 selects a particular resource for assignment of the request. For example, thecontroller 86 identifies a thirdDST client module 34 that is most available for the request when the request is the slice processing request. As another example, thecontroller 86 selects a fourthDT execution module 90 when the fourthDT execution module 90 is associated with processing resources capable of executing thepartial task 98 when the request is thepartial task 98. Thecontroller 86 assigns the request to the selected resource. The assigning includes at least one of outputting an assignment task control message to an assignedDT execution module 90 and outputting an assignment DST control message to the assigned DST client module. When the resource type is not available, thecontroller 86 may issue an error response via theinterface 169 to a requesting entity and/or to a managing unit. - The assigned
DT execution module 90 executes the assignedpartial task 98 to producepartial results 102. Alternatively, or in addition to, the assignedDT execution module 90 facilitates thememory 88 to retrieveslices 96 and to output results 104. The assigned aDST client module 34 executes the slice processing request to facilitate producing at least one ofsub-slice groupings 170 and sub-partialpartial tasks 172. Alternatively, or in addition to, theDST client module 34 may facilitate thememory 88 to provideslices 100 and/or two receivesslices 96 for further slice processing. -
FIG. 44B is a flowchart illustrating an example of assigning resources. The method includesstep 484 where a processing module (e.g., of a controller module) obtains resource status information for a plurality of task execution modules and a plurality of dispersed storage modules. The obtaining includes at least one of receiving, issuing a query, performing a lookup, accessing a historical record, and interpreting an activity log. The method continues atstep 486 where the processing module receives a request. The method continues atstep 488 where the processing module identifies a resource type based on the request. For example, the processing module identifies the resource type based on a type of the request. For instance, the processing module identifies a distributed task execution module receiving a partial task requests. In another instance, the processing module identifies a distributed storage and task client module type when receiving a slice processing request. The processing module may identify another resource type for another request type. - The method continues at
step 490 where the processing module determines whether the resource type is available. For example, for each resource, the processing module interprets pending request to produce a predicted loading level and compares the predicted loading level to an upper loading level threshold. The processing module indicates available when the comparison is favorable (e.g., more capacities available than required). The method branches to step 494 when the resource type is available. The method continues to step 492 when the resource type is not available. The method continues atstep 492 where the processing module issues and error response when the resource type is not available. The issuing of the error response includes generating an error message and sending the error message to at least one of a requesting entity and a managing unit. - The method continues at
step 494 where the processing module selects at least one resource of the plurality of task execution modules and the plurality of dispersed storage modules when the resource type is available. For example, the processing module identifies a resource associated with a most favorable comparison of predicted loading to available loading (e.g., most available capacity). The method continues atstep 496 where the processing module assigns the request to the selected at least one resource. For example, the processing module sends the request to the selected resource. -
FIG. 45A is a schematic block diagram of another embodiment of a dispersed storage network (DSN) system that includes the distributed storage and task network (DSTN)module 22 ofFIG. 1 , a set of distributed storage and task (DST) processing units 1-N, where each DST processing unit includes theDST processing unit 16 ofFIG. 1 , and a load-balancingmodule 498. TheDSTN module 22 includes the DST execution unit set 438 ofFIG. 43A . The DST execution unit set 438 includes a set ofDST execution units 36 ofFIG. 1 . - The system functions to store
data 500 as a plurality of sets of encoded data slices 504 in the DST execution unit set 438. The load-balancingmodule 498 selects one of the DST processing units, based on resource status information 502 from the DST processing units, to encode thedata 500 using a dispersed storage error coding function to produce the plurality of sets of encoded data slices 504 for storage in the DST execution unit set 438. The resource status information 502 includes one or more of an indicator of a time frame of availability, an indicator of a time frame of unavailability, a time frame for a scheduled software update, a time frame for a scheduled new hardware addition, an error message, a maintenance schedule, a communications error rate, and a storage error rate. - In an example of operation, a DST processing unit determines to at least temporarily suspend operations. The determining may be based on one or more of adding new software, activating new hardware, recovering from a storage error, recovering from a communications error, receiving a suspend request, and interpreting the maintenance schedule. The DST processing unit continues to perform a slice access activity with regards to pending data access requests associated with the DST processing unit. The load-balancing
module 498 receives a new data access request. The load-balancingmodule 498 determines availability of each of the DST processing units based on one or more of receiving resource status information 502, initiating a query, receiving an error message, and detecting an unfavorable performance (e.g., detecting slow response latency). The load-balancingmodule 498 selects the DST processing unit when the availability (e.g., previously known availability) of the DST processing unit compares favorably to availability of other DST processing units. The load-balancingmodule 498 forwards the data access requests to the DST processing unit. - While suspending operations, the DST processing units indicates the unfavorable performance to the load-balancing module. The indicating unfavorable performance includes at least one of ignoring the request, sending a late unfavorable response, issuing unfavorable resource status information, and ignoring resource status requests from the load-balancing module. The load-balancing
module 498 interprets the indication to determine that the data access request is to be reassigned. The load-balancingmodule 498 un-selects the DST processing unit from the data access assignment. For example, the load-balancing module sends a cancellation message to the DST processing unit and selects another DST processing unit and sends the data access request to the other DST processing unit. -
FIG. 45B is a diagram illustrating an example of load-balancing. The method includesstep 506 where a distributed storage and task (DST) processing unit determines to temporarily suspend operations. The method continues atstep 508 where the DST processing unit continues to execute pending operations. For example, the DST processing unit continues to process previously accepted data access requests. The method continues atstep 510 where a load-balancing module receives a data access request. The method continues atstep 512 where the load-balancing module assesses availability of a set of DST processing units that includes the DST processing unit. The assessing includes producing availability information based on one or more of interpreting performance indicators, receiving resource status information, initiating a query, receiving an error message, and detecting favorable performance. - The method continues at
step 514 where the load-balancing module selects the DST processing unit for execution of the data access request. For example, the load-balancing module selects the DST processing unit when availability of the DST processing unit compares more favorably to availability of other DST processing units. The method continues atstep 516 where the load-balancing module forwards the data access request to the DST processing unit. - The method continues at
step 518 where the DST processing unit indicates unfavorable performance. For example, the DST processing unit ignores the data access requests. As another example, the DST processing unit waits a delay time period before sending a data access response causing the load-balancing module to interpret the data access response as a late data access response associated with unfavorable performance. As yet another example, the DST processing unit delays responses associated with previous accepted data access requests. The method continues atstep 520 where the load-balancing module detects the indicated unfavorable performance. For example, the load-balancing module detects the indicated unfavorable performance when the data access response was not received within a desired response timeframe. - The method continues at
step 522 where the load-balancing module un-selects the DST processing unit for execution of the data access request. The un-selecting includes one or more of sending a cancellation message to the DST processing unit, selecting another DST processing unit for the data access request, and assigning the other DST processing unit the data access request. - The method continues at
step 524 where the DST processing unit determines to resume operations. The determining may be based on one or more of detecting that new software is operational, detecting that new hardware is operational, detecting that an error condition has cleared, and detecting that a level of pending data access requests has fallen below a low data access request threshold level. The method continues atstep 526 where the DST processing unit indicates favorable performance. For example, the DST processing unit generates data access responses in accordance with desired data access response timing. As another example, the DST processing unit responds to all data access requests. As yet another example, the DST processing unit sends favorable resource status information to the load-balancing module. -
FIG. 46A is a schematic block diagram of another embodiment of a distributed storage and task (DST)execution unit 36 that includes the distributed storage and task (DST)client module 34 and one ormore memory devices 88 ofFIG. 3 . Thememory 88 includes a plurality of portions of memory associated with different utilizations. The portions may be physical memory or virtual memory space. The plurality of portions includes one or more portions utilized forslices memory 606, utilized for rebuiltslices memory 608, reserved for rebuiltslices memory 610, andun-utilized memory 612. Theun-utilized memory 612 is associated with available storage capacity, where the available storage capacity may be calculated as a memory size minus memory used for each of the utilized forslices memory 606, memory used for the utilized for rebuiltslices memory 608, and memory used for the reserved for rebuiltslices memory 610. - The
DST execution unit 36 functions to store encoded data slices 600 in the utilized forslices memory 606 and store rebuilt encoded data slices 602 in the utilized for rebuilt slices memory. TheDST client module 34 may obtain the rebuilt encoded data slices by at least one of: receiving the rebuilt encoded data slices and generating the rebuilt encoded data slices by retrieving representations of encoded data slices from a decode threshold number of otherDST execution units 36. When encoded data slices are to be stored, theDST client module 34 determines whether sufficient available storage capacity of the un-utilized memory is available for utilization for slices memory. For instance, the DST client module compares a size of an encoded data slice for storage to the size of the un-utilized memory. The DST client module indicates that storage space is available when the size of the encoded data slice is less than the size of the un-utilized memory. TheDST client module 34 may determine the size of the reserved for rebuilt slices memory based on identifying encoded data slices to be rebuilt. The identifying includes at least one of detecting a slice error and receiving an indication of the slice error. - In an example of operation, the
DST client module 34 identifies a plurality of encoded data slices requiring rebuilding. TheDST client module 34 determines an amount ofreserve memory 610 required for storage of rebuilt slices for the identified plurality of encoded data slices requiring rebuilding. The determining may include exchangingmemory utilization information 604 with at least one other DST execution unit, where the exchanging includes receiving an amount of memory required for an encoded data slice associated with, for example, a slice error. TheDST client module 34 updates the memory utilization information to include the amount of reserve memory required. The memory utilization information includes one or more of size of the utilized for slices memory, size of the utilized for rebuilt slices memory, size of the reserved for rebuilt slices memory, and size of the un-utilized memory. TheDST client module 34 outputs thememory utilization information 604 to one or more of a DST processing unit, a managing unit, and a user device. - The
DST client module 34 obtains rebuilt encoded data slices (e.g., receives, generates) and stores the rebuilt encoded data slices in the utilized for rebuilt encoded data slices memory. Accordingly, the DST client module updates the reserved for rebuilt slices memory by a similar memory size amount as storage of the rebuild encoded data slices (e.g., lowers size of reserved for rebuilt slices memory and raises size for utilized for rebuilt slices memory). The DST client module updates the memory utilization information and may output the updated memory utilization information. -
FIG. 46B-C are diagrams illustrating examples of memory utilization for a series of times frames, where each timeframe indicates an amount of memory utilized for slices, rebuilt slices, reserved for rebuilt slices, unutilized, and a total amount of memory capacity. The total amount of memory capacity remains constant over the time intervals. In particular,FIG. 46 B illustrates examples of thememory utilization 614 for a first set of time intervals T1-5. At T1, stored slices use 300 TB of memory space of a total capacity of 500 TB of memory space leaving 200 TB of unutilized memory space. At T2, 50 TB of slices for rebuilding are detected such that reserved for rebuilding is incremented by 50 TB and unutilized memory space is lowered by 50 TB from 200 TB to 150 TB. At T3, a first 20 TB of rebuilt slices are obtained and stored such that the reserved memory space for rebuilt slices is lowered by 20 TB from 50 TB to 30 TB. At T4, a remaining 30 TB of rebuilt slices are obtained and stored such that the reserve memory space rebuilt slices is lowered by another 30 TB from 30 TB two 0 TB and the rebuilt slices is raised to buy 30 TB from 20 TB to 50 TB. At T5, the rebuilt slices are moved to the memory space for slices thus raising the rebuilt slices by 50 TB from 300 TB to 350 TB. Utilized memory includes thecombination 615 of utilized forslices memory 606, memory used for the utilized for rebuiltslices memory 608, and memory used for the reserved for rebuiltslices memory 610. -
FIG. 46C continues the examples ofmemory utilization 616 for second set of time intervals T6-T10. The example begins at time interval T6 which is equivalent to memory utilization of T5. At T7, 100 TB of new slices are stored thus raising the memory utilization of slices from 350 TB to 450 TB and lowering the unutilized memory space from 150 TB to 50 TB. At T8, 50 TB of slices for rebuilding is detected such that memory space of reserved for rebuilding is incremented by 50 TB from zero to 50 TB and memory space of unutilized is lowered by 50 TB from 50 TB two 0 TB. Requests for storage of new slices are rejected since the memory space of the unutilized memory is zero. At T9, 50 TB of rebuilt slices are received and stored in the memory space of the rebuilt slices thus raising the rebuilt slices from 0 TB to 50 TB and lowering the memory space for rebuilt slices from 50 TB to 0 TB. At T10, the slices of the memory space rebuilt slices is considered part of the memory space of slices thus raising the memory space of the slices from 450 TB to 500 TB and lowering the memory space of the rebuilt slices from 50 TB to 0 TB. As such, the memory storage space is full and subsequent request for storage of slices or rebuilt slices shall be rejected. -
FIG. 46D is a flowchart illustrating an example of updating memory utilization information. The method begins atstep 618 where a processing module (e.g., of a distributed storage and task (DST) client module) identifies a plurality of encoded data slices requiring rebuilding. As further delineated inFIG. 46E (flowchart illustrating example ways to identify slices needing a rebuild), the identifying includes at least one of: receiving an error message 632 (e.g., no slices detected for rebuild, no access to rebuild information, not enough space to rebuild, etc.); receiving a rebuilding request 634 (e.g., to rebuild specific data slices or range of data slices); detecting missing or corrupted encoded data slices by comparing a list of locally stored encoded data slices (or range of slices) to a list of remotely stored encoded data slices (or range of slices) associated with the locally stored encoded data slices to identify missing slices or detecting unfavorable slice integrity (e.g., corrupted slices); monitoring downloads 638 to the DS memory meeting minimum read/write (R/W) width thresholds but less than a full pillar width (successful download, but not all slices above threshold successfully downloaded); determining 640 when DSN read/write (R/W) requests occur for the plurality of encoded data slices and comparing to known times of inaccessibility for the DS memory storing the plurality of encoded data slices (e.g., DS memory was down for maintenance when original slice R/W request occurred); and querying vaults related to the plurality of encoded data slices 641 to determine one or more missing or corrupted encoded data slices (e.g., other vaults sharing the same data slices may have a list or copies which include the missing or corrupted data slices). - The rebuilding of the plurality of encoded data slices is, in one embodiment, queued for at least one of individual, group, or batch processing and the processing will be performed at a significant time delay from the queuing. As the rebuild processing may occur in the future, the embodiments of
FIGS. 46A-G , ensure that memory space is set aside for rebuilds such that interceding requests for memory slice storage will not over utilize memory needed for the rebuild before it has a chance to occur. - The method continues at the
step 620 where the processing module determines an amount of memory space to reserve for the plurality of encoded data slices requiring rebuilding. The determining includes identifying slice sizes based on at least one of initiating a slice size query with regards to the remotely stored encoded data slices, receiving a query response, and performing a local lookup based on a slice name. - The method continues at
step 622 where the processing module updates memory utilization information to include the amount of memory space to reserve. For example, the processing module increments an amount of memory reserved for rebuilt slices by the amount of memory space to reserve and decrements unutilized memory space by the amount of memory space to reserve. The method continues atstep 624 where the processing module sends the memory utilization information to at least one of a storing entity and a managing unit. The sending may further include determining whether a sum of an amount of memory utilized for slices, an amount of memory utilize for rebuilt slices, and an amount of memory reserved for rebuilt slices is greater than a capacity of memory. When the sum is greater, the processing module may further send an indication that the memory is full. - The method continues at
step 626 where the processing module obtains rebuilt encoded data slices (e.g., received, generate). The method continues atstep 628 where the processing module stores the rebuilt encoded data slices in a local DS memory. The method continues atstep 630 where the processing module updates the amount of memory space to reserve for remaining encoded data slices requiring rebuilding. The updating includes determining an amount of memory space utilized to store the obtained rebuilt encoded data slices, incrementing the amount of memory space utilized for rebuilt slices by the amount of memory space utilized to store the obtained rebuilt encoded data slices, and decrementing the amount of memory space reserved for rebuilt slices by the amount of memory space utilized to store the obtained rebuilt encoded data slices. The updating may further include updating the memory space utilized for slices to include the amount of memory space utilized to store the obtained rebuilt encoded data slices and decrementing the amount of memory space utilized to store the rebuild encoded data slices. The method loops back to the step where the processing module updates the memory utilization information. -
FIG. 46F is a flowchart illustrating another example of updating memory utilization information. The method begins atstep 642 where a processing module (e.g., DST integrity processing unit 20) attempts to retrieve a plurality of encoded data slices from a DS memory to perform an integrity check. Slices are retrieved based on any of: list(s) of slice addresses, list(s) of names, range(s) of slice addresses and range(s) of slice names. Instep 644, it is determined if the encoded data slices were retrieved during the attempted retrieval. Instep 646, for encoded data slices that were not received and/or not listed, they are flagged as missing slices. For retrieved encoded data slices, they are checked for errors due to data corruption, outdated version, etc. Instep 648, if a slice includes an error, it is flagged as a ‘bad’ slice. Bad and/or missing slices are subsequently rebuilt using other retrieved encoded data slices that are deemed to be good slices to produce rebuilt slices. - The rebuilding of the plurality of encoded data slices is, in one embodiment, queued for at least one of individual, group, or batch processing and the processing will be performed at a significant time delay from the queuing. As the rebuild processing may occur in the future, the embodiments of
FIGS. 47A-G , ensure that memory space is set aside for rebuilds such that interceding requests for memory slice storage will not over utilize memory needed for the rebuild before it has a chance to occur. - The method continues at the
step 650 where the processing module determines an amount of memory space to reserve for the plurality of encoded data slices requiring rebuilding. The determining includes identifying slice sizes based on at least one of initiating a slice size query with regards to the remotely stored encoded data slices, receiving a query response, and performing a local lookup based on a slice name. - The method continues at
step 652 where the processing module updates memory utilization information to include the amount of memory space to reserve. For example, the processing module increments an amount of memory reserved for rebuilt slices by the amount of memory space to reserve and decrements unutilized memory space by the amount of memory space to reserve. The method continues atstep 653 where the processing module sends the memory utilization information to at least one of a storing entity (e.g., storage/vault peers), user units and a managing unit. The sending may further include determining whether a sum of an amount of memory utilized for slices, an amount of memory utilize for rebuilt slices, and an amount of memory reserved for rebuilt slices is greater than a capacity of memory. When the sum is greater, the processing module may further send an indication that the memory is full. - The method continues at
step 654 where the processing module obtains rebuilt encoded data slices (e.g., received, generated) and stores, instep 656, the rebuilt encoded data slices in a local DS memory. The method continues atstep 657 where the processing module updates the amount of memory space to reserve for remaining encoded data slices requiring rebuilding. The updating includes determining an amount of memory space utilized to store the obtained rebuilt encoded data slices, incrementing the amount of memory space utilized for rebuilt slices by the amount of memory space utilized to store the obtained rebuilt encoded data slices, and decrementing the amount of memory space reserved for rebuilt slices by the amount of memory space utilized to store the obtained rebuilt encoded data slices. The updating may further include updating the memory space utilized for slices to include the amount of memory space utilized to store the obtained rebuilt encoded data slices and decrementing the amount of memory space utilized to store the rebuild encoded data slices. -
FIG. 46G is a schematic block diagram illustrating an exampleDST client module 34 structure for memory utilization.DST client module 34 may include a plurality of processing modules (or sub-modules) to perform one or more steps of the embodiments ofFIGS. 46A-F . While this example is shown as seven separate modules, the modules may be combined/separated into any number of modules (local or remote) to complete the various steps and functions of the various embodiments ofFIGS. 46A-F . - As shown, identify module 34-1 identifies a plurality of encoded data slices that require rebuilding, wherein rebuilding of the plurality of encoded data slices is queued for at least one of individual, group, or batch processing and the processing will be performed at a significant time delay from the queuing. Determine module 34-2 determines an amount of memory required for storage of the rebuild encoded data slices for the plurality of encoded data slices. Update module 34-3 updates utilization information of the memory by allocating a portion of available memory to the amount of memory required. Indicate module 34-4 indicates the memory utilization (e.g., by sending the updated
utilization information 604 of the memory to at least one of a storing entity (e.g., other storage/vault peers) and a managing unit). Obtain module 34-5 obtains rebuilt data slices (e.g., from other good copies or related vaults or generates them from other encoded data slices). Store module 34-6 stores the rebuilt encoded data slices in the reserve memory; and modify module 34-7 modifies the utilization information to reflect the stored rebuilt encoded data slices. Additional modules may be included withinDST client module 34 to perform additional tasks (for example, but not limited to, passing encoded data slices to/from slice memory during non-rebuild write/read (W/R) operations). Alternatively, obtain module 34-5 and store module 34-6 may perform the receive and store slices 600 tasks, respectively. -
FIG. 47A is a schematic block diagram of another embodiment of a dispersed storage network (DSN) system that includes the disbursing storage and task (DST)processing unit 16 and the distributed storage and task network (DSTN)module 22 ofFIG. 1 . TheDSTN module 22 includes at least two DST execution unit sets 1-2. Each DST execution unit set includes a set ofDST execution units 36 ofFIG. 1 . The system functions to store at least two data objects in a common DST execution unit set. - In an example of operation, the
DST processing unit 16 receives adata object 1write request 700. TheDST processing unit 16 encodesdata object 1 using a dispersed storage error coding function to produce first sets (data object 1) of encoded data slices 700-1, 2, . . . n (where n equals the width (number of pillars) of the encoded data slice set). TheDST processing unit 16 generates first sets of slice names for the first sets of encoded data slices. TheDST processing unit 16 issues one or more sets of data object 1 write slice requests to a DST execution unit set 1 that includes the first sets of encoded data slices and the corresponding first sets of slice names, where the first sets of slice names fall within a range of slice names associated with the DSTexecution unit set 1. - With data object 1 stored in the first set of
DST execution units 36, theDST processing unit 16 receives adata object 2co-locate write request 702 with regards to storing a second data object in the same set ofDST execution units 36 as the first data object (e.g., in the DST execution unit set 1). The data object 2 co-locate write request includes a data identifier (ID) of the data object to be co-located with (e.g., a data ID of the data object 1), a data ID of the second data object (e.g., the data object 2 to be co-located), and may include the data (e.g., data object 2) to be co-located when it is not already stored within theDSTN module 22. - When the data object to be co-located (e.g., the second data object) is included in the data object 2 co-locate write request, the
DST processing unit 16 identifies the set ofDST execution units 36 associated with the data ID of data object 1 to be co-located with (e.g., the DST execution unit set 1). The determining includes accessing one or more of a directory and a dispersed hierarchical index to identify a DSN address associated with the data ID of data object 1 to be co-located with and performing a DSN address-to-physical location table lookup to identify the set ofDST execution units 36 associated with the data ID of data object 1 to be co-located with. Next, the DST processing unit encodes the second data object (data object 2) to produce second sets of encoded data slices for storage in the DSTexecution unit set 1. TheDST processing unit 16 generates second sets of slice names for the second sets of encoded data slices, where the second sets of slice names are based on the first sets of slice names such that the second sets of slice names fall within a range of slice names associated with a range of slice names associated with the set ofDST execution units 36 associated with the data ID of data object 1 to be co-located with.DST processing unit 16 issues data object 2 write slice requests to the set ofDST execution units 36 associated with the data ID of the data object to be co-located with (e.g., to DST execution unit set 1), where the data object 2 write slice requests includes the second sets of encoded data slices. - When the data object to be co-located is not included in the data object 2 co-locate write request, the
DST processing unit 16 determines whether the data object to be co-located is already co-located. The determining includes theDST processing unit 16 identifying the DST execution unit set associated with storage of the second data object and comparing the identity to the identity of the DST execution unit set associated with storage of the first data object. When data object 2 to be co-located is not already co-located (e.g., with data object 1), theDST processing unit 16 recovers data object 2 from the DST execution unit set associated with storage of the second data object (e.g., from DST execution unit set 2). The recovering includes issuingdata object 2read slice requests 704 to the DST execution unit set associated with storage of the second data object and receiving the second sets of encoded data slices (e.g., received from DST execution unit set 2). Next, theDST processing unit 16 issues the data object 2 write slice requests to the set ofDST execution units 36 associated with the data ID of the data object 1 to be co-located with (e.g., to DST execution unit set 1), where the data object 2 write slice requests includes the received second sets of encoded data slices and the corresponding second sets of slice names. -
FIG. 47B is a diagram illustrating an example of generating an updated slice name for a previously stored encoded data slice of a second data object to be co-located with one or more encoded data slices of a first data object. Theslice name 706 has a structure that includes aslice index field 708, a vault identifier (ID)field 710, ageneration field 712, anobject number field 714, and asegment number field 716. A substantial number of the fields of the slice name structure of a slice name of the previously stored encoded data slice of the second data object are updated to be substantially aligned with corresponding fields of the slice name structure of a slice name of the one or more encoded data slices of the first data object. For example, a vault ID field entry of theprevious data object 2slice 1 is updated to be substantially the same as a vault ID field entry of data object 1slice 1. As another example, an object number field entry of theprevious data object 2slice 1 is updated based on an object number field entry of theprevious data object 2slice 1 such that the slice name of the updateddata object 2slice 1 falls within a range of slice names associated with storage of the first data object. -
FIG. 47C is a flowchart illustrating an example of co-locating storage of data objects. The method begins atstep 718 where a processing module (e.g., a distributed storage and task (DST) processing unit) receives adata object 2 co-locate write request to co-locate adata object 2 with adata object 1 to be co-located with. The write request includes one or more of data identifiers (IDs) for the data object 2 to be co-located and the data object 1 to be co-located with. The method continues atstep 720 where the processing module obtains a plurality of sets of encoded data slices for the data object 2 to co-locate. The obtaining includes one of receiving, generating, and retrieving. When receiving, the processing module extracts the plurality of sets of encoded data slices from thewrite request 700. When generating, the processing module encodes the data object 2 be co-located using a dispersed storage error coding function to produce the plurality of sets of encoded data slices. When retrieving, the processing module identifies previous sets of slice names utilized to store the plurality of sets of encoded data slices based on a data ID of the data object 2 to become co-located, issues one or more sets of read slice requests to a previously utilized set of storage units where the one or more sets of read slice requests includes the previous sets of slice names, and receiving the plurality of sets of encoded data slices 704. - The method continues at the
step 722 where the processing module generates a plurality of sets of slice names for the plurality of sets of encoded data slices based on addressing information of the data object 1 to be co-located with. For example, the processing module generates the plurality of sets of slice names to include a vault ID associated with the data object to be co-located with and an object number field entry that causes the generated plurality of sets of slice names to fall within a slice name range that is associated with a set of storage units where the data object to be co-located with is stored. - The method continues at the
step 724 where the processing module stores the plurality of sets of encoded data slices in the set of storage units using the generated plurality of sets of slice names. The storing includes generating one or more sets of write slice requests that includes the plurality of sets of encoded data slices and the generated plurality of sets of slice names and outputting the one or more sets of read slice requests to the set of storage units. When storage of the plurality of sets of encoded data slices in the set of storage units is confirmed, and when the plurality of sets of encoded data slices were retrieved using the previous sets of slice names, the method continues at thestep 726 where the processing module deletes the plurality of sets of encoded data slices utilizing the previous sets of slice names. For example, the processing module issues a set of delete slice requests that includes the previous sets of slice names to the previous utilized set of storage units. -
FIG. 47D is a flowchart illustrating one example of obtaining the plurality of sets of encoded data slices to be co-located. The obtaining,step 720, includes multiple processing paths for receiving, generating, and retrieving the plurality of sets of encoded data slices to be co-located (data object 2) based on the location of data object 2 at the time of the request. When receiving, the processing module extracts instep 727 the ID ofdata object 1, ID ofdata object 2 and, if included with the request, the plurality of data object 2 sets of encoded slices from thewrite request 700. When data object 2 to be co-located (e.g., the second data object) is included in the data object 2 co-locate write request, theDST processing unit 16 identifies, beginning withstep 730, the set ofDST execution units 36 associated withdata ID 1 of the data object to be co-located with (e.g., the DST execution unit set 1). The determining includes accessing one or more of a directory instep 731 and a dispersed hierarchical index instep 732 to identify a DSN address associated with data object 1 ID to be co-located with and performing a DSN address-to-physical location table lookup instep 734 to identify the physical location (PL) address set ofDST execution units 36 associated with the data ID of the data object to be co-located with. If data object 2 is not already encoded, it is encoded instep 729 using a dispersed storage error coding function. - When the data object to be co-located is not included in the data object 2 co-locate write request, the
DST processing unit 16 determines whether the data object to be co-located is already co-located. The determining includes comparingdata object 2 PL todata object 1 PL. If they are co-located (data object 2 PL is stored within a range of addresses for data object 1 PL) no further action is required. When data object 2 to be co-located is not already co-located, theDST processing unit 16 recovers (reads), instep 736, the second data object from the DST execution unit set associated with storage of the second data object (e.g., from DST execution unit set 2). -
FIG. 47E is a schematic block diagram of another embodiment of a dispersed storage network (DSN) system in accordance with the present disclosure.DST processing unit 16 may include a plurality of processing modules (or sub-modules) to perform one or more steps of the embodiments ofFIGS. 47A-D . While this example is shown as four separate modules, the modules may be combined or separated into any number of modules (local or remote) to complete the various steps and functions of the various embodiments ofFIGS. 47A-D . - As shown, receive module 16-1 operates to receive a data object co-locate write request. Obtain module 16-2 operates to obtain a plurality of sets of encoded data slices for a data object to co-locate. Generate module 16-3 operates to generate a plurality of sets of slice names for the data object to co-locate based on another plurality of sets of slice names associated with a data object to be co-located with. Store module 16-4 operates to store the plurality of sets of encoded data slices in DS memory using the generated plurality of sets of slice names for the data object co-locate.
- As may be used herein, the terms “substantially” and “approximately” provides an industry-accepted tolerance for its corresponding term and/or relativity between items. Such an industry-accepted tolerance ranges from less than one percent to fifty percent and corresponds to, but is not limited to, component values, integrated circuit process variations, temperature variations, rise and fall times, and/or thermal noise. Such relativity between items ranges from a difference of a few percent to magnitude differences. As may also be used herein, the term(s) “operably coupled to”, “coupled to”, and/or “coupling” includes direct coupling between items and/or indirect coupling between items via an intervening item (e.g., an item includes, but is not limited to, a component, an element, a circuit, and/or a module) where, for indirect coupling, the intervening item does not modify the information of a signal but may adjust its current level, voltage level, and/or power level. As may further be used herein, inferred coupling (i.e., where one element is coupled to another element by inference) includes direct and indirect coupling between two items in the same manner as “coupled to”. As may even further be used herein, the term “operable to” or “operably coupled to” indicates that an item includes one or more of power connections, input(s), output(s), etc., to perform, when activated, one or more its corresponding functions and may further include inferred coupling to one or more other items. As may still further be used herein, the term “associated with”, includes direct and/or indirect coupling of separate items and/or one item being embedded within another item. As may be used herein, the term “compares favorably”, indicates that a comparison between two or more items, signals, etc., provides a desired relationship. For example, when the desired relationship is that
signal 1 has a greater magnitude thansignal 2, a favorable comparison may be achieved when the magnitude ofsignal 1 is greater than that ofsignal 2 or when the magnitude ofsignal 2 is less than that ofsignal 1. - As may also be used herein, the terms “processing module”, “processing circuit”, and/or “processing unit” may be a single processing device or a plurality of processing devices. Such a processing device may be a microprocessor, micro-controller, digital signal processor, microcomputer, central processing unit, field programmable gate array, programmable logic device, state machine, logic circuitry, analog circuitry, digital circuitry, and/or any device that manipulates signals (analog and/or digital) based on hard coding of the circuitry and/or operational instructions. The processing module, module, processing circuit, and/or processing unit may be, or further include, memory and/or an integrated memory element, which may be a single memory device, a plurality of memory devices, and/or embedded circuitry of another processing module, module, processing circuit, and/or processing unit. Such a memory device may be a read-only memory, random access memory, volatile memory, non-volatile memory, static memory, dynamic memory, flash memory, cache memory, and/or any device that stores digital information. Note that if the processing module, module, processing circuit, and/or processing unit includes more than one processing device, the processing devices may be centrally located (e.g., directly coupled together via a wired and/or wireless bus structure) or may be distributedly located (e.g., cloud computing via indirect coupling via a local area network and/or a wide area network). Further note that if the processing module, module, processing circuit, and/or processing unit implements one or more of its functions via a state machine, analog circuitry, digital circuitry, and/or logic circuitry, the memory and/or memory element storing the corresponding operational instructions may be embedded within, or external to, the circuitry comprising the state machine, analog circuitry, digital circuitry, and/or logic circuitry. Still further note that, the memory element may store, and the processing module, module, processing circuit, and/or processing unit executes, hard coded and/or operational instructions corresponding to at least some of the steps and/or functions illustrated in one or more of the Figures. Such a memory device or memory element can be included in an article of manufacture.
- The present disclosure has been described above with the aid of method steps illustrating the performance of specified functions and relationships thereof. The boundaries and sequence of these functional building blocks and method steps have been arbitrarily defined herein for convenience of description. Alternate boundaries and sequences can be defined so long as the specified functions and relationships are appropriately performed. Any such alternate boundaries or sequences are thus within the scope and spirit of the claimed disclosure. Further, the boundaries of these functional building blocks have been arbitrarily defined for convenience of description. Alternate boundaries could be defined as long as the certain significant functions are appropriately performed. Similarly, flow diagram blocks may also have been arbitrarily defined herein to illustrate certain significant functionality. To the extent used, the flow diagram block boundaries and sequence could have been defined otherwise and still perform the certain significant functionality. Such alternate definitions of both functional building blocks and flow diagram blocks and sequences are thus within the scope and spirit of the claimed disclosure. One of average skill in the art will also recognize that the functional building blocks, and other illustrative blocks, modules and components herein, can be implemented as illustrated or by discrete components, application specific integrated circuits, processors executing appropriate software and the like or any combination thereof.
- The present disclosure may have also been described, at least in part, in terms of one or more embodiments. An embodiment of the present disclosure is used herein to illustrate the present disclosure, an aspect thereof, a feature thereof, a concept thereof, and/or an example thereof. A physical embodiment of an apparatus, an article of manufacture, a machine, and/or of a process that embodies the present disclosure may include one or more of the aspects, features, concepts, examples, etc. described with reference to one or more of the embodiments discussed herein. Further, from figure to figure, the embodiments may incorporate the same or similarly named functions, steps, modules, etc. that may use the same or different reference numbers and, as such, the functions, steps, modules, etc. may be the same or similar functions, steps, modules, etc. or different ones.
- While the transistors in the above described figure(s) is/are shown as field effect transistors (FETs), as one of ordinary skill in the art will appreciate, the transistors may be implemented using any type of transistor structure including, but not limited to, bipolar, metal oxide semiconductor field effect transistors (MOSFET), N-well transistors, P-well transistors, enhancement mode, depletion mode, and zero voltage threshold (VT) transistors.
- Unless specifically stated to the contra, signals to, from, and/or between elements in a figure of any of the figures presented herein may be analog or digital, continuous time or discrete time, and single-ended or differential. For instance, if a signal path is shown as a single-ended path, it also represents a differential signal path. Similarly, if a signal path is shown as a differential path, it also represents a single-ended signal path. While one or more particular architectures are described herein, other architectures can likewise be implemented that use one or more data buses not expressly shown, direct connectivity between elements, and/or indirect coupling between other elements as recognized by one of average skill in the art.
- The term “module” is used in the description of the various embodiments of the present disclosure. A module includes a processing module, a functional block, hardware, and/or software stored on memory for performing one or more functions as may be described herein. Note that, if the module is implemented via hardware, the hardware may operate independently and/or in conjunction software and/or firmware. As used herein, a module may contain one or more sub-modules, each of which may be one or more modules.
- While particular combinations of various functions and features of the present disclosure have been expressly described herein, other combinations of these features and functions are likewise possible. The present disclosure is not limited by the particular examples disclosed herein and expressly incorporates these other combinations.
Claims (20)
Priority Applications (1)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US14/292,662 US20150039660A1 (en) | 2013-07-31 | 2014-05-30 | Co-locate objects request |
Applications Claiming Priority (2)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US201361860498P | 2013-07-31 | 2013-07-31 | |
US14/292,662 US20150039660A1 (en) | 2013-07-31 | 2014-05-30 | Co-locate objects request |
Publications (1)
Publication Number | Publication Date |
---|---|
US20150039660A1 true US20150039660A1 (en) | 2015-02-05 |
Family
ID=52428661
Family Applications (6)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US14/292,662 Abandoned US20150039660A1 (en) | 2013-07-31 | 2014-05-30 | Co-locate objects request |
US14/292,009 Active 2034-10-07 US9626125B2 (en) | 2013-07-31 | 2014-05-30 | Accounting for data that needs to be rebuilt or deleted |
US14/307,672 Expired - Fee Related US9639298B2 (en) | 2013-07-31 | 2014-06-18 | Time-based storage within a dispersed storage network |
US14/307,625 Active 2034-08-24 US9495118B2 (en) | 2013-07-31 | 2014-06-18 | Storing data in a directory-less dispersed storage network |
US15/345,172 Expired - Fee Related US9927976B2 (en) | 2013-07-31 | 2016-11-07 | Storing data in a directory-less dispersed storage network |
US15/415,236 Expired - Fee Related US10359935B2 (en) | 2013-07-31 | 2017-01-25 | Dispersed storage encoded data slice rebuild |
Family Applications After (5)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US14/292,009 Active 2034-10-07 US9626125B2 (en) | 2013-07-31 | 2014-05-30 | Accounting for data that needs to be rebuilt or deleted |
US14/307,672 Expired - Fee Related US9639298B2 (en) | 2013-07-31 | 2014-06-18 | Time-based storage within a dispersed storage network |
US14/307,625 Active 2034-08-24 US9495118B2 (en) | 2013-07-31 | 2014-06-18 | Storing data in a directory-less dispersed storage network |
US15/345,172 Expired - Fee Related US9927976B2 (en) | 2013-07-31 | 2016-11-07 | Storing data in a directory-less dispersed storage network |
US15/415,236 Expired - Fee Related US10359935B2 (en) | 2013-07-31 | 2017-01-25 | Dispersed storage encoded data slice rebuild |
Country Status (1)
Country | Link |
---|---|
US (6) | US20150039660A1 (en) |
Cited By (8)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US20160306829A1 (en) * | 2014-09-16 | 2016-10-20 | Commvault Systems, Inc. | Fast deduplication data verification |
US20180121132A1 (en) * | 2016-10-31 | 2018-05-03 | International Business Machines Corporation | Managing storage resources in a dispersed storage network |
US20180285370A1 (en) * | 2017-03-30 | 2018-10-04 | International Business Machines Corporation | Dynamically managing a high speed storage tier of a data storage system |
US10135757B2 (en) * | 2015-03-20 | 2018-11-20 | International Business Machines Corporation | Inquiry-based adaptive prediction |
US10248505B2 (en) * | 2016-02-29 | 2019-04-02 | International Business Machines Corporation | Issue escalation by management unit |
US10324657B2 (en) * | 2015-05-29 | 2019-06-18 | International Business Machines Corporation | Accounting for data whose rebuilding is deferred |
US10572348B2 (en) | 2015-04-14 | 2020-02-25 | Commvault Systems, Inc. | Efficient deduplication database validation |
US11294871B2 (en) | 2019-07-19 | 2022-04-05 | Commvault Systems, Inc. | Deduplication system without reference counting |
Families Citing this family (29)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US11474903B1 (en) * | 2005-09-30 | 2022-10-18 | Pure Storage, Inc. | Rebuilding of encoded data slices using locally decodable code segments |
US20180074858A1 (en) * | 2011-12-12 | 2018-03-15 | International Business Machines Corporation | Multi-layer distribution of a computing task in a dispersed storage network |
US10146621B2 (en) * | 2011-12-12 | 2018-12-04 | International Business Machines Corporation | Chaining computes in a distributed computing system |
US9817701B2 (en) * | 2011-12-12 | 2017-11-14 | International Business Machines Corporation | Threshold computing in a distributed computing system |
US10664360B2 (en) * | 2013-02-05 | 2020-05-26 | Pure Storage, Inc. | Identifying additional resources to accelerate rebuildling |
US20180188964A1 (en) * | 2013-07-31 | 2018-07-05 | International Business Machines Corporation | Managed storage unit shutdown in a distributed storage network |
US9933980B2 (en) * | 2014-02-24 | 2018-04-03 | Toshiba Memory Corporation | NAND raid controller for connection between an SSD controller and multiple non-volatile storage units |
US20190087599A1 (en) | 2014-04-02 | 2019-03-21 | International Business Machines Corporation | Compressing a slice name listing in a dispersed storage network |
WO2016144291A1 (en) * | 2015-03-06 | 2016-09-15 | Hewlett Packard Enterprise Development Lp | Data write to subset of memory devices |
US9959306B2 (en) | 2015-06-12 | 2018-05-01 | International Business Machines Corporation | Partition-based index management in hadoop-like data stores |
US10101913B2 (en) * | 2015-09-02 | 2018-10-16 | Commvault Systems, Inc. | Migrating data to disk without interrupting running backup operations |
US9678824B2 (en) | 2015-11-05 | 2017-06-13 | International Business Machines Corporation | Durability and availability evaluation for distributed storage systems |
CN107766262B (en) * | 2016-08-18 | 2021-09-14 | 北京忆恒创源科技股份有限公司 | Method and device for adjusting number of concurrent write commands |
US10579309B2 (en) * | 2017-02-16 | 2020-03-03 | International Business Machines Corporation | Method for increasing throughput in a distributed storage network |
US10509699B2 (en) * | 2017-08-07 | 2019-12-17 | International Business Machines Corporation | Zone aware request scheduling and data placement |
US10684916B2 (en) * | 2018-08-27 | 2020-06-16 | International Business Machines Corporation | Data set allocation technique to preserve deleted data sets |
CN109947589B (en) * | 2019-03-05 | 2023-02-17 | 深圳市得一微电子有限责任公司 | Approximate data storage method in flash memory |
CN113918578B (en) * | 2020-07-10 | 2024-05-24 | 成都秦川物联网科技股份有限公司 | Method for storing power-down data of intelligent gas meter of Internet of things in full-order mode |
CN114063883B (en) * | 2020-07-31 | 2024-08-23 | 伊姆西Ip控股有限责任公司 | Data storage method, electronic device and computer program product |
US11561722B2 (en) * | 2020-08-25 | 2023-01-24 | Micron Technology, Inc. | Multi-page parity data storage in a memory device |
US11372579B2 (en) * | 2020-10-22 | 2022-06-28 | EMC IP Holding Company LLC | Techniques for generating data sets with specified compression and deduplication ratios |
GB202019527D0 (en) * | 2020-12-10 | 2021-01-27 | Imagination Tech Ltd | Processing tasks in a processing system |
US12099742B2 (en) * | 2021-03-15 | 2024-09-24 | Pure Storage, Inc. | Utilizing programming page size granularity to optimize data segment storage in a storage system |
US11789617B2 (en) * | 2021-06-29 | 2023-10-17 | Acronis International Gmbh | Integration of hashgraph and erasure coding for data integrity |
US11922047B2 (en) * | 2021-09-16 | 2024-03-05 | EMC IP Holding Company LLC | Using RPO as an optimization target for DataDomain garbage collection |
US20230136274A1 (en) * | 2021-11-04 | 2023-05-04 | Softiron Limited | Ceph Media Failure and Remediation |
US12019899B2 (en) * | 2022-03-03 | 2024-06-25 | Western Digital Technologies, Inc. | Data relocation with protection for open relocation destination blocks |
US20240143512A1 (en) * | 2022-11-01 | 2024-05-02 | Western Digital Technologies, Inc. | Write buffer linking for easy cache reads |
US20240295981A1 (en) * | 2023-03-03 | 2024-09-05 | Western Digital Technologies, Inc. | Data Storage Device and Method for Host-Assisted Efficient Handling of Multiple Versions of Data |
Citations (4)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US6976103B1 (en) * | 2000-03-03 | 2005-12-13 | Hitachi, Ltd. | Data migration method using storage area network |
US20090089428A1 (en) * | 2007-09-28 | 2009-04-02 | International Business Machines Corporation | Reducing overhead in component interactions |
US20110289122A1 (en) * | 2010-05-19 | 2011-11-24 | Cleversafe, Inc. | Rebuilding data in multiple dispersed storage networks |
US20120054225A1 (en) * | 2010-08-30 | 2012-03-01 | Oracle International Corporation | Query and Exadata Support for Hybrid Columnar Compressed Data |
Family Cites Families (90)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US4092732A (en) | 1977-05-31 | 1978-05-30 | International Business Machines Corporation | System for recovering data stored in failed memory unit |
US5485474A (en) | 1988-02-25 | 1996-01-16 | The President And Fellows Of Harvard College | Scheme for information dispersal and reconstruction |
US5454101A (en) | 1992-09-15 | 1995-09-26 | Universal Firmware Industries, Ltd. | Data storage system with set lists which contain elements associated with parents for defining a logical hierarchy and general record pointers identifying specific data sets |
US5987622A (en) | 1993-12-10 | 1999-11-16 | Tm Patents, Lp | Parallel computer system including parallel storage subsystem including facility for correction of data in the event of failure of a storage device in parallel storage subsystem |
US6175571B1 (en) | 1994-07-22 | 2001-01-16 | Network Peripherals, Inc. | Distributed memory switching hub |
US5848230A (en) | 1995-05-25 | 1998-12-08 | Tandem Computers Incorporated | Continuously available computer memory systems |
US5774643A (en) | 1995-10-13 | 1998-06-30 | Digital Equipment Corporation | Enhanced raid write hole protection and recovery |
US5809285A (en) | 1995-12-21 | 1998-09-15 | Compaq Computer Corporation | Computer system having a virtual drive array controller |
US6012159A (en) | 1996-01-17 | 2000-01-04 | Kencast, Inc. | Method and system for error-free data transfer |
US5802364A (en) | 1996-04-15 | 1998-09-01 | Sun Microsystems, Inc. | Metadevice driver rename/exchange technique for a computer system incorporating a plurality of independent device drivers |
US5890156A (en) | 1996-05-02 | 1999-03-30 | Alcatel Usa, Inc. | Distributed redundant database |
US6058454A (en) | 1997-06-09 | 2000-05-02 | International Business Machines Corporation | Method and system for automatically configuring redundant arrays of disk memory devices |
US6088330A (en) | 1997-09-09 | 2000-07-11 | Bruck; Joshua | Reliable array of distributed computing nodes |
US5991414A (en) | 1997-09-12 | 1999-11-23 | International Business Machines Corporation | Method and apparatus for the secure distributed storage and retrieval of information |
US6272658B1 (en) | 1997-10-27 | 2001-08-07 | Kencast, Inc. | Method and system for reliable broadcasting of data files and streams |
JPH11161505A (en) | 1997-12-01 | 1999-06-18 | Matsushita Electric Ind Co Ltd | Media send-out device |
JPH11167443A (en) | 1997-12-02 | 1999-06-22 | Casio Comput Co Ltd | Interface device |
US6415373B1 (en) | 1997-12-24 | 2002-07-02 | Avid Technology, Inc. | Computer system and process for transferring multiple high bandwidth streams of data between multiple storage units and multiple applications in a scalable and reliable manner |
US6374336B1 (en) | 1997-12-24 | 2002-04-16 | Avid Technology, Inc. | Computer system and process for transferring multiple high bandwidth streams of data between multiple storage units and multiple applications in a scalable and reliable manner |
CA2341014A1 (en) | 1998-08-19 | 2000-03-02 | Alexander Roger Deas | A system and method for defining transforms of memory device addresses |
US6356949B1 (en) | 1999-01-29 | 2002-03-12 | Intermec Ip Corp. | Automatic data collection device that receives data output instruction from data consumer |
US6609223B1 (en) | 1999-04-06 | 2003-08-19 | Kencast, Inc. | Method for packet-level fec encoding, in which on a source packet-by-source packet basis, the error correction contributions of a source packet to a plurality of wildcard packets are computed, and the source packet is transmitted thereafter |
US6571282B1 (en) | 1999-08-31 | 2003-05-27 | Accenture Llp | Block-based communication in a communication services patterns environment |
US6826711B2 (en) | 2000-02-18 | 2004-11-30 | Avamar Technologies, Inc. | System and method for data protection with multidimensional parity |
US6718361B1 (en) | 2000-04-07 | 2004-04-06 | Network Appliance Inc. | Method and apparatus for reliable and scalable distribution of data files in distributed networks |
EP1364510B1 (en) | 2000-10-26 | 2007-12-12 | Prismedia Networks, Inc. | Method and system for managing distributed content and related metadata |
US8176563B2 (en) | 2000-11-13 | 2012-05-08 | DigitalDoors, Inc. | Data security system and method with editor |
US7146644B2 (en) | 2000-11-13 | 2006-12-05 | Digital Doors, Inc. | Data security system and method responsive to electronic attacks |
US7140044B2 (en) | 2000-11-13 | 2006-11-21 | Digital Doors, Inc. | Data security system and method for separation of user communities |
US7103915B2 (en) | 2000-11-13 | 2006-09-05 | Digital Doors, Inc. | Data security system and method |
GB2369206B (en) | 2000-11-18 | 2004-11-03 | Ibm | Method for rebuilding meta-data in a data storage system and a data storage system |
US6785783B2 (en) | 2000-11-30 | 2004-08-31 | International Business Machines Corporation | NUMA system with redundant main memory architecture |
US7080101B1 (en) | 2000-12-01 | 2006-07-18 | Ncr Corp. | Method and apparatus for partitioning data for storage in a database |
US20020120874A1 (en) | 2000-12-22 | 2002-08-29 | Li Shu | Method and system for secure exchange of messages |
WO2002065275A1 (en) | 2001-01-11 | 2002-08-22 | Yottayotta, Inc. | Storage virtualization system and methods |
US20020161846A1 (en) | 2001-01-29 | 2002-10-31 | Ulrich Thomas R. | Data path controller architecture |
US20030037261A1 (en) | 2001-03-26 | 2003-02-20 | Ilumin Corporation | Secured content delivery system and method |
US6879596B1 (en) | 2001-04-11 | 2005-04-12 | Applied Micro Circuits Corporation | System and method for systolic array sorting of information segments |
US7024609B2 (en) | 2001-04-20 | 2006-04-04 | Kencast, Inc. | System for protecting the transmission of live data streams, and upon reception, for reconstructing the live data streams and recording them into files |
GB2377049A (en) | 2001-06-30 | 2002-12-31 | Hewlett Packard Co | Billing for utilisation of a data storage array |
US6944785B2 (en) | 2001-07-23 | 2005-09-13 | Network Appliance, Inc. | High-availability cluster virtual server system |
US7636724B2 (en) | 2001-08-31 | 2009-12-22 | Peerify Technologies LLC | Data storage system and method by shredding and deshredding |
US7024451B2 (en) | 2001-11-05 | 2006-04-04 | Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. | System and method for maintaining consistent independent server-side state among collaborating servers |
US7003688B1 (en) | 2001-11-15 | 2006-02-21 | Xiotech Corporation | System and method for a reserved memory area shared by all redundant storage controllers |
US7171493B2 (en) | 2001-12-19 | 2007-01-30 | The Charles Stark Draper Laboratory | Camouflage of network traffic to resist attack |
WO2004012337A2 (en) | 2002-07-29 | 2004-02-05 | Robert Halford | Multi-dimensional data protection and mirroring method for micro level data |
US7051155B2 (en) | 2002-08-05 | 2006-05-23 | Sun Microsystems, Inc. | Method and system for striping data to accommodate integrity metadata |
US20040122917A1 (en) | 2002-12-18 | 2004-06-24 | Menon Jaishankar Moothedath | Distributed storage system for data-sharing among client computers running defferent operating system types |
JP2006526204A (en) | 2003-03-13 | 2006-11-16 | ディーアールエム テクノロジーズ、エルエルシー | Secure streaming container |
US7185144B2 (en) | 2003-11-24 | 2007-02-27 | Network Appliance, Inc. | Semi-static distribution technique |
GB0308264D0 (en) | 2003-04-10 | 2003-05-14 | Ibm | Recovery from failures within data processing systems |
GB0308262D0 (en) | 2003-04-10 | 2003-05-14 | Ibm | Recovery from failures within data processing systems |
US7415115B2 (en) | 2003-05-14 | 2008-08-19 | Broadcom Corporation | Method and system for disaster recovery of data from a storage device |
US7613945B2 (en) | 2003-08-14 | 2009-11-03 | Compellent Technologies | Virtual disk drive system and method |
US7899059B2 (en) | 2003-11-12 | 2011-03-01 | Agere Systems Inc. | Media delivery using quality of service differentiation within a media stream |
US8332483B2 (en) | 2003-12-15 | 2012-12-11 | International Business Machines Corporation | Apparatus, system, and method for autonomic control of grid system resources |
US7206899B2 (en) | 2003-12-29 | 2007-04-17 | Intel Corporation | Method, system, and program for managing data transfer and construction |
US7222133B1 (en) | 2004-02-05 | 2007-05-22 | Unisys Corporation | Method for reducing database recovery time |
US7240236B2 (en) | 2004-03-23 | 2007-07-03 | Archivas, Inc. | Fixed content distributed data storage using permutation ring encoding |
US7231578B2 (en) | 2004-04-02 | 2007-06-12 | Hitachi Global Storage Technologies Netherlands B.V. | Techniques for detecting and correcting errors using multiple interleave erasure pointers |
JP4446839B2 (en) | 2004-08-30 | 2010-04-07 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Storage device and storage management device |
US7680771B2 (en) | 2004-12-20 | 2010-03-16 | International Business Machines Corporation | Apparatus, system, and method for database provisioning |
US7386758B2 (en) | 2005-01-13 | 2008-06-10 | Hitachi, Ltd. | Method and apparatus for reconstructing data in object-based storage arrays |
US7672930B2 (en) | 2005-04-05 | 2010-03-02 | Wal-Mart Stores, Inc. | System and methods for facilitating a linear grid database with data organization by dimension |
JP2007087530A (en) * | 2005-09-22 | 2007-04-05 | Rohm Co Ltd | Signal decoding method, signal decoding device and signal storage system |
US7574579B2 (en) * | 2005-09-30 | 2009-08-11 | Cleversafe, Inc. | Metadata management system for an information dispersed storage system |
US7574570B2 (en) * | 2005-09-30 | 2009-08-11 | Cleversafe Inc | Billing system for information dispersal system |
US7546427B2 (en) | 2005-09-30 | 2009-06-09 | Cleversafe, Inc. | System for rebuilding dispersed data |
US8171101B2 (en) | 2005-09-30 | 2012-05-01 | Cleversafe, Inc. | Smart access to a dispersed data storage network |
US8285878B2 (en) * | 2007-10-09 | 2012-10-09 | Cleversafe, Inc. | Block based access to a dispersed data storage network |
US7904475B2 (en) | 2007-10-09 | 2011-03-08 | Cleversafe, Inc. | Virtualized data storage vaults on a dispersed data storage network |
US7953937B2 (en) | 2005-09-30 | 2011-05-31 | Cleversafe, Inc. | Systems, methods, and apparatus for subdividing data for storage in a dispersed data storage grid |
US20070214285A1 (en) | 2006-03-08 | 2007-09-13 | Omneon Video Networks | Gateway server |
US7934058B2 (en) * | 2006-12-14 | 2011-04-26 | Microsoft Corporation | Predictive caching of assets to improve level load time on a game console |
US8819179B2 (en) * | 2007-10-09 | 2014-08-26 | Cleversafe, Inc. | Data revision synchronization in a dispersed storage network |
JP4620722B2 (en) * | 2007-12-26 | 2011-01-26 | 富士通株式会社 | Data placement control program, data placement control device, data placement control method, and multi-node storage system |
JP2011087103A (en) * | 2009-10-15 | 2011-04-28 | Sony Corp | Provision of content reproduction system, content reproduction device, program, content reproduction method, and content server |
US8522074B2 (en) * | 2009-10-29 | 2013-08-27 | Cleversafe, Inc. | Intentionally introduced storage deviations in a dispersed storage network |
US9043489B2 (en) * | 2009-10-30 | 2015-05-26 | Cleversafe, Inc. | Router-based dispersed storage network method and apparatus |
US9152514B2 (en) * | 2009-11-24 | 2015-10-06 | Cleversafe, Inc. | Rebuilding a data segment in a dispersed storage network |
US8874868B2 (en) * | 2010-05-19 | 2014-10-28 | Cleversafe, Inc. | Memory utilization balancing in a dispersed storage network |
US8842746B2 (en) * | 2010-08-02 | 2014-09-23 | Cleversafe, Inc. | Receiving encoded data slices via wireless communication |
US9116831B2 (en) * | 2010-10-06 | 2015-08-25 | Cleversafe, Inc. | Correcting an errant encoded data slice |
US8954787B2 (en) * | 2011-05-09 | 2015-02-10 | Cleversafe, Inc. | Establishing trust in a maintenance free storage container |
US8782439B2 (en) * | 2011-06-06 | 2014-07-15 | Cleversafe, Inc. | Securing a data segment for storage |
US8930649B2 (en) * | 2011-09-06 | 2015-01-06 | Cleversafe, Inc. | Concurrent coding of data streams |
US9292212B2 (en) * | 2012-06-25 | 2016-03-22 | International Business Machines Corporation | Detecting storage errors in a dispersed storage network |
US9092441B1 (en) * | 2012-08-08 | 2015-07-28 | Amazon Technologies, Inc. | Archival data organization and management |
US9032165B1 (en) * | 2013-04-30 | 2015-05-12 | Amazon Technologies, Inc. | Systems and methods for scheduling write requests for a solid state storage device |
US20150032798A1 (en) * | 2013-07-24 | 2015-01-29 | Alcatel-Lucent Canada Inc. | Method And Apparatus For Providing Redundant Data Access |
-
2014
- 2014-05-30 US US14/292,662 patent/US20150039660A1/en not_active Abandoned
- 2014-05-30 US US14/292,009 patent/US9626125B2/en active Active
- 2014-06-18 US US14/307,672 patent/US9639298B2/en not_active Expired - Fee Related
- 2014-06-18 US US14/307,625 patent/US9495118B2/en active Active
-
2016
- 2016-11-07 US US15/345,172 patent/US9927976B2/en not_active Expired - Fee Related
-
2017
- 2017-01-25 US US15/415,236 patent/US10359935B2/en not_active Expired - Fee Related
Patent Citations (4)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US6976103B1 (en) * | 2000-03-03 | 2005-12-13 | Hitachi, Ltd. | Data migration method using storage area network |
US20090089428A1 (en) * | 2007-09-28 | 2009-04-02 | International Business Machines Corporation | Reducing overhead in component interactions |
US20110289122A1 (en) * | 2010-05-19 | 2011-11-24 | Cleversafe, Inc. | Rebuilding data in multiple dispersed storage networks |
US20120054225A1 (en) * | 2010-08-30 | 2012-03-01 | Oracle International Corporation | Query and Exadata Support for Hybrid Columnar Compressed Data |
Non-Patent Citations (1)
Title |
---|
Google Definition for "Data Object" (Year: 2018) * |
Cited By (17)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US10496615B2 (en) | 2014-09-16 | 2019-12-03 | Commvault Systems, Inc. | Fast deduplication data verification |
US11422991B2 (en) | 2014-09-16 | 2022-08-23 | Commvault Systems, Inc. | Fast deduplication data verification |
US10614049B2 (en) * | 2014-09-16 | 2020-04-07 | Commvault Systems, Inc. | Fast deduplication data verification |
US20160306829A1 (en) * | 2014-09-16 | 2016-10-20 | Commvault Systems, Inc. | Fast deduplication data verification |
US10135757B2 (en) * | 2015-03-20 | 2018-11-20 | International Business Machines Corporation | Inquiry-based adaptive prediction |
US10142260B2 (en) * | 2015-03-20 | 2018-11-27 | International Business Machines Corporation | Inquiry-based adaptive prediction |
US10572348B2 (en) | 2015-04-14 | 2020-02-25 | Commvault Systems, Inc. | Efficient deduplication database validation |
US11175996B2 (en) | 2015-04-14 | 2021-11-16 | Commvault Systems, Inc. | Efficient deduplication database validation |
US10324657B2 (en) * | 2015-05-29 | 2019-06-18 | International Business Machines Corporation | Accounting for data whose rebuilding is deferred |
US10248505B2 (en) * | 2016-02-29 | 2019-04-02 | International Business Machines Corporation | Issue escalation by management unit |
US11169731B2 (en) * | 2016-10-31 | 2021-11-09 | International Business Machines Corporation | Managing storage resources in a dispersed storage network |
US20180121132A1 (en) * | 2016-10-31 | 2018-05-03 | International Business Machines Corporation | Managing storage resources in a dispersed storage network |
US20180285370A1 (en) * | 2017-03-30 | 2018-10-04 | International Business Machines Corporation | Dynamically managing a high speed storage tier of a data storage system |
US10915498B2 (en) * | 2017-03-30 | 2021-02-09 | International Business Machines Corporation | Dynamically managing a high speed storage tier of a data storage system |
US11294871B2 (en) | 2019-07-19 | 2022-04-05 | Commvault Systems, Inc. | Deduplication system without reference counting |
US11341106B2 (en) | 2019-07-19 | 2022-05-24 | Commvault Systems, Inc. | Deduplication system without reference counting |
US12007967B2 (en) | 2019-07-19 | 2024-06-11 | Commvault Systems, Inc. | Deduplication database without reference counting |
Also Published As
Publication number | Publication date |
---|---|
US9927976B2 (en) | 2018-03-27 |
US20150039934A1 (en) | 2015-02-05 |
US20150039969A1 (en) | 2015-02-05 |
US9495118B2 (en) | 2016-11-15 |
US9626125B2 (en) | 2017-04-18 |
US20150039828A1 (en) | 2015-02-05 |
US20170068454A1 (en) | 2017-03-09 |
US9639298B2 (en) | 2017-05-02 |
US10359935B2 (en) | 2019-07-23 |
US20170132082A1 (en) | 2017-05-11 |
Similar Documents
Publication | Publication Date | Title |
---|---|---|
US10359935B2 (en) | Dispersed storage encoded data slice rebuild | |
US20230195574A1 (en) | Determining A Performance Error For A Storage Device | |
US11892908B2 (en) | Prioritizing locations for error scanning in a storage network | |
US10416889B2 (en) | Session execution decision | |
US9998538B2 (en) | Dispersed storage with coordinated execution and methods for use therewith | |
US9910732B2 (en) | Maintaining a desired number of storage units | |
US20140040417A1 (en) | Storing a stream of data in a dispersed storage network | |
US10324623B2 (en) | Mapping storage of data in a dispersed storage network | |
US20240095124A1 (en) | Storing Data Objects in a Storage Network with Multiple Memory Types | |
US20230333931A1 (en) | Dynamic storage of encoded data slices in multiple vaults | |
US20240211349A1 (en) | Trait Based Storage Unit Groups |
Legal Events
Date | Code | Title | Description |
---|---|---|---|
AS | Assignment |
Owner name: CLEVERSAFE, INC., ILLINOIS Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNORS:BAPTIST, ANDREW;LEGGETTE, WESLEY;RESCH, JASON;AND OTHERS;SIGNING DATES FROM 20140530 TO 20140609;REEL/FRAME:033081/0680 |
|
AS | Assignment |
Owner name: INTERNATIONAL BUSINESS MACHINES CORPORATION, NEW YORK Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNOR:CLEVERSAFE, INC.;REEL/FRAME:038629/0015 Effective date: 20160405 Owner name: INTERNATIONAL BUSINESS MACHINES CORPORATION, NEW Y Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNOR:CLEVERSAFE, INC.;REEL/FRAME:038629/0015 Effective date: 20160405 |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: NON FINAL ACTION MAILED |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: RESPONSE TO NON-FINAL OFFICE ACTION ENTERED AND FORWARDED TO EXAMINER |
|
AS | Assignment |
Owner name: PURE STORAGE, INC., CALIFORNIA Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNOR:INTERNATIONAL BUSINESS MACHINES CORPORATION;REEL/FRAME:049555/0530 Effective date: 20190611 |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: FINAL REJECTION MAILED |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: ADVISORY ACTION MAILED |
|
STCV | Information on status: appeal procedure |
Free format text: NOTICE OF APPEAL FILED |
|
AS | Assignment |
Owner name: PURE STORAGE, INC., CALIFORNIA Free format text: CORRECTIVE ASSIGNMENT TO CORRECT THE DELETE 15/174/279 AND 15/174/596 PROPERTY NUMBERS PREVIOUSLY RECORDED AT REEL: 49555 FRAME: 530. ASSIGNOR(S) HEREBY CONFIRMS THE ASSIGNMENT;ASSIGNOR:INTERNATIONAL BUSINESS MACHINES CORPORATION;REEL/FRAME:051495/0831 Effective date: 20190611 |
|
STCV | Information on status: appeal procedure |
Free format text: APPEAL BRIEF (OR SUPPLEMENTAL BRIEF) ENTERED AND FORWARDED TO EXAMINER |
|
STCV | Information on status: appeal procedure |
Free format text: EXAMINER'S ANSWER TO APPEAL BRIEF MAILED |
|
STCV | Information on status: appeal procedure |
Free format text: ON APPEAL -- AWAITING DECISION BY THE BOARD OF APPEALS |
|
AS | Assignment |
Owner name: BARCLAYS BANK PLC AS ADMINISTRATIVE AGENT, NEW YORK Free format text: SECURITY INTEREST;ASSIGNOR:PURE STORAGE, INC.;REEL/FRAME:053867/0581 Effective date: 20200824 |
|
STCV | Information on status: appeal procedure |
Free format text: BOARD OF APPEALS DECISION RENDERED |
|
STCB | Information on status: application discontinuation |
Free format text: ABANDONED -- AFTER EXAMINER'S ANSWER OR BOARD OF APPEALS DECISION |